summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/docs-xml/manpages
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to 'docs-xml/manpages')
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/eventlogadm.8.xml291
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/findsmb.1.xml153
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/idmap_ad.8.xml114
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/idmap_autorid.8.xml153
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/idmap_hash.8.xml75
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/idmap_ldap.8.xml145
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/idmap_nss.8.xml60
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/idmap_rid.8.xml132
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/idmap_tdb.8.xml75
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/idmap_tdb2.8.xml137
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/ldb.3.xml265
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/ldbadd.1.xml108
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/ldbdel.1.xml108
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/ldbedit.1.xml203
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/ldbmodify.1.xml96
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/ldbrename.1.xml110
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/ldbsearch.1.xml122
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/libsmbclient.7.xml141
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/lmhosts.5.xml127
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/log2pcap.1.xml138
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/net.8.xml2394
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/nmbd.8.xml294
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/nmblookup.1.xml223
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/ntlm_auth.1.xml409
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/pam_winbind.8.xml264
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/pam_winbind.conf.5.xml190
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/pdbedit.8.xml547
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/profiles.1.xml88
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/rpcclient.1.xml542
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/samba.7.xml334
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/sharesec.1.xml220
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smb.conf.5.xml827
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smbcacls.1.xml265
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smbclient.1.xml1193
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smbcontrol.1.xml330
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smbcquotas.1.xml183
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smbd.8.xml445
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smbget.1.xml217
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smbgetrc.5.xml116
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smbpasswd.5.xml211
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smbpasswd.8.xml431
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smbspool.8.xml133
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smbstatus.1.xml158
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smbta-util.8.xml119
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smbtar.1.xml237
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/smbtree.1.xml96
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/swat.8.xml237
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/tdbbackup.8.xml136
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/tdbdump.8.xml61
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/tdbtool.8.xml243
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/testparm.1.xml202
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_acl_tdb.8.xml79
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_acl_xattr.8.xml83
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_aio_fork.8.xml86
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_aio_linux.8.xml115
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_aio_pthread.8.xml120
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_audit.8.xml122
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_cacheprime.8.xml110
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_cap.8.xml78
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_catia.8.xml73
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_commit.8.xml110
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_crossrename.8.xml116
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_default_quota.8.xml136
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_dirsort.8.xml69
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_extd_audit.8.xml68
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_fake_perms.8.xml73
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_fileid.8.xml112
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_full_audit.8.xml241
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_gpfs.8.xml443
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_media_harmony.8.xml142
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_netatalk.8.xml77
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_notify_fam.8.xml70
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_prealloc.8.xml107
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_preopen.8.xml115
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_readahead.8.xml115
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_readonly.8.xml101
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_recycle.8.xml220
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_scannedonly.8.xml243
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_shadow_copy.8.xml121
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_shadow_copy2.8.xml211
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_smb_traffic_analyzer.8.xml299
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_streams_depot.8.xml78
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_streams_xattr.8.xml68
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_time_audit.8.xml101
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_tsmsm.8.xml135
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfs_xattr_tdb.8.xml69
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/vfstest.1.xml153
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/wbinfo.1.xml500
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/winbind_krb5_locator.7.xml95
-rw-r--r--docs-xml/manpages/winbindd.8.xml497
90 files changed, 19849 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/eventlogadm.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/eventlogadm.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..4a6a68e185
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/eventlogadm.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,291 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="eventlogadm.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>eventlogadm</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>eventlogadm</refname>
+ <refpurpose>push records into the Samba event log store</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+
+ <command>eventlogadm</command>
+ <arg><option>-s</option></arg>
+ <arg><option>-d</option></arg>
+ <arg><option>-h</option></arg>
+ <arg choice="plain"><option>-o</option>
+ <literal>addsource</literal>
+ <replaceable>EVENTLOG</replaceable>
+ <replaceable>SOURCENAME</replaceable>
+ <replaceable>MSGFILE</replaceable>
+ </arg>
+
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>eventlogadm</command>
+ <arg><option>-s</option></arg>
+ <arg><option>-d</option></arg>
+ <arg><option>-h</option></arg>
+ <arg choice="plain"><option>-o</option>
+ <literal>write</literal>
+ <replaceable>EVENTLOG</replaceable>
+ </arg>
+
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>eventlogadm</command>
+ <arg><option>-s</option></arg>
+ <arg><option>-d</option></arg>
+ <arg><option>-h</option></arg>
+ <arg choice="plain"><option>-o</option>
+ <literal>dump</literal>
+ <replaceable>EVENTLOG</replaceable>
+ <replaceable>RECORD_NUMBER</replaceable>
+ </arg>
+
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>eventlogadm</command> is a filter that accepts
+ formatted event log records on standard input and writes them
+ to the Samba event log store. Windows client can then manipulate
+ these record using the usual administration tools.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>
+ <option>-s</option>
+ <replaceable>FILENAME</replaceable>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ The <command>-s</command> option causes <command>eventlogadm</command> to load the
+ configuration file given as FILENAME instead of the default one used by Samba.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>-d</option></term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ The <command>-d</command> option causes <command>eventlogadm</command> to emit debugging
+ information.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>
+ <option>-o</option>
+ <literal>addsource</literal>
+ <replaceable>EVENTLOG</replaceable>
+ <replaceable>SOURCENAME</replaceable>
+ <replaceable>MSGFILE</replaceable>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ The <command>-o addsource</command> option creates a
+ new event log source.
+ </para> </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>
+ <option>-o</option>
+ <literal>write</literal>
+ <replaceable>EVENTLOG</replaceable>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ The <command>-o write</command> reads event log
+ records from standard input and writes them to the Samba
+ event log store named by EVENTLOG.
+ </para> </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>
+ <option>-o</option>
+ <literal>dump</literal>
+ <replaceable>EVENTLOG</replaceable>
+ <replaceable>RECORD_NUMBER</replaceable>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ The <command>-o dump</command> reads event log
+ records from a EVENTLOG tdb and dumps them to standard
+ output on screen.
+ </para> </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>-h</option></term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Print usage information.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EVENTLOG RECORD FORMAT</title>
+
+ <para>For the write operation, <command>eventlogadm</command>
+ expects to be able to read structured records from standard
+ input. These records are a sequence of lines, with the record key
+ and data separated by a colon character. Records are separated
+ by at least one or more blank line.</para>
+
+ <para>The event log record field are:</para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>LEN</command> - This field should be 0, since <command>eventlogadm</command> will calculate this value.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>RS1</command> - This must be the value 1699505740.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>RCN</command> - This field should be 0.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>TMG</command> - The time the eventlog record
+ was generated; format is the number of seconds since
+ 00:00:00 January 1, 1970, UTC.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>TMW</command> - The time the eventlog record was
+ written; format is the number of seconds since 00:00:00
+ January 1, 1970, UTC.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>EID</command> - The eventlog ID.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>ETP</command> - The event type -- one of
+ &quot;INFO&quot;,
+ &quot;ERROR&quot;, &quot;WARNING&quot;, &quot;AUDIT
+ SUCCESS&quot; or &quot;AUDIT FAILURE&quot;.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>ECT</command> - The event category; this depends
+ on the message file. It is primarily used as a means of
+ filtering in the eventlog viewer.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>RS2</command> - This field should be 0.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>CRN</command> - This field should be 0.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>USL</command> - This field should be 0.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>SRC</command> - This field contains the source
+ name associated with the event log. If a message file is
+ used with an event log, there will be a registry entry
+ for associating this source name with a message file DLL.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>SRN</command> - The name of the machine on
+ which the eventlog was generated. This is typically the
+ host name.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>STR</command> - The text associated with the
+ eventlog. There may be more than one string in a record.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>DAT</command> - This field should be left unset.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+ <para>An example of the record format accepted by <command>eventlogadm</command>:</para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ LEN: 0
+ RS1: 1699505740
+ RCN: 0
+ TMG: 1128631322
+ TMW: 1128631322
+ EID: 1000
+ ETP: INFO
+ ECT: 0
+ RS2: 0
+ CRN: 0
+ USL: 0
+ SRC: cron
+ SRN: dmlinux
+ STR: (root) CMD ( rm -f /var/spool/cron/lastrun/cron.hourly)
+ DAT:
+ </programlisting>
+
+ <para>Set up an eventlog source, specifying a message file DLL:</para>
+ <programlisting>
+ eventlogadm -o addsource Application MyApplication | \\
+ %SystemRoot%/system32/MyApplication.dll
+ </programlisting>
+
+ <para>Filter messages from the system log into an event log:</para>
+ <programlisting>
+ tail -f /var/log/messages | \\
+ my_program_to_parse_into_eventlog_records | \\
+ eventlogadm SystemLogEvents
+ </programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para> The original Samba software and related utilities were
+ created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed by the
+ Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
+ Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/findsmb.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/findsmb.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..92bcbbefb6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/findsmb.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,153 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="findsmb.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>findsmb</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>findsmb</refname>
+ <refpurpose>list info about machines that respond to SMB
+ name queries on a subnet</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>findsmb</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">subnet broadcast address</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This perl script is part of the <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle><manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>findsmb</command> is a perl script that
+ prints out several pieces of information about machines
+ on a subnet that respond to SMB name query requests.
+ It uses <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmblookup</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ to obtain this information.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-r</term>
+ <listitem><para>Controls whether <command>findsmb</command> takes
+ bugs in Windows95 into account when trying to find a Netbios name
+ registered of the remote machine. This option is disabled by default
+ because it is specific to Windows 95 and Windows 95 machines only.
+ If set, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmblookup</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ will be called with <constant>-B</constant> option.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>subnet broadcast address</term>
+ <listitem><para>Without this option, <command>findsmb
+ </command> will probe the subnet of the machine where
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>findsmb</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ is run. This value is passed to
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmblookup</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ as part of the <constant>-B</constant> option.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>The output of <command>findsmb</command> lists the following
+ information for all machines that respond to the initial
+ <command>nmblookup</command> for any name: IP address, NetBIOS name,
+ Workgroup name, operating system, and SMB server version.</para>
+
+ <para>There will be a '+' in front of the workgroup name for
+ machines that are local master browsers for that workgroup. There
+ will be an '*' in front of the workgroup name for
+ machines that are the domain master browser for that workgroup.
+ Machines that are running Windows for Workgroups, Windows 95 or
+ Windows 98 will
+ not show any information about the operating system or server
+ version.</para>
+
+ <para>The command with <constant>-r</constant> option
+ must be run on a system without <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry> running.
+
+ If <command>nmbd</command> is running on the system, you will
+ only get the IP address and the DNS name of the machine. To
+ get proper responses from Windows 95 and Windows 98 machines,
+ the command must be run as root and with <constant>-r</constant>
+ option on a machine without <command>nmbd</command> running.</para>
+
+ <para>For example, running <command>findsmb</command>
+ without <constant>-r</constant> option set would yield output similar
+ to the following</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+IP ADDR NETBIOS NAME WORKGROUP/OS/VERSION
+---------------------------------------------------------------------
+192.168.35.10 MINESET-TEST1 [DMVENGR]
+192.168.35.55 LINUXBOX *[MYGROUP] [Unix] [Samba 2.0.6]
+192.168.35.56 HERBNT2 [HERB-NT]
+192.168.35.63 GANDALF [MVENGR] [Unix] [Samba 2.0.5a for IRIX]
+192.168.35.65 SAUNA [WORKGROUP] [Unix] [Samba 1.9.18p10]
+192.168.35.71 FROGSTAR [ENGR] [Unix] [Samba 2.0.0 for IRIX]
+192.168.35.78 HERBDHCP1 +[HERB]
+192.168.35.88 SCNT2 +[MVENGR] [Windows NT 4.0] [NT LAN Manager 4.0]
+192.168.35.93 FROGSTAR-PC [MVENGR] [Windows 5.0] [Windows 2000 LAN Manager]
+192.168.35.97 HERBNT1 *[HERB-NT] [Windows NT 4.0] [NT LAN Manager 4.0]
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry>,
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry>, and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmblookup</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink
+ url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>)
+ and updated for the Samba 2.0 release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook
+ XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_ad.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_ad.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..7319f9199f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_ad.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,114 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="idmap_ad.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>idmap_ad</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>idmap_ad</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Samba's idmap_ad Backend for Winbind</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+ <para>The idmap_ad plugin provides a way for Winbind to read
+ id mappings from an AD server that uses RFC2307/SFU schema
+ extensions. This module implements only the &quot;idmap&quot;
+ API, and is READONLY. Mappings must be provided in advance
+ by the administrator by adding the posixAccount/posixGroup
+ classes and relative attribute/value pairs to the user and
+ group objects in the AD.</para>
+
+ <para>
+ Note that the idmap_ad module has changed considerably since
+ Samba versions 3.0 and 3.2.
+ Currently, the <parameter>ad</parameter> backend
+ does not work as the the default idmap backend, but one has
+ to configure it separately for each domain for which one wants
+ to use it, using disjoint ranges. One usually needs to configure
+ a writeable default idmap range, using for example the
+ <parameter>tdb</parameter> or <parameter>ldap</parameter>
+ backend, in order to be able to map the BUILTIN sids and
+ possibly other trusted domains. The writeable default config
+ is also needed in order to be able to create group mappings.
+ This catch-all default idmap configuration should have a range
+ that is disjoint from any explicitly configured domain with
+ idmap backend <parameter>ad</parameter>. See the example below.
+ </para>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>IDMAP OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>range = low - high</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Defines the available matching UID and GID range for which the
+ backend is authoritative. Note that the range acts as a filter.
+ If specified any UID or GID stored in AD that fall outside the
+ range is ignored and the corresponding map is discarded.
+ It is intended as a way to avoid accidental UID/GID overlaps
+ between local and remotely defined IDs.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>schema_mode = &lt;rfc2307 | sfu | sfu20&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Defines the schema that idmap_ad should use when querying
+ Active Directory regarding user and group information.
+ This can be either the RFC2307 schema support included
+ in Windows 2003 R2 or the Service for Unix (SFU) schema.
+ For SFU 3.0 or 3.5 please choose "sfu", for SFU 2.0
+ please choose "sfu20".
+
+ Please note that primary group membership is currently always calculated
+ via the "primaryGroupID" LDAP attribute.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+ <para>
+ The following example shows how to retrieve idmappings from our principal and
+ trusted AD domains. If trusted domains are present id conflicts must be
+ resolved beforehand, there is no
+ guarantee on the order conflicting mappings would be resolved at this point.
+
+ This example also shows how to leave a small non conflicting range for local
+ id allocation that may be used in internal backends like BUILTIN.
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ [global]
+ workgroup = CORP
+
+ idmap config * : backend = tdb
+ idmap config * : range = 1000000-1999999
+
+ idmap config CORP : backend = ad
+ idmap config CORP : range = 1000-999999
+ </programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_autorid.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_autorid.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..498ef68fb3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_autorid.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,153 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="idmap_autorid.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>idmap_autorid</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>idmap_autorid</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Samba's idmap_autorid Backend for Winbind</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+ <para>The idmap_autorid backend provides a way to use an algorithmic
+ mapping scheme to map UIDs/GIDs and SIDs that is more deterministic
+ than idmap_tdb and easier to configure than idmap_rid.</para>
+ <para>The module works similar to idmap_rid, but it automatically
+ configures the range to be used for each domain, so there is no need
+ to specify a specific range for each domain in the forest, the only
+ configuration that is needed is the range of uid/gids that shall
+ be used for user/group mappings and an optional size of the ranges
+ to be used.</para>
+ <para>The mappings of which domain is mapped to which range is stored
+ in autorid.tdb, thus you should backup this database regularly.</para>
+ <para>Due to the algorithm being used, it is the module that is
+ most easy to use as it only requires a minimal configuration.</para>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>IDMAP OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>rangesize = numberofidsperdomain</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Defines the available number of uids/gids per domain. The
+ minimum needed value is 2000. SIDs with RIDs larger than this
+ value cannot be mapped, are ignored and the corresponding map
+ is discarded. Choose this value carefully, as this should
+ not be changed after the first ranges for domains have been
+ defined, otherwise mappings between domains will get intermixed
+ leading to unpredictable results. Please note that RIDs in Windows
+ Domains usually start with 500 for builtin users and 1000
+ for regular users. As the parameter cannot be changed later, please
+ plan accordingly for your expected number of users in a domain
+ with safety margins.
+ </para>
+ <para>One range will be used for local users and groups and for
+ non-domain well-known SIDs like Everyone (S-1-1-0) or Creator Owner (S-1-3-0).
+ A chosen list of well-known SIDs will be preallocated on first start
+ to create deterministic mappings for those.</para>
+ <para>
+ Thus the number of local users and groups that can be created is
+ limited by this option as well. If you plan to create a large amount
+ of local users or groups, you will need set this parameter accordingly.
+ </para>
+ <para>The default value is 100000.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>read only = [ yes | no ]</term>
+ <listitem><para>Turn the module into read-only mode. No new ranges will be allocated
+ nor will new mappings be created in the idmap pool. Defaults to no.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>ignore builtin = [ yes | no ]</term>
+ <listitem><para>Ignore any mapping requests for the BUILTIN domain.
+ Defaults to no.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>THE MAPPING FORMULAS</title>
+ <para>
+ The Unix ID for a RID is calculated this way:
+ <programlisting>
+ ID = IDMAP UID LOW VALUE + DOMAINRANGENUMBER * RANGESIZE + RID
+ </programlisting>
+ </para>
+ <para>
+ Correspondingly, the formula for calculating the RID for a
+ given Unix ID is this:
+ <programlisting>
+ RID = ID - IDMAP UID LOW VALUE - DOMAINRANGENUMBER * RANGESIZE
+ </programlisting>
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+ <para>
+ This example shows you the minimal configuration that will
+ work for the principial domain and 19 trusted domains.
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ [global]
+ security = ads
+ workgroup = CUSTOMER
+ realm = CUSTOMER.COM
+
+ idmap config * : backend = autorid
+ idmap config * : range = 1000000-1999999
+
+ </programlisting>
+
+ <para>
+ This example shows how to configure idmap_autorid as default
+ for all domains with a potentially large amount of users
+ plus a specific configuration for a trusted domain
+ that uses the SFU mapping scheme. Please note that idmap
+ ranges and sfu ranges are not allowed to overlap.
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ [global]
+ security = ads
+ workgroup = CUSTOMER
+ realm = CUSTOMER.COM
+
+ idmap config * : backend = autorid
+ idmap config * : range = 1000000-19999999
+ idmap config * : rangesize = 1000000
+
+ idmap config TRUSTED : backend = ad
+ idmap config TRUSTED : range = 50000 - 99999
+ idmap config TRUSTED : schema_mode = sfu
+ </programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_hash.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_hash.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..f3ec6a7bc2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_hash.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,75 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="idmap_hash.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>idmap_hash</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>idmap_hash</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Samba's idmap_hash Backend for Winbind</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+ <para>The idmap_hash plugin implements a hashing algorithm used to map
+ SIDs for domain users and groups to 31-bit uids and gids, respectively.
+ This plugin also implements the nss_info API and can be used
+ to support a local name mapping files if enabled via the
+ &quot;winbind normalize names&quot; and &quot;winbind nss info&quot;
+ parameters in smb.conf.
+ </para>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>IDMAP OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>name_map</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Specifies the absolute path to the name mapping
+ file used by the nss_info API. Entries in the file
+ are of the form &quot;<replaceable>unix name</replaceable>
+ = <replaceable>qualified domain name</replaceable>&quot;.
+ Mapping of both user and group names is supported.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+ <para>The following example utilizes the idmap_hash plugin for
+ the idmap and nss_info information.
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ [global]
+ idmap config * : backend = hash
+ idmap config * : range = 1000-4000000000
+
+ winbind nss info = hash
+ winbind normalize names = yes
+ idmap_hash:name_map = /etc/samba/name_map.cfg
+ </programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_ldap.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_ldap.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..2c0fcfd17c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_ldap.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,145 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="idmap_ldap.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>idmap_ldap</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>idmap_ldap</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Samba's idmap_ldap Backend for Winbind</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>The idmap_ldap plugin provides a means for Winbind to
+ store and retrieve SID/uid/gid mapping tables in an LDAP directory
+ service.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ In contrast to read only backends like idmap_rid, it is an allocating
+ backend: This means that it needs to allocate new user and group IDs in
+ order to create new mappings.
+ </para>
+
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>IDMAP OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>ldap_base_dn = DN</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Defines the directory base suffix to use for
+ SID/uid/gid mapping entries. If not defined, idmap_ldap will default
+ to using the &quot;ldap idmap suffix&quot; option from smb.conf.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>ldap_user_dn = DN</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Defines the user DN to be used for authentication.
+ The secret for authenticating this user should be
+ stored with net idmap secret
+ (see <citerefentry><refentrytitle>net</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>).
+ If absent, the ldap credentials from the ldap passdb configuration
+ are used, and if these are also absent, an anonymous
+ bind will be performed as last fallback.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>ldap_url = ldap://server/</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Specifies the LDAP server to use for
+ SID/uid/gid map entries. If not defined, idmap_ldap will
+ assume that ldap://localhost/ should be used.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>range = low - high</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Defines the available matching uid and gid range for which the
+ backend is authoritative.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The following example shows how an ldap directory is used as the
+ default idmap backend. It also configures the idmap range and base
+ directory suffix. The secret for the ldap_user_dn has to be set with
+ &quot;net idmap secret '*' password&quot;.
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ [global]
+ idmap config * : backend = ldap
+ idmap config * : range = 1000000-1999999
+ idmap config * : ldap_url = ldap://localhost/
+ idmap config * : ldap_base_dn = ou=idmap,dc=example,dc=com
+ idmap config * : ldap_user_dn = cn=idmap_admin,dc=example,dc=com
+ </programlisting>
+
+ <para>
+ This example shows how ldap can be used as a readonly backend while
+ tdb is the default backend used to store the mappings.
+ It adds an explicit configuration for some domain DOM1, that
+ uses the ldap idmap backend. Note that a range disjoint from the
+ default range is used.
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ [global]
+ # "backend = tdb" is redundant here since it is the default
+ idmap config * : backend = tdb
+ idmap config * : range = 1000000-1999999
+
+ idmap config DOM1 : backend = ldap
+ idmap config DOM1 : range = 2000000-2999999
+ idmap config DOM1 : read only = yes
+ idmap config DOM1 : ldap_url = ldap://server/
+ idmap config DOM1 : ldap_base_dn = ou=idmap,dc=dom1,dc=example,dc=com
+ idmap config DOM1 : ldap_user_dn = cn=idmap_admin,dc=dom1,dc=example,dc=com
+ </programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <title>NOTE</title>
+
+ <para>In order to use authentication against ldap servers you may
+ need to provide a DN and a password. To avoid exposing the password
+ in plain text in the configuration file we store it into a security
+ store. The &quot;net idmap &quot; command is used to store a secret
+ for the DN specified in a specific idmap domain.
+ </para>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_nss.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_nss.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..565019cd3d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_nss.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,60 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="idmap_nss.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>idmap_nss</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>idmap_nss</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Samba's idmap_nss Backend for Winbind</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>The idmap_nss plugin provides a means to map Unix users and groups
+ to Windows accounts and obsoletes the &quot;winbind trusted domains only&quot;
+ smb.conf option. This provides a simple means of ensuring that the SID
+ for a Unix user named jsmith is reported as the one assigned to
+ DOMAIN\jsmith which is necessary for reporting ACLs on files and printers
+ stored on a Samba member server.
+ </para>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>
+ This example shows how to use idmap_nss to check the local accounts for its
+ own domain while using allocation to create new mappings for trusted domains
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ [global]
+ idmap config * : backend = tdb
+ idmap config * : range = 1000000-1999999
+
+ idmap config SAMBA : backend = nss
+ idmap config SAMBA : range = 1000-999999
+ </programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_rid.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_rid.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..3f8735288c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_rid.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,132 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="idmap_rid.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>idmap_rid</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>idmap_rid</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Samba's idmap_rid Backend for Winbind</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+ <para>The idmap_rid backend provides a way to use an algorithmic
+ mapping scheme to map UIDs/GIDs and SIDs. No database is required
+ in this case as the mapping is deterministic.</para>
+
+ <para>
+ Note that the idmap_rid module has changed considerably since Samba
+ versions 3.0. and 3.2.
+ Currently, there should to be an explicit idmap configuration for each
+ domain that should use the idmap_rid backend, using disjoint ranges.
+ One usually needs to define a writeable default idmap range, using
+ a backend like <parameter>tdb</parameter> or <parameter>ldap</parameter>
+ that can create unix ids, in order to be able to map the BUILTIN sids
+ and other domains, and also in order to be able to create group mappings.
+ See the example below.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ Note that the old syntax
+ <parameter>idmap backend = rid:"DOM1=range DOM2=range2 ..."</parameter>
+ is not supported any more since Samba version 3.0.25.
+ </para>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>IDMAP OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>range = low - high</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Defines the available matching uid and gid range for which the
+ backend is authoritative. Note that the range acts as a filter.
+ If algorithmically determined UID or GID fall outside the
+ range, they are ignored and the corresponding map is discarded.
+ It is intended as a way to avoid accidental UID/GID overlaps
+ between local and remotely defined IDs.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>base_rid = INTEGER</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Defines the base integer used to build SIDs out of a UID or a GID,
+ and to rebase the UID or GID to be obtained from a SID.
+ This means SIDs with a RID less than the base rid are filtered.
+ The default is not to restrict the allowed rids at all,
+ i.e. a base_rid value of 0.
+ A good value for the base_rid can be 1000, since user
+ RIDs by default start at 1000 (512 hexadecimal).
+ </para>
+ <para>
+ Use of this parameter is deprecated.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>THE MAPPING FORMULAS</title>
+ <para>
+ The Unix ID for a RID is calculated this way:
+ <programlisting>
+ ID = RID - BASE_RID + LOW_RANGE_ID.
+ </programlisting>
+ </para>
+ <para>
+ Correspondingly, the formula for calculating the RID for a
+ given Unix ID is this:
+ <programlisting>
+ RID = ID + BASE_RID - LOW_RANGE_ID.
+ </programlisting>
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+ <para>
+ This example shows how to configure two domains with idmap_rid,
+ the principal domain and a trusted domain, leaving the default
+ id mapping scheme at tdb. The example also demonstrates the use
+ of the base_rid parameter for the trusted domain.
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ [global]
+ security = domain
+ workgroup = MAIN
+
+ idmap config * : backend = tdb
+ idmap config * : range = 1000000-1999999
+
+ idmap config MAIN : backend = rid
+ idmap config MAIN : range = 10000 - 49999
+
+ idmap config TRUSTED : backend = rid
+ idmap config TRUSTED : range = 50000 - 99999
+ idmap config TRUSTED : base_rid = 1000
+ </programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_tdb.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_tdb.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..c67d6cb9bc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_tdb.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,75 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="idmap_tdb.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>idmap_tdb</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>idmap_tdb</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Samba's idmap_tdb Backend for Winbind</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The idmap_tdb plugin is the default backend used by winbindd
+ for storing SID/uid/gid mapping tables.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ In contrast to read only backends like idmap_rid, it is an allocating
+ backend: This means that it needs to allocate new user and group IDs in
+ order to create new mappings.
+ </para>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>IDMAP OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>range = low - high</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Defines the available matching uid and gid range for which the
+ backend is authoritative.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>
+ This example shows how tdb is used as a the default idmap backend.
+ This configured range is used for uid and gid allocation.
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ [global]
+ # "backend = tdb" is redundant here since it is the default
+ idmap config * : backend = tdb
+ idmap config * : range = 1000000-2000000
+ </programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_tdb2.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_tdb2.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..1faf59085f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/idmap_tdb2.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,137 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="idmap_tdb2.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>idmap_tdb2</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>idmap_tdb2</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Samba's idmap_tdb2 Backend for Winbind</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The idmap_tdb2 plugin is a substitute for the default idmap_tdb
+ backend used by winbindd for storing SID/uid/gid mapping tables
+ in clustered environments with Samba and CTDB.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ In contrast to read only backends like idmap_rid, it is an allocating
+ backend: This means that it needs to allocate new user and group IDs in
+ order to create new mappings.
+ </para>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>IDMAP OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>range = low - high</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Defines the available matching uid and gid range for which the
+ backend is authoritative.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>script</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ This option can be used to configure an external program
+ for performing id mappings instead of using the tdb
+ counter. The mappings are then stored int tdb2 idmap
+ database. For details see the section on IDMAP SCRIPT below.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>IDMAP SCRIPT</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The tdb2 idmap backend supports an external program for performing id mappings
+ through the smb.conf option <parameter>idmap config * : script</parameter> or
+ its deprecated legacy form <parameter>idmap : script</parameter>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The mappings obtained by the script are then stored in the idmap tdb2
+ database instead of mappings created by the incrementing id counters.
+ It is therefore important that the script covers the complete range of
+ SIDs that can be passed in for SID to Unix ID mapping, since otherwise
+ SIDs unmapped by the script might get mapped to IDs that had
+ previously been mapped by the script.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The script should accept the following command line options.
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ SIDTOID S-1-xxxx
+ IDTOSID UID xxxx
+ IDTOSID GID xxxx
+ </programlisting>
+
+ <para>
+ And it should return one of the following responses as a single line of
+ text.
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ UID:yyyy
+ GID:yyyy
+ SID:yyyy
+ ERR:yyyy
+ </programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>
+ This example shows how tdb2 is used as a the default idmap backend.
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ [global]
+ idmap config * : backend = tdb2
+ idmap config * : range = 1000000-2000000
+ </programlisting>
+
+ <para>
+ This example shows how tdb2 is used as a the default idmap backend
+ using an external program via the script parameter:
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ [global]
+ idmap config * : backend = tdb2
+ idmap config * : range = 1000000-2000000
+ idmap config * : script = /usr/local/samba/bin/idmap_script.sh
+ </programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/ldb.3.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/ldb.3.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..715fd8002f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/ldb.3.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,265 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.2//EN" "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd">
+<refentry id="ldb.3">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>ldb</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>3</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">C Library Functions</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>ldb</refname>
+ <refclass>The Samba Project</refclass>
+ <refpurpose>A light-weight database library</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <synopsis>#include &lt;ldb.h&gt;</synopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>description</title>
+
+ <para>
+ldb is a light weight embedded database library and API. With a
+programming interface that is very similar to LDAP, ldb can store its
+data either in a tdb(3) database or in a real LDAP database.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+When used with the tdb backend ldb does not require any database
+daemon. Instead, ldb function calls are processed immediately by the
+ldb library, which does IO directly on the database, while allowing
+multiple readers/writers using operating system byte range locks. This
+leads to an API with very low overheads, often resulting in speeds of
+more than 10x what can be achieved with a more traditional LDAP
+architecture.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+In a taxonomy of databases ldb would sit half way between key/value
+pair databases (such as berkley db or tdb) and a full LDAP
+database. With a structured attribute oriented API like LDAP and good
+indexing capabilities, ldb can be used for quite sophisticated
+applications that need a light weight database, without the
+administrative overhead of a full LDAP installation.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+Included with ldb are a number of useful command line tools for
+manipulating a ldb database. These tools are similar in style to the
+equivalent ldap command line tools.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+In its default mode of operation with a tdb backend, ldb can also be
+seen as a "schema-less LDAP". By default ldb does not require a
+schema, which greatly reduces the complexity of getting started with
+ldb databases. As the complexity of you application grows you can take
+advantage of some of the optional schema-like attributes that ldb
+offers, or you can migrate to using the full LDAP api while keeping
+your exiting ldb code.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+If you are new to ldb, then I suggest starting with the manual pages
+for ldbsearch(1) and ldbedit(1), and experimenting with a local
+database. Then I suggest you look at the ldb_connect(3) and
+ldb_search(3) manual pages.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>TOOLS</title>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <application>ldbsearch(1)</application>
+ - command line ldb search utility
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <application>ldbedit(1)</application>
+ - edit all or part of a ldb database using your favourite editor
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <application>ldbadd(1)</application>
+ - add records to a ldb database using LDIF formatted input
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <application>ldbdel(1)</application>
+ - delete records from a ldb database
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <application>ldbmodify(1)</application>
+ - modify records in a ldb database using LDIF formatted input
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>FUNCTIONS</title>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_connect(3)</function>
+ - connect to a ldb backend
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_search(3)</function>
+ - perform a database search
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_add(3)</function>
+ - add a record to the database
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_delete(3)</function>
+ - delete a record from the database
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_modify(3)</function>
+ - modify a record in the database
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_errstring(3)</function>
+ - retrieve extended error information from the last operation
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_ldif_write(3)</function>
+ - write a LDIF formatted message
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_ldif_write_file(3)</function>
+ - write a LDIF formatted message to a file
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_ldif_read(3)</function>
+ - read a LDIF formatted message
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_ldif_read_free(3)</function>
+ - free the result of a ldb_ldif_read()
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_ldif_read_file(3)</function>
+ - read a LDIF message from a file
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_ldif_read_string(3)</function>
+ - read a LDIF message from a string
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_msg_find_element(3)</function>
+ - find an element in a ldb_message
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_val_equal_exact(3)</function>
+ - compare two ldb_val structures
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_msg_find_val(3)</function>
+ - find an element by value
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_msg_add_empty(3)</function>
+ - add an empty message element to a ldb_message
+ </para></listitem>
+
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_msg_add(3)</function>
+ - add a non-empty message element to a ldb_message
+ </para></listitem>
+
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_msg_element_compare(3)</function>
+ - compare two ldb_message_element structures
+ </para></listitem>
+
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_msg_find_int(3)</function>
+ - return an integer value from a ldb_message
+ </para></listitem>
+
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_msg_find_uint(3)</function>
+ - return an unsigned integer value from a ldb_message
+ </para></listitem>
+
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_msg_find_double(3)</function>
+ - return a double value from a ldb_message
+ </para></listitem>
+
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_msg_find_string(3)</function>
+ - return a string value from a ldb_message
+ </para></listitem>
+
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_set_alloc(3)</function>
+ - set the memory allocation function to be used by ldb
+ </para></listitem>
+
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_set_debug(3)</function>
+ - set a debug handler to be used by ldb
+ </para></listitem>
+
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <function>ldb_set_debug_stderr(3)</function>
+ - set a debug handler for stderr output
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>Author</title>
+
+ <para>
+ ldb was written by
+ <ulink url="http://samba.org/~tridge/">Andrew Tridgell</ulink>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+If you wish to report a problem or make a suggestion then please see
+the <ulink url="http://ldb.samba.org/"/> web site for
+current contact and maintainer information.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ldb is released under the GNU Lesser General Public License version 2
+or later. Please see the file COPYING for license details.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/ldbadd.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/ldbadd.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..b0c25e74c7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/ldbadd.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,108 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.2//EN" "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd">
+<refentry id="ldbadd.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>ldbadd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>ldbadd</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Command-line utility for adding records to an LDB</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>ldbadd</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-H LDB-URL</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">ldif-file1</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">ldif-file2</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">...</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>ldbadd adds records to an ldb(7) database. It reads
+ the ldif(5) files specified on the command line and adds
+ the records from these files to the LDB database, which is specified
+ by the -H option or the LDB_URL environment variable.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>If - is specified as a ldb file, the ldif input is read from
+ standard input.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-h</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Show list of available options.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-H &lt;ldb-url&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ LDB URL to connect to. See ldb(7) for details.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>ENVIRONMENT</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>LDB_URL</term>
+ <listitem><para>LDB URL to connect to (can be overridden by using the
+ -H command-line option.)</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+
+ <para>ldb(7), ldbmodify, ldbdel, ldif(5)</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para> ldb was written by
+ <ulink url="http://samba.org/~tridge/">Andrew Tridgell</ulink>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+If you wish to report a problem or make a suggestion then please see
+the <ulink url="http://ldb.samba.org/"/> web site for
+current contact and maintainer information.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/ldbdel.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/ldbdel.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..c7e33a839f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/ldbdel.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,108 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.2//EN" "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd">
+<refentry id="ldbdel.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>ldbdel</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>ldbdel</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Command-line program for deleting LDB records</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>ldbdel</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-H LDB-URL</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">dn</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">...</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>ldbdel deletes records from an ldb(7) database.
+ It deletes the records identified by the dn's specified
+ on the command-line. </para>
+
+ <para>ldbdel uses either the database that is specified with
+ the -H option or the database specified by the LDB_URL environment
+ variable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-h</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Show list of available options.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-H &lt;ldb-url&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ LDB URL to connect to. See ldb(7) for details.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>ENVIRONMENT</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>LDB_URL</term>
+ <listitem><para>LDB URL to connect to (can be overridden by using the
+ -H command-line option.)</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+
+ <para>ldb(7), ldbmodify, ldbadd, ldif(5)</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para> ldb was written by
+ <ulink url="http://samba.org/~tridge/">Andrew Tridgell</ulink>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+If you wish to report a problem or make a suggestion then please see
+the <ulink url="http://ldb.samba.org/"/> web site for
+current contact and maintainer information.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>ldbdel was written by Andrew Tridgell.</para>
+
+ <para>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/ldbedit.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/ldbedit.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..bbca0d2309
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/ldbedit.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,203 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.2//EN" "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd">
+<refentry id="ldbedit.1">
+
+ <refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>ldbedit</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+ </refmeta>
+
+
+ <refnamediv>
+ <refname>ldbedit</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Edit LDB databases using your preferred editor</refpurpose>
+ </refnamediv>
+
+ <refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>ldbedit</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-?</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--usage</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s base|one|sub</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-b basedn</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-a</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-e editor</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-H LDB-URL</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">expression</arg>
+ <arg rep="repeat" choice="opt">attributes</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>ldbedit is a utility that allows you to edit LDB entries (in
+ tdb files, sqlite files or LDAP servers) using your preferred editor.
+ ldbedit generates an LDIF file based on your query, allows you to edit
+ the LDIF, and then merges that LDIF back into the LDB backend.
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+ <refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-?</term>
+ <term>--help</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Show list of available options, and a phrase describing what that option
+ does.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--usage</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Show list of available options. This is similar to the help option,
+ however it does not provide any description, and is hence shorter.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-H &lt;ldb-url&gt;</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ LDB URL to connect to. For a tdb database,
+ this will be of the form
+ tdb://<replaceable>filename</replaceable>.
+ For a LDAP connection over unix domain
+ sockets, this will be of the form
+ ldapi://<replaceable>socket</replaceable>. For
+ a (potentially remote) LDAP connection over
+ TCP, this will be of the form
+ ldap://<replaceable>hostname</replaceable>. For
+ an SQLite database, this will be of the form
+ sqlite://<replaceable>filename</replaceable>.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-s one|sub|base</term>
+ <listitem><para>Search scope to use. One-level, subtree or base.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-a</term>
+ <term>-all</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Edit all records. This allows you to
+ apply the same change to a number of records
+ at once. You probably want to combine this
+ with an expression of the form
+ "objectclass=*".
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-e editor</term>
+ <term>--editor editor</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Specify the editor that should be used (overrides
+ the VISUAL and EDITOR environment
+ variables). If this option is not used, and
+ neither VISUAL nor EDITOR environment variables
+ are set, then the vi editor will be used.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-b basedn</term>
+ <listitem><para>Specify Base Distinguished Name to use.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-v</term>
+ <term>--verbose</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Make ldbedit more verbose about the
+ operations that are being performed. Without
+ this option, ldbedit will only provide a
+ summary change line.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+
+ </refsect1>
+
+ <refsect1>
+ <title>ENVIRONMENT</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>LDB_URL</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>LDB URL to connect to. This can be
+ overridden by using the -H command-line option.)
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>VISUAL and EDITOR</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Environment variables used to determine what
+ editor to use. VISUAL takes precedence over
+ EDITOR, and both are overridden by the
+ -e command-line option.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ </refsect1>
+
+ <refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</para>
+ </refsect1>
+
+ <refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+
+ <para>ldb(7), ldbmodify(1), ldbdel(1), ldif(5), vi(1)</para>
+
+ </refsect1>
+
+ <refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ ldb was written by
+ <ulink url="http://samba.org/~tridge/">Andrew Tridgell</ulink>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ If you wish to report a problem or make a suggestion then please see
+ the <ulink url="http://ldb.samba.org/"/> web site for
+ current contact and maintainer information.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij and updated
+ by Brad Hards.
+ </para>
+
+ </refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/ldbmodify.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/ldbmodify.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..0c91f75599
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/ldbmodify.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,96 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.2//EN" "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd">
+<refentry id="ldbmodify.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>ldbmodify</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>ldbmodify</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Modify records in a LDB database</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>ldbmodify</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-H LDB-URL</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">ldif-file</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>
+ ldbmodify changes, adds and deletes records in a LDB database.
+ The changes that should be made to the LDB database are read from
+ the specified LDIF-file. If - is specified as the filename, input is read from stdin.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>For now, see ldapmodify(1) for details on the LDIF file format.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-H &lt;ldb-url&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ LDB URL to connect to. See ldb(7) for details.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>ENVIRONMENT</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>LDB_URL</term>
+ <listitem><para>LDB URL to connect to (can be overridden by using the
+ -H command-line option.)</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+
+ <para>ldb(7), ldbedit</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para> ldb was written by
+ <ulink url="http://samba.org/~tridge/">Andrew Tridgell</ulink>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+If you wish to report a problem or make a suggestion then please see
+the <ulink url="http://ldb.samba.org/"/> web site for
+current contact and maintainer information.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/ldbrename.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/ldbrename.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..394cff74ef
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/ldbrename.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,110 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.2//EN" "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd">
+<refentry id="ldbrename.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>ldbrename</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>ldbrename</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Edit LDB databases using your favorite editor</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>ldbrename</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-o options</arg>
+ <arg choice="req">olddn</arg>
+ <arg choice="req">newdb</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>ldbrename is a utility that allows you to rename trees in
+ an LDB database based by DN. This utility takes
+ two arguments: the original
+ DN name of the top element and the DN to change it to.
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-h</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Show list of available options.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-H &lt;ldb-url&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ LDB URL to connect to. See ldb(7) for details.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-o options</term>
+ <listitem><para>Extra ldb options, such as
+ modules.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>ENVIRONMENT</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>LDB_URL</term>
+ <listitem><para>LDB URL to connect to (can be overridden by using the
+ -H command-line option.)</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+
+ <para>ldb(7), ldbmodify, ldbdel, ldif(5)</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para> ldb was written by
+ <ulink url="http://samba.org/~tridge/">Andrew Tridgell</ulink>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+If you wish to report a problem or make a suggestion then please see
+the <ulink url="http://ldb.samba.org/"/> web site for
+current contact and maintainer information.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/ldbsearch.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/ldbsearch.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..6882c56bfe
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/ldbsearch.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,122 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.2//EN" "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd">
+<refentry id="ldbsearch.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>ldbsearch</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>ldbsearch</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Search for records in a LDB database</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>ldbsearch</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s base|one|sub</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-b basedn</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-i</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-H LDB-URL</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">expression</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">attributes</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>ldbsearch searches a LDB database for records matching the
+ specified expression (see the ldapsearch(1) manpage for
+ a description of the expression format). For each
+ record, the specified attributes are printed.
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-h</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Show list of available options.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-H &lt;ldb-url&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ LDB URL to connect to. See ldb(7) for details.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-s one|sub|base</term>
+ <listitem><para>Search scope to use. One-level, subtree or base.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-i</term>
+ <listitem><para>Read search expressions from stdin. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-b basedn</term>
+ <listitem><para>Specify Base DN to use.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>ENVIRONMENT</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>LDB_URL</term>
+ <listitem><para>LDB URL to connect to (can be overridden by using the
+ -H command-line option.)</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 4.0 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+
+ <para>ldb(7), ldbedit(1)</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para> ldb was written by
+ <ulink url="http://samba.org/~tridge/">Andrew Tridgell</ulink>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+If you wish to report a problem or make a suggestion then please see
+the <ulink url="http://ldb.samba.org/"/> web site for
+current contact and maintainer information.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/libsmbclient.7.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/libsmbclient.7.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..277caf3618
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/libsmbclient.7.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,141 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="libsmbclient.7">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>libsmbclient</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">7</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>libsmbclient</refname>
+ <refpurpose>An extension library for browsers and that can be used as a generic browsing API.</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <para>
+ Browser URL:
+ <command moreinfo="none">smb://[[[domain:]user[:password@]]server[/share[/path[/file]]]] [?options]
+ </command>
+ </para>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>
+ This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ <command>libsmbclient</command> is a library toolset that permits applications to manipulate CIFS/SMB network
+ resources using many of the standards POSIX functions available for manipulating local UNIX/Linux files. It
+ permits much more than just browsing, files can be opened and read or written, permissions changed, file times
+ modified, attributes and ACL's can be manipulated, and so on. Of course, its functionality includes all the
+ capabilities commonly called browsing.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ <command>libsmbclient</command> can not be used directly from the command line, instead it provides an
+ extension of the capabilities of tools such as file managers and browsers. This man page describes the
+ configuration options for this tool so that the user may obtain greatest utility of use.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <para>
+ What the URLs mean:
+ </para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>smb://</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Shows all workgroups or domains that are visible in the network. The behavior matches
+ that of the Microsoft Windows Explorer.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The method of locating the list of workgroups (domains also) varies depending on the setting of
+ the context variable <literal>(context-&gt;options.browse_max_lmb_count)</literal>. It is the
+ responsibility of the application that calls this library to set this to a sensible value. This
+ is a compile-time option. This value determines the maximum number of local master browsers to
+ query for the list of workgroups. In order to ensure that the list is complete for those present
+ on the network, all master browsers must be queried. If there are a large number of workgroups
+ on the network, the time spent querying will be significant. For small networks (just a few
+ workgroups), it is suggested to set this value to 0, instructing libsmbclient to query all local
+ master browsers. In an environment that has many workgroups a more reasonable setting may be around 3.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>smb://name/</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ This command causes libsmbclient to perform a name look-up. If the NAME&lt;1D&gt; or
+ NAME&lt;1B&gt; exists (workgroup name), libsmbclient will list all servers in the
+ workgroup (or domain). Otherwise, a name look-up for the NAME&lt;20&gt; (machine name)
+ will be performed, and the list of shared resources on the server will be displayed.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ <para>
+ When libsmbclient is invoked by an application it searches for a directory called
+ <filename>.smb</filename> in the $HOME directory that is specified in the users shell
+ environment. It then searches for a file called <filename>smb.conf</filename> which,
+ if present, will fully over-ride the system <filename>/etc/samba/smb.conf</filename> file. If
+ instead libsmbclient finds a file called <filename>~/.smb/smb.conf.append</filename>,
+ it will read the system <filename>/etc/samba/smb.conf</filename> and then append the
+ contents of the <filename>~/.smb/smb.conf.append</filename> to it.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ <command>libsmbclient</command> will check the users shell environment for the <literal>USER</literal>
+ parameter and will use its value when if the <literal>user</literal> parameter was not included
+ in the URL.
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>PROGRAMMERS GUIDE</title>
+
+ <para>
+ Watch this space for future updates.
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>
+ This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities were created by Andrew Tridgell.
+ Samba is now developed by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way
+ the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The libsmbclient manpage page was written by John H Terpstra.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/lmhosts.5.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/lmhosts.5.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..de6bc4d1a9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/lmhosts.5.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,127 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="lmhosts.5">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>lmhosts</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">File Formats and Conventions</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>lmhosts</refname>
+ <refpurpose>The Samba NetBIOS hosts file</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <para><filename>lmhosts</filename> is the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file.</para>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This file is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><filename>lmhosts</filename> is the <emphasis>Samba
+ </emphasis> NetBIOS name to IP address mapping file. It
+ is very similar to the <filename>/etc/hosts</filename> file
+ format, except that the hostname component must correspond
+ to the NetBIOS naming format.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>FILE FORMAT</title>
+ <para>It is an ASCII file containing one line for NetBIOS name.
+ The two fields on each line are separated from each other by
+ white space. Any entry beginning with '#' is ignored. Each line
+ in the lmhosts file contains the following information:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>IP Address - in dotted decimal format.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>NetBIOS Name - This name format is a
+ maximum fifteen character host name, with an optional
+ trailing '#' character followed by the NetBIOS name type
+ as two hexadecimal digits.</para>
+
+ <para>If the trailing '#' is omitted then the given IP
+ address will be returned for all names that match the given
+ name, whatever the NetBIOS name type in the lookup.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>An example follows:
+<programlisting>
+#
+# Sample Samba lmhosts file.
+#
+192.9.200.1 TESTPC
+192.9.200.20 NTSERVER#20
+192.9.200.21 SAMBASERVER
+</programlisting>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>Contains three IP to NetBIOS name mappings. The first
+ and third will be returned for any queries for the names "TESTPC"
+ and "SAMBASERVER" respectively, whatever the type component of
+ the NetBIOS name requested.</para>
+
+ <para>The second mapping will be returned only when the "0x20" name
+ type for a name "NTSERVER" is queried. Any other name type will not
+ be resolved.</para>
+
+ <para>The default location of the <filename>lmhosts</filename> file
+ is in the same directory as the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>FILES</title>
+
+ <para>lmhosts is loaded from the configuration directory. This is
+ usually <filename>/etc/samba</filename> or <filename>/usr/local/samba/lib</filename>.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry>, and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
+ <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook
+ XML 4.2 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/log2pcap.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/log2pcap.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..5e449b8252
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/log2pcap.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,138 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="log2pcap.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>log2pcap</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>log2pcap</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Extract network traces from Samba log files</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>log2pcap</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-q</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">logfile</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">pcap_file</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>log2pcap</command> reads in a
+ samba log file and generates a pcap file (readable
+ by most sniffers, such as ethereal or tcpdump) based on the packet
+ dumps in the log file.</para>
+
+ <para>The log file must have a <parameter>log level</parameter>
+ of at least <constant>5</constant> to get the SMB header/parameters
+ right, <constant>10</constant> to get the first 512 data bytes of the
+ packet and <constant>50</constant> to get the whole packet.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-h</term>
+ <listitem><para>If this parameter is
+ specified the output file will be a
+ hex dump, in a format that is readable
+ by the <application>text2pcap</application> utility.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-q</term>
+ <listitem><para>Be quiet. No warning messages about missing
+ or incomplete data will be given.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>logfile</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Samba log file. log2pcap will try to read the log from stdin
+ if the log file is not specified.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>pcap_file</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Name of the output file to write the pcap (or hexdump) data to.
+ If this argument is not specified, output data will be written
+ to stdout.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.help;
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Extract all network traffic from all samba log files:</para>
+
+ <para><programlisting>
+ <prompt>$</prompt> log2pcap &lt; /var/log/* &gt; trace.pcap
+ </programlisting></para>
+
+ <para>Convert to pcap using text2pcap:</para>
+
+ <para><programlisting>
+ <prompt>$</prompt> log2pcap -h samba.log | text2pcap -T 139,139 - trace.pcap
+ </programlisting></para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>BUGS</title>
+
+ <para>Only SMB data is extracted from the samba logs, no LDAP,
+ NetBIOS lookup or other data.</para>
+
+ <para>The generated TCP and IP headers don't contain a valid
+ checksum.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>text2pcap</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>ethereal</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/net.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/net.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..7a7ca6d1b6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/net.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,2394 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="net.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>net</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>net</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Tool for administration of Samba and remote
+ CIFS servers.
+ </refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>net</command>
+ <arg choice="req">&lt;ads|rap|rpc&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-w workgroup</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-W myworkgroup</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-U user</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-I ip-address</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-p port</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-n myname</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s conffile</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-S server</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-l</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-P</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d debuglevel</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-V</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--request-timeout seconds</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The Samba net utility is meant to work just like the net utility
+ available for windows and DOS. The first argument should be used
+ to specify the protocol to use when executing a certain command.
+ ADS is used for ActiveDirectory, RAP is using for old (Win9x/NT3)
+ clients and RPC can be used for NT4 and Windows 2000. If this
+ argument is omitted, net will try to determine it automatically.
+ Not all commands are available on all protocols.
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ &stdarg.help;
+ &stdarg.kerberos;
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-w target-workgroup</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Sets target workgroup or domain. You have to specify
+ either this option or the IP address or the name of a server.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-W workgroup</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Sets client workgroup or domain
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-U user</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ User name to use
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-I ip-address</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ IP address of target server to use. You have to
+ specify either this option or a target workgroup or
+ a target server.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-p port</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Port on the target server to connect to (usually 139 or 445).
+ Defaults to trying 445 first, then 139.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.netbios.name;
+ &stdarg.configfile;
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-S server</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Name of target server. You should specify either
+ this option or a target workgroup or a target IP address.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-l</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ When listing data, give more information on each item.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-P</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Make queries to the external server using the machine account of the local server.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--request-timeout 30</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Let client requests timeout after 30 seconds the default is 10
+ seconds.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+<title>COMMANDS</title>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>CHANGESECRETPW</title>
+
+<para>This command allows the Samba machine account password to be set from an external application
+to a machine account password that has already been stored in Active Directory. DO NOT USE this command
+unless you know exactly what you are doing. The use of this command requires that the force flag (-f)
+be used also. There will be NO command prompt. Whatever information is piped into stdin, either by
+typing at the command line or otherwise, will be stored as the literal machine password. Do NOT use
+this without care and attention as it will overwrite a legitimate machine password without warning.
+YOU HAVE BEEN WARNED.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+ <title>TIME</title>
+
+ <para>The <command>NET TIME</command> command allows you to view the time on a remote server
+ or synchronise the time on the local server with the time on the remote server.</para>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>TIME</title>
+
+<para>Without any options, the <command>NET TIME</command> command
+displays the time on the remote server.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>TIME SYSTEM</title>
+
+<para>Displays the time on the remote server in a format ready for <command>/bin/date</command>.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>TIME SET</title>
+<para>Tries to set the date and time of the local server to that on
+the remote server using <command>/bin/date</command>. </para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>TIME ZONE</title>
+
+<para>Displays the timezone in hours from GMT on the remote computer.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>[RPC|ADS] JOIN [TYPE] [-U username[%password]] [createupn=UPN] [createcomputer=OU] [options]</title>
+
+<para>
+Join a domain. If the account already exists on the server, and
+[TYPE] is MEMBER, the machine will attempt to join automatically.
+(Assuming that the machine has been created in server manager)
+Otherwise, a password will be prompted for, and a new account may
+be created.</para>
+
+<para>
+[TYPE] may be PDC, BDC or MEMBER to specify the type of server
+joining the domain.
+</para>
+
+<para>
+[UPN] (ADS only) set the principalname attribute during the join. The default
+format is host/netbiosname@REALM.
+</para>
+
+<para>
+[OU] (ADS only) Precreate the computer account in a specific OU. The
+OU string reads from top to bottom without RDNs, and is delimited by
+a '/'. Please note that '\' is used for escape by both the shell
+and ldap, so it may need to be doubled or quadrupled to pass through,
+and it is not used as a delimiter.
+</para>
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>[RPC] OLDJOIN [options]</title>
+
+<para>Join a domain. Use the OLDJOIN option to join the domain
+using the old style of domain joining - you need to create a trust
+account in server manager first.</para>
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>[RPC|ADS] USER</title>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC|ADS] USER</title>
+
+<para>List all users</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC|ADS] USER DELETE <replaceable>target</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Delete specified user</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC|ADS] USER INFO <replaceable>target</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>List the domain groups of the specified user.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC|ADS] USER RENAME <replaceable>oldname</replaceable> <replaceable>newname</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Rename specified user.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC|ADS] USER ADD <replaceable>name</replaceable> [password] [-F user flags] [-C comment]</title>
+
+<para>Add specified user.</para>
+</refsect3>
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>[RPC|ADS] GROUP</title>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC|ADS] GROUP [misc options] [targets]</title>
+<para>List user groups.</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC|ADS] GROUP DELETE <replaceable>name</replaceable> [misc. options]</title>
+
+<para>Delete specified group.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC|ADS] GROUP ADD <replaceable>name</replaceable> [-C comment]</title>
+
+<para>Create specified group.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>[RAP|RPC] SHARE</title>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RAP|RPC] SHARE [misc. options] [targets]</title>
+
+<para>Enumerates all exported resources (network shares) on target server.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RAP|RPC] SHARE ADD <replaceable>name=serverpath</replaceable> [-C comment] [-M maxusers] [targets]</title>
+
+<para>Adds a share from a server (makes the export active). Maxusers
+specifies the number of users that can be connected to the
+share simultaneously.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>SHARE DELETE <replaceable>sharename</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Delete specified share.</para>
+</refsect3>
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>[RPC|RAP] FILE</title>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC|RAP] FILE</title>
+
+<para>List all open files on remote server.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC|RAP] FILE CLOSE <replaceable>fileid</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Close file with specified <replaceable>fileid</replaceable> on
+remote server.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC|RAP] FILE INFO <replaceable>fileid</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Print information on specified <replaceable>fileid</replaceable>.
+Currently listed are: file-id, username, locks, path, permissions.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RAP|RPC] FILE USER <replaceable>user</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+List files opened by specified <replaceable>user</replaceable>.
+Please note that <command>net rap file user</command> does not work
+against Samba servers.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SESSION</title>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RAP SESSION</title>
+
+<para>Without any other options, SESSION enumerates all active SMB/CIFS
+sessions on the target server.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RAP SESSION DELETE|CLOSE <replaceable>CLIENT_NAME</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Close the specified sessions.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RAP SESSION INFO <replaceable>CLIENT_NAME</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Give a list with all the open files in specified session.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RAP SERVER <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>List all servers in specified domain or workgroup. Defaults
+to local domain.</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RAP DOMAIN</title>
+
+<para>Lists all domains and workgroups visible on the
+current network.</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RAP PRINTQ</title>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RAP PRINTQ INFO <replaceable>QUEUE_NAME</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Lists the specified print queue and print jobs on the server.
+If the <replaceable>QUEUE_NAME</replaceable> is omitted, all
+queues are listed.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RAP PRINTQ DELETE <replaceable>JOBID</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Delete job with specified id.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RAP VALIDATE <replaceable>user</replaceable> [<replaceable>password</replaceable>]</title>
+
+<para>
+Validate whether the specified user can log in to the
+remote server. If the password is not specified on the commandline, it
+will be prompted.
+</para>
+
+&not.implemented;
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RAP GROUPMEMBER</title>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RAP GROUPMEMBER LIST <replaceable>GROUP</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>List all members of the specified group.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RAP GROUPMEMBER DELETE <replaceable>GROUP</replaceable> <replaceable>USER</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Delete member from group.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RAP GROUPMEMBER ADD <replaceable>GROUP</replaceable> <replaceable>USER</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Add member to group.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RAP ADMIN <replaceable>command</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Execute the specified <replaceable>command</replaceable> on
+the remote server. Only works with OS/2 servers.
+</para>
+
+&not.implemented;
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RAP SERVICE</title>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RAP SERVICE START <replaceable>NAME</replaceable> [arguments...]</title>
+
+<para>Start the specified service on the remote server. Not implemented yet.</para>
+
+&not.implemented;
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RAP SERVICE STOP</title>
+
+<para>Stop the specified service on the remote server.</para>
+
+&not.implemented;
+
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RAP PASSWORD <replaceable>USER</replaceable> <replaceable>OLDPASS</replaceable> <replaceable>NEWPASS</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Change password of <replaceable>USER</replaceable> from <replaceable>OLDPASS</replaceable> to <replaceable>NEWPASS</replaceable>.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>LOOKUP</title>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>LOOKUP HOST <replaceable>HOSTNAME</replaceable> [<replaceable>TYPE</replaceable>]</title>
+
+<para>
+Lookup the IP address of the given host with the specified type (netbios suffix).
+The type defaults to 0x20 (workstation).
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>LOOKUP LDAP [<replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable>]</title>
+
+<para>Give IP address of LDAP server of specified <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable>. Defaults to local domain.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>LOOKUP KDC [<replaceable>REALM</replaceable>]</title>
+
+<para>Give IP address of KDC for the specified <replaceable>REALM</replaceable>.
+Defaults to local realm.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>LOOKUP DC [<replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable>]</title>
+
+<para>Give IP's of Domain Controllers for specified <replaceable>
+DOMAIN</replaceable>. Defaults to local domain.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>LOOKUP MASTER <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Give IP of master browser for specified <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable>
+or workgroup. Defaults to local domain.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>CACHE</title>
+
+<para>Samba uses a general caching interface called 'gencache'. It
+can be controlled using 'NET CACHE'.</para>
+
+<para>All the timeout parameters support the suffixes:
+
+<simplelist>
+<member>s - Seconds</member>
+<member>m - Minutes</member>
+<member>h - Hours</member>
+<member>d - Days</member>
+<member>w - Weeks</member>
+</simplelist>
+
+</para>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>CACHE ADD <replaceable>key</replaceable> <replaceable>data</replaceable> <replaceable>time-out</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Add specified key+data to the cache with the given timeout.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>CACHE DEL <replaceable>key</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Delete key from the cache.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>CACHE SET <replaceable>key</replaceable> <replaceable>data</replaceable> <replaceable>time-out</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Update data of existing cache entry.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>CACHE SEARCH <replaceable>PATTERN</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Search for the specified pattern in the cache data.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>CACHE LIST</title>
+
+<para>
+List all current items in the cache.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>CACHE FLUSH</title>
+
+<para>Remove all the current items from the cache.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>GETLOCALSID [DOMAIN]</title>
+
+<para>Prints the SID of the specified domain, or if the parameter is
+omitted, the SID of the local server.</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SETLOCALSID S-1-5-21-x-y-z</title>
+
+<para>Sets SID for the local server to the specified SID.</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>GETDOMAINSID</title>
+
+<para>Prints the local machine SID and the SID of the current
+domain.</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SETDOMAINSID</title>
+
+<para>Sets the SID of the current domain.</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>GROUPMAP</title>
+
+<para>Manage the mappings between Windows group SIDs and UNIX groups.
+Common options include:</para>
+
+<itemizedlist>
+<listitem><para>unixgroup - Name of the UNIX group</para></listitem>
+<listitem><para>ntgroup - Name of the Windows NT group (must be
+ resolvable to a SID</para></listitem>
+<listitem><para>rid - Unsigned 32-bit integer</para></listitem>
+<listitem><para>sid - Full SID in the form of "S-1-..."</para></listitem>
+<listitem><para>type - Type of the group; either 'domain', 'local',
+ or 'builtin'</para></listitem>
+<listitem><para>comment - Freeform text description of the group</para></listitem>
+</itemizedlist>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>GROUPMAP ADD</title>
+
+<para>
+Add a new group mapping entry:
+<programlisting>
+net groupmap add {rid=int|sid=string} unixgroup=string \
+ [type={domain|local}] [ntgroup=string] [comment=string]
+</programlisting>
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>GROUPMAP DELETE</title>
+
+<para>Delete a group mapping entry. If more than one group name matches, the first entry found is deleted.</para>
+
+<para>net groupmap delete {ntgroup=string|sid=SID}</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>GROUPMAP MODIFY</title>
+
+<para>Update an existing group entry.</para>
+
+<para>
+<programlisting>
+net groupmap modify {ntgroup=string|sid=SID} [unixgroup=string] \
+ [comment=string] [type={domain|local}]
+</programlisting>
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>GROUPMAP LIST</title>
+
+<para>List existing group mapping entries.</para>
+
+<para>net groupmap list [verbose] [ntgroup=string] [sid=SID]</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+</refsect2>
+
+
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>MAXRID</title>
+
+<para>Prints out the highest RID currently in use on the local
+server (by the active 'passdb backend').
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RPC INFO</title>
+
+<para>Print information about the domain of the remote server,
+such as domain name, domain sid and number of users and groups.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>[RPC|ADS] TESTJOIN</title>
+
+<para>Check whether participation in a domain is still valid.</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>[RPC|ADS] CHANGETRUSTPW</title>
+
+<para>Force change of domain trust password.</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RPC TRUSTDOM</title>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RPC TRUSTDOM ADD <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Add a interdomain trust account for <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable>.
+This is in fact a Samba account named <replaceable>DOMAIN$</replaceable>
+with the account flag <constant>'I'</constant> (interdomain trust account).
+This is required for incoming trusts to work. It makes Samba be a
+trusted domain of the foreign (trusting) domain.
+Users of the Samba domain will be made available in the foreign domain.
+If the command is used against localhost it has the same effect as
+<command>smbpasswd -a -i DOMAIN</command>. Please note that both commands
+expect a appropriate UNIX account.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RPC TRUSTDOM DEL <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Remove interdomain trust account for
+<replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable>. If it is used against localhost
+it has the same effect as <command>smbpasswd -x DOMAIN$</command>.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RPC TRUSTDOM ESTABLISH <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Establish a trust relationship to a trusted domain.
+Interdomain account must already be created on the remote PDC.
+This is required for outgoing trusts to work. It makes Samba be a
+trusting domain of a foreign (trusted) domain.
+Users of the foreign domain will be made available in our domain.
+You'll need winbind and a working idmap config to make them
+appear in your system.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RPC TRUSTDOM REVOKE <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable></title>
+<para>Abandon relationship to trusted domain</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RPC TRUSTDOM LIST</title>
+
+<para>List all interdomain trust relationships.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RPC TRUST</title>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RPC TRUST CREATE</title>
+
+<para>Create a trust object by calling lsaCreateTrustedDomainEx2.
+The can be done on a single server or on two servers at once with the
+possibility to use a random trust password.</para>
+
+<variablelist><title>Options:</title>
+<varlistentry>
+<term>otherserver</term>
+<listitem><para>Domain controller of the second domain</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry>
+<term>otheruser</term>
+<listitem><para>Admin user in the second domain</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry>
+<term>otherdomainsid</term>
+<listitem><para>SID of the second domain</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry>
+<term>other_netbios_domain</term>
+<listitem><para>NetBIOS (short) name of the second domain</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry>
+<term>otherdomain</term>
+<listitem><para>DNS (full) name of the second domain</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry>
+<term>trustpw</term>
+<listitem><para>Trust password</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+</variablelist>
+
+<variablelist><title>Examples:</title>
+<varlistentry>
+<term>Create a trust object on srv1.dom1.dom for the domain dom2</term>
+<listitem><literallayout>
+net rpc trust create \
+ otherdomainsid=S-x-x-xx-xxxxxxxxxx-xxxxxxxxxx-xxxxxxxxx \
+ other_netbios_domain=dom2 \
+ otherdomain=dom2.dom \
+ trustpw=12345678 \
+ -S srv1.dom1.dom
+</literallayout></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+<varlistentry>
+<term>Create a trust relationship between dom1 and dom2</term>
+<listitem><literallayout>
+net rpc trust create \
+ otherserver=srv2.dom2.test \
+ otheruser=dom2adm \
+ -S srv1.dom1.dom
+</literallayout></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+</variablelist>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>RPC TRUST DELETE</title>
+
+<para>Delete a trust trust object by calling lsaDeleteTrustedDomain.
+The can be done on a single server or on two servers at once.</para>
+
+<variablelist><title>Options:</title>
+<varlistentry>
+<term>otherserver</term>
+<listitem><para>Domain controller of the second domain</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry>
+<term>otheruser</term>
+<listitem><para>Admin user in the second domain</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry>
+<term>otherdomainsid</term>
+<listitem><para>SID of the second domain</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+</variablelist>
+
+<variablelist><title>Examples:</title>
+<varlistentry>
+<term>Delete a trust object on srv1.dom1.dom for the domain dom2</term>
+<listitem><literallayout>
+net rpc trust delete \
+ otherdomainsid=S-x-x-xx-xxxxxxxxxx-xxxxxxxxxx-xxxxxxxxx \
+ -S srv1.dom1.dom
+</literallayout></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+<varlistentry>
+<term>Delete a trust relationship between dom1 and dom2</term>
+<listitem><literallayout>
+net rpc trust delete \
+ otherserver=srv2.dom2.test \
+ otheruser=dom2adm \
+ -S srv1.dom1.dom
+</literallayout></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+</variablelist>
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<refsect3>
+<title>RPC RIGHTS</title>
+
+<para>This subcommand is used to view and manage Samba's rights assignments (also
+referred to as privileges). There are three options currently available:
+<parameter>list</parameter>, <parameter>grant</parameter>, and
+<parameter>revoke</parameter>. More details on Samba's privilege model and its use
+can be found in the Samba-HOWTO-Collection.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RPC ABORTSHUTDOWN</title>
+
+<para>Abort the shutdown of a remote server.</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RPC SHUTDOWN [-t timeout] [-r] [-f] [-C message]</title>
+
+<para>Shut down the remote server.</para>
+
+<variablelist>
+<varlistentry>
+<term>-r</term>
+<listitem><para>
+Reboot after shutdown.
+</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry>
+<term>-f</term>
+<listitem><para>
+Force shutting down all applications.
+</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry>
+<term>-t timeout</term>
+<listitem><para>
+Timeout before system will be shut down. An interactive
+user of the system can use this time to cancel the shutdown.
+</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry>
+<term>-C message</term>
+<listitem><para>Display the specified message on the screen to
+announce the shutdown.</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+</variablelist>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RPC SAMDUMP</title>
+
+<para>Print out sam database of remote server. You need
+to run this against the PDC, from a Samba machine joined as a BDC. </para>
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RPC VAMPIRE</title>
+
+<para>Export users, aliases and groups from remote server to
+local server. You need to run this against the PDC, from a Samba machine joined as a BDC.
+</para>
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RPC VAMPIRE KEYTAB</title>
+
+<para>Dump remote SAM database to local Kerberos keytab file.
+</para>
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RPC VAMPIRE LDIF</title>
+
+<para>Dump remote SAM database to local LDIF file or standard output.
+</para>
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>RPC GETSID</title>
+
+<para>Fetch domain SID and store it in the local <filename>secrets.tdb</filename>. </para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>ADS LEAVE</title>
+
+<para>Make the remote host leave the domain it is part of. </para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>ADS STATUS</title>
+
+<para>Print out status of machine account of the local machine in ADS.
+Prints out quite some debug info. Aimed at developers, regular
+users should use <command>NET ADS TESTJOIN</command>.</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>ADS PRINTER</title>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>ADS PRINTER INFO [<replaceable>PRINTER</replaceable>] [<replaceable>SERVER</replaceable>]</title>
+
+<para>
+Lookup info for <replaceable>PRINTER</replaceable> on <replaceable>SERVER</replaceable>. The printer name defaults to "*", the
+server name defaults to the local host.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>ADS PRINTER PUBLISH <replaceable>PRINTER</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Publish specified printer using ADS.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>ADS PRINTER REMOVE <replaceable>PRINTER</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Remove specified printer from ADS directory.</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>ADS SEARCH <replaceable>EXPRESSION</replaceable> <replaceable>ATTRIBUTES...</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>Perform a raw LDAP search on a ADS server and dump the results. The
+expression is a standard LDAP search expression, and the
+attributes are a list of LDAP fields to show in the results.</para>
+
+<para>Example: <userinput>net ads search '(objectCategory=group)' sAMAccountName</userinput>
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>ADS DN <replaceable>DN</replaceable> <replaceable>(attributes)</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Perform a raw LDAP search on a ADS server and dump the results. The
+DN standard LDAP DN, and the attributes are a list of LDAP fields
+to show in the result.
+</para>
+
+<para>Example: <userinput>net ads dn 'CN=administrator,CN=Users,DC=my,DC=domain' SAMAccountName</userinput></para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>ADS WORKGROUP</title>
+
+<para>Print out workgroup name for specified kerberos realm.</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM CREATEBUILTINGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+(Re)Create a BUILTIN group.
+Only a wellknown set of BUILTIN groups can be created with this command.
+This is the list of currently recognized group names: Administrators,
+Users, Guests, Power Users, Account Operators, Server Operators, Print
+Operators, Backup Operators, Replicator, RAS Servers, Pre-Windows 2000
+compatible Access.
+
+This command requires a running Winbindd with idmap allocation properly
+configured. The group gid will be allocated out of the winbindd range.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM CREATELOCALGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Create a LOCAL group (also known as Alias).
+
+This command requires a running Winbindd with idmap allocation properly
+configured. The group gid will be allocated out of the winbindd range.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM DELETELOCALGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Delete an existing LOCAL group (also known as Alias).
+
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM MAPUNIXGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Map an existing Unix group and make it a Domain Group, the domain group
+will have the same name.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM UNMAPUNIXGROUP &lt;NAME&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Remove an existing group mapping entry.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM ADDMEM &lt;GROUP&gt; &lt;MEMBER&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Add a member to a Local group. The group can be specified only by name,
+the member can be specified by name or SID.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM DELMEM &lt;GROUP&gt; &lt;MEMBER&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Remove a member from a Local group. The group and the member must be
+specified by name.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM LISTMEM &lt;GROUP&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+List Local group members. The group must be specified by name.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM LIST &lt;users|groups|localgroups|builtin|workstations&gt; [verbose]</title>
+
+<para>
+List the specified set of accounts by name. If verbose is specified,
+the rid and description is also provided for each account.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM RIGHTS LIST</title>
+
+<para>
+List all available privileges.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM RIGHTS GRANT &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;PRIVILEGE&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Grant one or more privileges to a user.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM RIGHTS REVOKE &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;PRIVILEGE&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Revoke one or more privileges from a user.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM SHOW &lt;NAME&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Show the full DOMAIN\\NAME the SID and the type for the corresponding
+account.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM SET HOMEDIR &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;DIRECTORY&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Set the home directory for a user account.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM SET PROFILEPATH &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;PATH&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Set the profile path for a user account.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM SET COMMENT &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;COMMENT&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Set the comment for a user or group account.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM SET FULLNAME &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;FULL NAME&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Set the full name for a user account.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM SET LOGONSCRIPT &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;SCRIPT&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Set the logon script for a user account.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM SET HOMEDRIVE &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;DRIVE&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Set the home drive for a user account.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM SET WORKSTATIONS &lt;NAME&gt; &lt;WORKSTATIONS&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Set the workstations a user account is allowed to log in from.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM SET DISABLE &lt;NAME&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Set the "disabled" flag for a user account.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM SET PWNOTREQ &lt;NAME&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Set the "password not required" flag for a user account.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM SET AUTOLOCK &lt;NAME&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Set the "autolock" flag for a user account.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM SET PWNOEXP &lt;NAME&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Set the "password do not expire" flag for a user account.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM SET PWDMUSTCHANGENOW &lt;NAME&gt; [yes|no]</title>
+
+<para>
+Set or unset the "password must change" flag for a user account.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM POLICY LIST</title>
+
+<para>
+List the available account policies.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM POLICY SHOW &lt;account policy&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Show the account policy value.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM POLICY SET &lt;account policy&gt; &lt;value&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Set a value for the account policy.
+Valid values can be: "forever", "never", "off", or a number.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>SAM PROVISION</title>
+
+<para>
+Only available if ldapsam:editposix is set and winbindd is running.
+Properly populates the ldap tree with the basic accounts (Administrator)
+and groups (Domain Users, Domain Admins, Domain Guests) on the ldap tree.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>IDMAP DUMP &lt;local tdb file name&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Dumps the mappings contained in the local tdb file specified.
+This command is useful to dump only the mappings produced by the idmap_tdb backend.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>IDMAP RESTORE [input file]</title>
+
+<para>
+Restore the mappings from the specified file or stdin.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>IDMAP SECRET &lt;DOMAIN&gt; &lt;secret&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Store a secret for the specified domain, used primarily for domains
+that use idmap_ldap as a backend. In this case the secret is used
+as the password for the user DN used to bind to the ldap server.
+</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+
+<title>IDMAP DELETE [-f] [--db=&lt;DB&gt;] &lt;ID&gt;</title>
+
+<para>
+Delete a mapping sid &lt;-&gt; gid or sid &lt;-&gt; uid from the IDMAP database.
+The mapping is given by &lt;ID&gt; which may either be a sid: S-x-..., a gid: "GID number" or a uid: "UID number".
+Use -f to delete an invalid partial mapping &lt;ID&gt; -&gt; xx
+</para>
+<para>
+ Use "smbcontrol all idmap ..." to notify running smbd instances.
+ See the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbcontrol</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> manpage for details.
+</para>
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+
+<title>IDMAP CHECK [-v] [-r] [-a] [-T] [-f] [-l] [--db=&lt;DB&gt;]</title>
+
+<para>
+ Check and repair the IDMAP database. If no option is given a read only check
+ of the database is done. Among others an interactive or automatic repair mode
+ may be chosen with one of the following options:
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>-r|--repair</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Interactive repair mode, ask a lot of questions.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>-a|--auto</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Noninteractive repair mode, use default answers.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>-v|--verbose</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Produce more output.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>-f|--force</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Try to apply changes, even if they do not apply cleanly.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>-T|--test</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Dry run, show what changes would be made but don't touch anything.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>-l|--lock</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Lock the database while doing the check.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>--db &lt;DB&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Check the specified database.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term></term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ It reports about the finding of the following errors:
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>Missing reverse mapping:</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ A record with mapping A-&gt;B where there is no B-&gt;A. Default action
+ in repair mode is to "fix" this by adding the reverse mapping.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>Invalid mapping:</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ A record with mapping A-&gt;B where B-&gt;C. Default action
+ is to "delete" this record.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>Missing or invalid HWM:</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ A high water mark is not at least equal to the largest ID in the
+ database. Default action is to "fix" this by setting it to the
+ largest ID found +1.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>Invalid record:</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Something we failed to parse. Default action is to "edit" it
+ in interactive and "delete" it in automatic mode.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+</variablelist>
+</para>
+</refsect2>
+
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>USERSHARE</title>
+
+<para>Starting with version 3.0.23, a Samba server now supports the ability for
+non-root users to add user defined shares to be exported using the "net usershare"
+commands.
+</para>
+
+<para>
+To set this up, first set up your smb.conf by adding to the [global] section:
+
+usershare path = /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
+
+Next create the directory /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares, change the owner to root and
+set the group owner to the UNIX group who should have the ability to create usershares,
+for example a group called "serverops".
+
+Set the permissions on /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares to 01770.
+
+(Owner and group all access, no access for others, plus the sticky bit,
+which means that a file in that directory can be renamed or deleted only
+by the owner of the file).
+
+Finally, tell smbd how many usershares you will allow by adding to the [global]
+section of smb.conf a line such as :
+
+usershare max shares = 100.
+
+To allow 100 usershare definitions. Now, members of the UNIX group "serverops"
+can create user defined shares on demand using the commands below.
+</para>
+
+<para>The usershare commands are:
+
+<simplelist>
+<member>net usershare add sharename path [comment [acl] [guest_ok=[y|n]]] - to add or change a user defined share.</member>
+<member>net usershare delete sharename - to delete a user defined share.</member>
+<member>net usershare info [-l|--long] [wildcard sharename] - to print info about a user defined share.</member>
+<member>net usershare list [-l|--long] [wildcard sharename] - to list user defined shares.</member>
+</simplelist>
+
+</para>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>USERSHARE ADD <replaceable>sharename</replaceable> <replaceable>path</replaceable> <replaceable>[comment]</replaceable> <replaceable>[acl]</replaceable> <replaceable>[guest_ok=[y|n]]</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Add or replace a new user defined share, with name "sharename".
+</para>
+
+<para>
+"path" specifies the absolute pathname on the system to be exported.
+Restrictions may be put on this, see the global smb.conf parameters:
+"usershare owner only", "usershare prefix allow list", and
+"usershare prefix deny list".
+</para>
+
+<para>
+The optional "comment" parameter is the comment that will appear
+on the share when browsed to by a client.
+</para>
+
+<para>The optional "acl" field
+specifies which users have read and write access to the entire share.
+Note that guest connections are not allowed unless the smb.conf parameter
+"usershare allow guests" has been set. The definition of a user
+defined share acl is: "user:permission", where user is a valid
+username on the system and permission can be "F", "R", or "D".
+"F" stands for "full permissions", ie. read and write permissions.
+"D" stands for "deny" for a user, ie. prevent this user from accessing
+this share.
+"R" stands for "read only", ie. only allow read access to this
+share (no creation of new files or directories or writing to files).
+</para>
+
+<para>
+The default if no "acl" is given is "Everyone:R", which means any
+authenticated user has read-only access.
+</para>
+
+<para>
+The optional "guest_ok" has the same effect as the parameter of the
+same name in smb.conf, in that it allows guest access to this user
+defined share. This parameter is only allowed if the global parameter
+"usershare allow guests" has been set to true in the smb.conf.
+</para>
+
+There is no separate command to modify an existing user defined share,
+just use the "net usershare add [sharename]" command using the same
+sharename as the one you wish to modify and specify the new options
+you wish. The Samba smbd daemon notices user defined share modifications
+at connect time so will see the change immediately, there is no need
+to restart smbd on adding, deleting or changing a user defined share.
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>USERSHARE DELETE <replaceable>sharename</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Deletes the user defined share by name. The Samba smbd daemon
+immediately notices this change, although it will not disconnect
+any users currently connected to the deleted share.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>USERSHARE INFO <replaceable>[-l|--long]</replaceable> <replaceable>[wildcard sharename]</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Get info on user defined shares owned by the current user matching the given pattern, or all users.
+</para>
+
+<para>
+net usershare info on its own dumps out info on the user defined shares that were
+created by the current user, or restricts them to share names that match the given
+wildcard pattern ('*' matches one or more characters, '?' matches only one character).
+If the '-l' or '--long' option is also given, it prints out info on user defined
+shares created by other users.
+</para>
+
+<para>
+The information given about a share looks like:
+
+[foobar]
+path=/home/jeremy
+comment=testme
+usershare_acl=Everyone:F
+guest_ok=n
+
+And is a list of the current settings of the user defined share that can be
+modified by the "net usershare add" command.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>USERSHARE LIST <replaceable>[-l|--long]</replaceable> <replaceable>wildcard sharename</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+List all the user defined shares owned by the current user matching the given pattern, or all users.
+</para>
+
+<para>
+net usershare list on its own list out the names of the user defined shares that were
+created by the current user, or restricts the list to share names that match the given
+wildcard pattern ('*' matches one or more characters, '?' matches only one character).
+If the '-l' or '--long' option is also given, it includes the names of user defined
+shares created by other users.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>[RPC] CONF</title>
+
+<para>Starting with version 3.2.0, a Samba server can be configured by data
+stored in registry. This configuration data can be edited with the new "net
+conf" commands. There is also the possiblity to configure a remote Samba server
+by enabling the RPC conf mode and specifying the the address of the remote server.
+</para>
+
+<para>
+The deployment of this configuration data can be activated in two levels from the
+<emphasis>smb.conf</emphasis> file: Share definitions from registry are
+activated by setting <parameter>registry shares</parameter> to
+<quote>yes</quote> in the [global] section and global configuration options are
+activated by setting <smbconfoption name="include">registry</smbconfoption> in
+the [global] section for a mixed configuration or by setting
+<smbconfoption name="config backend">registry</smbconfoption> in the [global]
+section for a registry-only configuration.
+See the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+<manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> manpage for details.
+</para>
+
+<para>The conf commands are:
+<simplelist>
+<member>net [rpc] conf list - Dump the complete configuration in smb.conf like
+format.</member>
+<member>net [rpc] conf import - Import configuration from file in smb.conf
+format.</member>
+<member>net [rpc] conf listshares - List the registry shares.</member>
+<member>net [rpc] conf drop - Delete the complete configuration from
+registry.</member>
+<member>net [rpc] conf showshare - Show the definition of a registry share.</member>
+<member>net [rpc] conf addshare - Create a new registry share.</member>
+<member>net [rpc] conf delshare - Delete a registry share.</member>
+<member>net [rpc] conf setparm - Store a parameter.</member>
+<member>net [rpc] conf getparm - Retrieve the value of a parameter.</member>
+<member>net [rpc] conf delparm - Delete a parameter.</member>
+<member>net [rpc] conf getincludes - Show the includes of a share definition.</member>
+<member>net [rpc] conf setincludes - Set includes for a share.</member>
+<member>net [rpc] conf delincludes - Delete includes from a share definition.</member>
+</simplelist>
+</para>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC] CONF LIST</title>
+
+<para>
+Print the configuration data stored in the registry in a smb.conf-like format to
+standard output.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC] CONF IMPORT <replaceable>[--test|-T]</replaceable> <replaceable>filename</replaceable> <replaceable>[section]</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+This command imports configuration from a file in smb.conf format.
+If a section encountered in the input file is present in registry,
+its contents is replaced. Sections of registry configuration that have
+no counterpart in the input file are not affected. If you want to delete these,
+you will have to use the "net conf drop" or "net conf delshare" commands.
+Optionally, a section may be specified to restrict the effect of the
+import command to that specific section. A test mode is enabled by specifying
+the parameter "-T" on the commandline. In test mode, no changes are made to the
+registry, and the resulting configuration is printed to standard output instead.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC] CONF LISTSHARES</title>
+
+<para>
+List the names of the shares defined in registry.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC] CONF DROP</title>
+
+<para>
+Delete the complete configuration data from registry.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC] CONF SHOWSHARE <replaceable>sharename</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Show the definition of the share or section specified. It is valid to specify
+"global" as sharename to retrieve the global configuration options from
+registry.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC] CONF ADDSHARE <replaceable>sharename</replaceable> <replaceable>path</replaceable> [<replaceable>writeable={y|N}</replaceable> [<replaceable>guest_ok={y|N}</replaceable> [<replaceable>comment</replaceable>]]] </title>
+
+<para>Create a new share definition in registry.
+The sharename and path have to be given. The share name may
+<emphasis>not</emphasis> be "global". Optionally, values for the very
+common options "writeable", "guest ok" and a "comment" may be specified.
+The same result may be obtained by a sequence of "net conf setparm"
+commands.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC] CONF DELSHARE <replaceable>sharename</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Delete a share definition from registry.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC] CONF SETPARM <replaceable>section</replaceable> <replaceable>parameter</replaceable> <replaceable>value</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Store a parameter in registry. The section may be global or a sharename.
+The section is created if it does not exist yet.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC] CONF GETPARM <replaceable>section</replaceable> <replaceable>parameter</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Show a parameter stored in registry.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC] CONF DELPARM <replaceable>section</replaceable> <replaceable>parameter</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Delete a parameter stored in registry.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC] CONF GETINCLUDES <replaceable>section</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Get the list of includes for the provided section (global or share).
+</para>
+
+<para>
+Note that due to the nature of the registry database and the nature of include directives,
+the includes need special treatment: Parameters are stored in registry by the parameter
+name as valuename, so there is only ever one instance of a parameter per share.
+Also, a specific order like in a text file is not guaranteed. For all real
+parameters, this is perfectly ok, but the include directive is rather a meta
+parameter, for which, in the smb.conf text file, the place where it is specified
+between the other parameters is very important. This can not be achieved by the
+simple registry smbconf data model, so there is one ordered list of includes
+per share, and this list is evaluated after all the parameters of the share.
+</para>
+
+<para>
+Further note that currently, only files can be included from registry
+configuration. In the future, there will be the ability to include configuration
+data from other registry keys.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC] CONF SETINCLUDES <replaceable>section</replaceable> [<replaceable>filename</replaceable>]+</title>
+
+<para>
+Set the list of includes for the provided section (global or share) to the given
+list of one or more filenames. The filenames may contain the usual smb.conf
+macros like %I.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>[RPC] CONF DELINCLUDES <replaceable>section</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Delete the list of includes from the provided section (global or share).
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>REGISTRY</title>
+<para>
+Manipulate Samba's registry.
+</para>
+
+<para>The registry commands are:
+<simplelist>
+<member>net registry enumerate - Enumerate registry keys and values.</member>
+<member>net registry enumerate_recursive - Enumerate registry key and its subkeys.</member>
+<member>net registry createkey - Create a new registry key.</member>
+<member>net registry deletekey - Delete a registry key.</member>
+<member>net registry deletekey_recursive - Delete a registry key with subkeys.</member>
+<member>net registry getvalue - Print a registry value.</member>
+<member>net registry getvalueraw - Print a registry value (raw format).</member>
+<member>net registry setvalue - Set a new registry value.</member>
+<member>net registry increment - Increment a DWORD registry value under a lock.
+</member>
+<member>net registry deletevalue - Delete a registry value.</member>
+<member>net registry getsd - Get security descriptor.</member>
+<member>net registry getsd_sdd1 - Get security descriptor in sddl format.
+</member>
+<member>net registry setsd_sdd1 - Set security descriptor from sddl format
+string.</member>
+<member>net registry import - Import a registration entries (.reg) file.
+</member>
+<member>net registry export - Export a registration entries (.reg) file.
+</member>
+<member>net registry convert - Convert a registration entries (.reg) file.
+</member>
+<member>net registry check - Check and reapair a registry database.
+</member>
+</simplelist>
+</para>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY ENUMERATE <replaceable>key</replaceable> </title>
+ <para>Enumerate subkeys and values of <emphasis>key</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY ENUMERATE_RECURSIVE <replaceable>key</replaceable> </title>
+ <para>Enumerate values of <emphasis>key</emphasis> and its subkeys.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY CREATEKEY <replaceable>key</replaceable> </title>
+ <para>Create a new <emphasis>key</emphasis> if not yet existing.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY DELETEKEY <replaceable>key</replaceable> </title>
+ <para>Delete the given <emphasis>key</emphasis> and its
+ values from the registry, if it has no subkeys.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY DELETEKEY_RECURSIVE <replaceable>key</replaceable> </title>
+ <para>Delete the given <emphasis>key</emphasis> and all of its
+ subkeys and values from the registry.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY GETVALUE <replaceable>key</replaceable> <!--
+ --><replaceable>name</replaceable></title>
+
+ <para>Output type and actual value of the value <emphasis>name</emphasis>
+ of the given <emphasis>key</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY GETVALUERAW <replaceable>key</replaceable> <!--
+ --><replaceable>name</replaceable></title>
+ <para>Output the actual value of the value <emphasis>name</emphasis>
+ of the given <emphasis>key</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY SETVALUE <replaceable>key</replaceable> <!--
+ --><replaceable>name</replaceable> <replaceable>type</replaceable> <!--
+ --><replaceable>value</replaceable> ...<!--
+ --></title>
+
+ <para>Set the value <emphasis>name</emphasis>
+ of an existing <emphasis>key</emphasis>.
+ <emphasis>type</emphasis> may be one of
+ <emphasis>sz</emphasis>, <emphasis>multi_sz</emphasis> or
+ <emphasis>dword</emphasis>.
+ In case of <emphasis>multi_sz</emphasis> <replaceable>value</replaceable> may
+ be given multiple times.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY INCREMENT <replaceable>key</replaceable> <!--
+ --><replaceable>name</replaceable> <replaceable>[inc]</replaceable><!--
+ --></title>
+
+ <para>Increment the DWORD value <emphasis>name</emphasis>
+ of <emphasis>key</emphasis> by <replaceable>inc</replaceable>
+ while holding a g_lock.
+ <emphasis>inc</emphasis> defaults to 1.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY DELETEVALUE <replaceable>key</replaceable> <!--
+ --><replaceable>name</replaceable></title>
+
+ <para>Delete the value <emphasis>name</emphasis>
+ of the given <emphasis>key</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY GETSD <replaceable>key</replaceable></title>
+
+ <para>Get the security descriptor of the given <emphasis>key</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY GETSD_SDDL <replaceable>key</replaceable></title>
+
+ <para>Get the security descriptor of the given <emphasis>key</emphasis> as a
+ Security Descriptor Definition Language (SDDL) string.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY SETSD_SDDL <replaceable>key</replaceable><!--
+ --><replaceable>sd</replaceable></title>
+
+ <para>Set the security descriptor of the given <emphasis>key</emphasis> from a
+ Security Descriptor Definition Language (SDDL) string <emphasis>sd</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY IMPORT <replaceable>file</replaceable><!--
+ --><replaceable> [--precheck &lt;check-file&gt;] [opt]</replaceable></title>
+ <para>Import a registration entries (.reg) <emphasis>file</emphasis>.</para>
+ <para>The following options are available:</para>
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>--precheck <replaceable>check-file</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ This is a mechanism to check the existence or non-existence of
+ certain keys or values specified in a precheck file before applying
+ the import file.
+ The import file will only be applied if the precheck succeeds.
+ </para>
+ <para>
+ The check-file follows the normal registry file syntax with the
+ following semantics:
+ </para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>&lt;value name&gt;=&lt;value&gt; checks whether the
+ value exists and has the given value.</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>&lt;value name&gt;=- checks whether the value does
+ not exist.</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>[key] checks whether the key exists.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem><para>[-key] checks whether the key does not exist.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY EXPORT <replaceable>key</replaceable><!--
+ --><replaceable>file</replaceable><!--
+ --><replaceable>[opt]</replaceable></title>
+
+ <para>Export a <emphasis>key</emphasis> to a registration entries (.reg)
+ <emphasis>file</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY CONVERT <replaceable>in</replaceable> <!--
+ --><replaceable>out</replaceable> <!--
+ --><replaceable>[[inopt] outopt]</replaceable></title>
+
+ <para>Convert a registration entries (.reg) file <emphasis>in</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>REGISTRY CHECK [-ravTl] [-o &lt;ODB&gt;] [--wipe] [&lt;DB&gt;]</title>
+ <para>Check and repair the registry database. If no option is given a read only check of the database is done. Among others an interactive or automatic repair mode may be chosen with one of the following options
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>-r|--repair</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Interactive repair mode, ask a lot of questions.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>-a|--auto</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Noninteractive repair mode, use default answers.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>-v|--verbose</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Produce more output.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>-T|--test</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Dry run, show what changes would be made but don't touch anything.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>-l|--lock</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Lock the database while doing the check.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>--reg-version={1,2,3}</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Specify the format of the registry database. If not given it defaults to
+ the value of the binary or, if an registry.tdb is explizitly stated at
+ the commandline, to the value found in the INFO/version record.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>[--db] &lt;DB&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Check the specified database.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>-o|--output &lt;ODB&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Create a new registry database &lt;ODB&gt; instead of modifying the
+ input. If &lt;ODB&gt; is already existing --wipe may be used to
+ overwrite it.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>--wipe</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Replace the registry database instead of modifying the input or
+ overwrite an existing output database.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term></term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>CONNECTIONS</title>
+<para>
+Manipulate Samba's connections database.
+</para>
+
+<para>The registry commands are:
+<simplelist>
+<member>net connections cleanup - Remove orphaned entries from the connections database.</member>
+</simplelist>
+</para>
+
+<refsect3>
+ <title>CONNECTIONS CLEANUP [-avT]</title>
+ <para> Remove orphaned entries from the connections database. This may be necessary if restarting smbd isn't an option.
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>-a|--auto</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Noninteractive mode, don't ask.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>-v|--verbose</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Produce more output.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>-T|--test</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Dry run, show what changes would be made but don't touch anything.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+ </para>
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>EVENTLOG</title>
+
+<para>Starting with version 3.4.0 net can read, dump, import and export native
+win32 eventlog files (usually *.evt). evt files are used by the native Windows eventviewer tools.
+</para>
+
+<para>
+The import and export of evt files can only succeed when <parameter>eventlog list</parameter> is used in
+<emphasis>smb.conf</emphasis> file.
+See the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> manpage for details.
+</para>
+
+<para>The eventlog commands are:
+<simplelist>
+<member>net eventlog dump - Dump a eventlog *.evt file on the screen.</member>
+<member>net eventlog import - Import a eventlog *.evt into the samba internal
+tdb based representation of eventlogs.</member>
+<member>net eventlog export - Export the samba internal tdb based representation
+of eventlogs into an eventlog *.evt file.</member>
+</simplelist>
+</para>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>EVENTLOG DUMP <replaceable>filename</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Prints a eventlog *.evt file to standard output.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>EVENTLOG IMPORT <replaceable>filename</replaceable> <replaceable>eventlog</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Imports a eventlog *.evt file defined by <replaceable>filename</replaceable> into the
+samba internal tdb representation of eventlog defined by <replaceable>eventlog</replaceable>.
+<replaceable>eventlog</replaceable> needs to part of the <parameter>eventlog list</parameter>
+defined in smb.conf.
+See the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> manpage for details.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>EVENTLOG EXPORT <replaceable>filename</replaceable> <replaceable>eventlog</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Exports the samba internal tdb representation of eventlog defined by <replaceable>eventlog</replaceable>
+to a eventlog *.evt file defined by <replaceable>filename</replaceable>.
+<replaceable>eventlog</replaceable> needs to part of the <parameter>eventlog list</parameter>
+defined in smb.conf.
+See the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> manpage for details.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>DOM</title>
+
+<para>Starting with version 3.2.0 Samba has support for remote join and unjoin APIs, both client and server-side. Windows supports remote join capabilities since Windows 2000.
+</para>
+<para>In order for Samba to be joined or unjoined remotely an account must be used that is either member of the Domain Admins group, a member of the local Administrators group or a user that is granted the SeMachineAccountPrivilege privilege.
+</para>
+
+<para>The client side support for remote join is implemented in the net dom commands which are:
+<simplelist>
+<member>net dom join - Join a remote computer into a domain.</member>
+<member>net dom unjoin - Unjoin a remote computer from a domain.</member>
+<member>net dom renamecomputer - Renames a remote computer joined to a domain.</member>
+</simplelist>
+</para>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>DOM JOIN <replaceable>domain=DOMAIN</replaceable> <replaceable>ou=OU</replaceable> <replaceable>account=ACCOUNT</replaceable> <replaceable>password=PASSWORD</replaceable> <replaceable>reboot</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Joins a computer into a domain. This command supports the following additional parameters:
+</para>
+
+<itemizedlist>
+
+<listitem><para><replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable> can be a NetBIOS domain name (also known as short domain name) or a DNS domain name for Active Directory Domains. As in Windows, it is also possible to control which Domain Controller to use. This can be achieved by appending the DC name using the \ separator character. Example: MYDOM\MYDC. The <replaceable>DOMAIN</replaceable> parameter cannot be NULL.</para></listitem>
+
+<listitem><para><replaceable>OU</replaceable> can be set to a RFC 1779 LDAP DN, like <emphasis>ou=mymachines,cn=Users,dc=example,dc=com</emphasis> in order to create the machine account in a non-default LDAP container. This optional parameter is only supported when joining Active Directory Domains.</para></listitem>
+
+<listitem><para><replaceable>ACCOUNT</replaceable> defines a domain account that will be used to join the machine to the domain. This domain account needs to have sufficient privileges to join machines.</para></listitem>
+
+<listitem><para><replaceable>PASSWORD</replaceable> defines the password for the domain account defined with <replaceable>ACCOUNT</replaceable>.</para></listitem>
+
+<listitem><para><replaceable>REBOOT</replaceable> is an optional parameter that can be set to reboot the remote machine after successful join to the domain.</para></listitem>
+
+</itemizedlist>
+
+<para>
+Note that you also need to use standard net parameters to connect and authenticate to the remote machine that you want to join. These additional parameters include: -S computer and -U user.
+</para>
+<para>
+ Example:
+ net dom join -S xp -U XP\\administrator%secret domain=MYDOM account=MYDOM\\administrator password=topsecret reboot.
+</para>
+<para>
+This example would connect to a computer named XP as the local administrator using password secret, and join the computer into a domain called MYDOM using the MYDOM domain administrator account and password topsecret. After successful join, the computer would reboot.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>DOM UNJOIN <replaceable>account=ACCOUNT</replaceable> <replaceable>password=PASSWORD</replaceable> <replaceable>reboot</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Unjoins a computer from a domain. This command supports the following additional parameters:
+</para>
+
+<itemizedlist>
+
+<listitem><para><replaceable>ACCOUNT</replaceable> defines a domain account that will be used to unjoin the machine from the domain. This domain account needs to have sufficient privileges to unjoin machines.</para></listitem>
+
+<listitem><para><replaceable>PASSWORD</replaceable> defines the password for the domain account defined with <replaceable>ACCOUNT</replaceable>.</para></listitem>
+
+<listitem><para><replaceable>REBOOT</replaceable> is an optional parameter that can be set to reboot the remote machine after successful unjoin from the domain.</para></listitem>
+
+</itemizedlist>
+
+<para>
+Note that you also need to use standard net parameters to connect and authenticate to the remote machine that you want to unjoin. These additional parameters include: -S computer and -U user.
+</para>
+<para>
+ Example:
+ net dom unjoin -S xp -U XP\\administrator%secret account=MYDOM\\administrator password=topsecret reboot.
+</para>
+<para>
+This example would connect to a computer named XP as the local administrator using password secret, and unjoin the computer from the domain using the MYDOM domain administrator account and password topsecret. After successful unjoin, the computer would reboot.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>DOM RENAMECOMPUTER <replaceable>newname=NEWNAME</replaceable> <replaceable>account=ACCOUNT</replaceable> <replaceable>password=PASSWORD</replaceable> <replaceable>reboot</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Renames a computer that is joined to a domain. This command supports the following additional parameters:
+</para>
+
+<itemizedlist>
+
+<listitem><para><replaceable>NEWNAME</replaceable> defines the new name of the machine in the domain.</para></listitem>
+
+<listitem><para><replaceable>ACCOUNT</replaceable> defines a domain account that will be used to rename the machine in the domain. This domain account needs to have sufficient privileges to rename machines.</para></listitem>
+
+<listitem><para><replaceable>PASSWORD</replaceable> defines the password for the domain account defined with <replaceable>ACCOUNT</replaceable>.</para></listitem>
+
+<listitem><para><replaceable>REBOOT</replaceable> is an optional parameter that can be set to reboot the remote machine after successful rename in the domain.</para></listitem>
+
+</itemizedlist>
+
+<para>
+Note that you also need to use standard net parameters to connect and authenticate to the remote machine that you want to rename in the domain. These additional parameters include: -S computer and -U user.
+</para>
+<para>
+ Example:
+ net dom renamecomputer -S xp -U XP\\administrator%secret newname=XPNEW account=MYDOM\\administrator password=topsecret reboot.
+</para>
+<para>
+This example would connect to a computer named XP as the local administrator using password secret, and rename the joined computer to XPNEW using the MYDOM domain administrator account and password topsecret. After successful rename, the computer would reboot.
+</para>
+
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>G_LOCK</title>
+
+<para>Manage global locks.</para>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>G_LOCK DO <replaceable>lockname</replaceable> <replaceable>timeout</replaceable> <replaceable>command</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Execute a shell command under a global lock. This might be useful to define the
+order in which several shell commands will be executed. The locking information
+is stored in a file called <filename>g_lock.tdb</filename>. In setups with CTDB
+running, the locking information will be available on all cluster nodes.
+</para>
+
+<itemizedlist>
+<listitem><para><replaceable>LOCKNAME</replaceable> defines the name of the global lock.</para></listitem>
+<listitem><para><replaceable>TIMEOUT</replaceable> defines the timeout.</para></listitem>
+<listitem><para><replaceable>COMMAND</replaceable> defines the shell command to execute.</para></listitem>
+</itemizedlist>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>G_LOCK LOCKS</title>
+
+<para>
+Print a list of all currently existing locknames.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+<refsect3>
+<title>G_LOCK DUMP <replaceable>lockname</replaceable></title>
+
+<para>
+Dump the locking table of a certain global lock.
+</para>
+</refsect3>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+<refsect2>
+<title>HELP [COMMAND]</title>
+
+<para>Gives usage information for the specified command.</para>
+
+</refsect2>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is complete for version 3 of the Samba
+ suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The net manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/nmbd.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/nmbd.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..43a367fe6f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/nmbd.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,294 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="nmbd.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>nmbd</refname>
+ <refpurpose>NetBIOS name server to provide NetBIOS
+ over IP naming services to clients</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>nmbd</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-D</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-F</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-S</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-a</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-i</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-o</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-V</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d &lt;debug level&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-H &lt;lmhosts file&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-l &lt;log directory&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-p &lt;port number&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+ <para>This program is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>nmbd</command> is a server that understands
+ and can reply to NetBIOS over IP name service requests, like
+ those produced by SMB/CIFS clients such as Windows 95/98/ME,
+ Windows NT, Windows 2000, Windows XP and LanManager clients. It also
+ participates in the browsing protocols which make up the
+ Windows "Network Neighborhood" view.</para>
+
+ <para>SMB/CIFS clients, when they start up, may wish to
+ locate an SMB/CIFS server. That is, they wish to know what
+ IP number a specified host is using.</para>
+
+ <para>Amongst other services, <command>nmbd</command> will
+ listen for such requests, and if its own NetBIOS name is
+ specified it will respond with the IP number of the host it
+ is running on. Its "own NetBIOS name" is by
+ default the primary DNS name of the host it is running on,
+ but this can be overridden by the <smbconfoption name="netbios name"/>
+ in &smb.conf;. Thus <command>nmbd</command> will
+ reply to broadcast queries for its own name(s). Additional
+ names for <command>nmbd</command> to respond on can be set
+ via parameters in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> configuration file.</para>
+
+ <para><command>nmbd</command> can also be used as a WINS
+ (Windows Internet Name Server) server. What this basically means
+ is that it will act as a WINS database server, creating a
+ database from name registration requests that it receives and
+ replying to queries from clients for these names.</para>
+
+ <para>In addition, <command>nmbd</command> can act as a WINS
+ proxy, relaying broadcast queries from clients that do
+ not understand how to talk the WINS protocol to a WINS
+ server.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-D</term>
+ <listitem><para>If specified, this parameter causes
+ <command>nmbd</command> to operate as a daemon. That is,
+ it detaches itself and runs in the background, fielding
+ requests on the appropriate port. By default, <command>nmbd</command>
+ will operate as a daemon if launched from a command shell.
+ nmbd can also be operated from the <command>inetd</command>
+ meta-daemon, although this is not recommended.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-F</term>
+ <listitem><para>If specified, this parameter causes
+ the main <command>nmbd</command> process to not daemonize,
+ i.e. double-fork and disassociate with the terminal.
+ Child processes are still created as normal to service
+ each connection request, but the main process does not
+ exit. This operation mode is suitable for running
+ <command>nmbd</command> under process supervisors such
+ as <command>supervise</command> and <command>svscan</command>
+ from Daniel J. Bernstein's <command>daemontools</command>
+ package, or the AIX process monitor.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-S</term>
+ <listitem><para>If specified, this parameter causes
+ <command>nmbd</command> to log to standard output rather
+ than a file.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-i</term>
+ <listitem><para>If this parameter is specified it causes the
+ server to run "interactively", not as a daemon, even if the
+ server is executed on the command line of a shell. Setting this
+ parameter negates the implicit daemon mode when run from the
+ command line. <command>nmbd</command> also logs to standard
+ output, as if the <constant>-S</constant> parameter had been
+ given. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.help;
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-H &lt;filename&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>NetBIOS lmhosts file. The lmhosts
+ file is a list of NetBIOS names to IP addresses that
+ is loaded by the nmbd server and used via the name
+ resolution mechanism <smbconfoption name="name resolve order"/> described in <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> to resolve any
+ NetBIOS name queries needed by the server. Note
+ that the contents of this file are <emphasis>NOT</emphasis>
+ used by <command>nmbd</command> to answer any name queries.
+ Adding a line to this file affects name NetBIOS resolution
+ from this host <emphasis>ONLY</emphasis>.</para>
+
+ <para>The default path to this file is compiled into
+ Samba as part of the build process. Common defaults
+ are <filename>/usr/local/samba/lib/lmhosts</filename>,
+ <filename>/usr/samba/lib/lmhosts</filename> or
+ <filename>/etc/samba/lmhosts</filename>. See the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>lmhosts</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> man page for details on the contents of this file.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-p &lt;UDP port number&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>UDP port number is a positive integer value.
+ This option changes the default UDP port number (normally 137)
+ that <command>nmbd</command> responds to name queries on. Don't
+ use this option unless you are an expert, in which case you
+ won't need help!</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>FILES</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><filename>/etc/inetd.conf</filename></term>
+ <listitem><para>If the server is to be run by the
+ <command>inetd</command> meta-daemon, this file
+ must contain suitable startup information for the
+ meta-daemon.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><filename>/etc/rc</filename></term>
+ <listitem><para>or whatever initialization script your
+ system uses).</para>
+
+ <para>If running the server as a daemon at startup,
+ this file will need to contain an appropriate startup
+ sequence for the server.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><filename>/etc/services</filename></term>
+ <listitem><para>If running the server via the
+ meta-daemon <command>inetd</command>, this file
+ must contain a mapping of service name (e.g., netbios-ssn)
+ to service port (e.g., 139) and protocol type (e.g., tcp).
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><filename>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</filename></term>
+ <listitem><para>This is the default location of
+ the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> server
+ configuration file. Other common places that systems
+ install this file are <filename>/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</filename>
+ and <filename>/etc/samba/smb.conf</filename>.</para>
+
+ <para>When run as a WINS server (see the
+ <smbconfoption name="wins support"/>
+ parameter in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> man page),
+ <command>nmbd</command>
+ will store the WINS database in the file <filename>wins.dat</filename>
+ in the <filename>var/locks</filename> directory configured under
+ wherever Samba was configured to install itself.</para>
+
+ <para>If <command>nmbd</command> is acting as a <emphasis>
+ browse master</emphasis> (see the <smbconfoption name="local master"/>
+ parameter in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> man page, <command>nmbd</command>
+ will store the browsing database in the file <filename>browse.dat
+ </filename> in the <filename>var/locks</filename> directory
+ configured under wherever Samba was configured to install itself.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SIGNALS</title>
+
+ <para>To shut down an <command>nmbd</command> process it is recommended
+ that SIGKILL (-9) <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> be used, except as a last
+ resort, as this may leave the name database in an inconsistent state.
+ The correct way to terminate <command>nmbd</command> is to send it
+ a SIGTERM (-15) signal and wait for it to die on its own.</para>
+
+ <para><command>nmbd</command> will accept SIGHUP, which will cause
+ it to dump out its namelists into the file <filename>namelist.debug
+ </filename> in the <filename>/usr/local/samba/var/locks</filename>
+ directory (or the <filename>var/locks</filename> directory configured
+ under wherever Samba was configured to install itself). This will also
+ cause <command>nmbd</command> to dump out its server database in
+ the <filename>log.nmb</filename> file.</para>
+
+ <para>The debug log level of nmbd may be raised or lowered
+ using <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbcontrol</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> (SIGUSR[1|2] signals
+ are no longer used since Samba 2.2). This is to allow
+ transient problems to be diagnosed, whilst still running
+ at a normally low log level.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para>
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>inetd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>testparm</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>testprns</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, and the Internet
+ RFC's <filename>rfc1001.txt</filename>, <filename>rfc1002.txt</filename>.
+ In addition the CIFS (formerly SMB) specification is available
+ as a link from the Web page <ulink noescape="1" url="http://samba.org/cifs/">
+ http://samba.org/cifs/</ulink>.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook
+ XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/nmblookup.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/nmblookup.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..465bba04db
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/nmblookup.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,223 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="nmblookup">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>nmblookup</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>nmblookup</refname>
+ <refpurpose>NetBIOS over TCP/IP client used to lookup NetBIOS
+ names</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>nmblookup</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-M</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-R</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-S</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-r</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-A</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-B &lt;broadcast address&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-U &lt;unicast address&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d &lt;debug level&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s &lt;smb config file&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-i &lt;NetBIOS scope&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-T</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-f</arg>
+ <arg choice="req">name</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>nmblookup</command> is used to query NetBIOS names
+ and map them to IP addresses in a network using NetBIOS over TCP/IP
+ queries. The options allow the name queries to be directed at a
+ particular IP broadcast area or to a particular machine. All queries
+ are done over UDP.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-M</term>
+ <listitem><para>Searches for a master browser by looking
+ up the NetBIOS name <replaceable>name</replaceable> with a
+ type of <constant>0x1d</constant>. If <replaceable>
+ name</replaceable> is "-" then it does a lookup on the special name
+ <constant>__MSBROWSE__</constant>. Please note that in order to
+ use the name "-", you need to make sure "-" isn't parsed as an
+ argument, e.g. use :
+ <userinput>nmblookup -M -- -</userinput>.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-R</term>
+ <listitem><para>Set the recursion desired bit in the packet
+ to do a recursive lookup. This is used when sending a name
+ query to a machine running a WINS server and the user wishes
+ to query the names in the WINS server. If this bit is unset
+ the normal (broadcast responding) NetBIOS processing code
+ on a machine is used instead. See RFC1001, RFC1002 for details.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-S</term>
+ <listitem><para>Once the name query has returned an IP
+ address then do a node status query as well. A node status
+ query returns the NetBIOS names registered by a host.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-r</term>
+ <listitem><para>Try and bind to UDP port 137 to send and receive UDP
+ datagrams. The reason for this option is a bug in Windows 95
+ where it ignores the source port of the requesting packet
+ and only replies to UDP port 137. Unfortunately, on most UNIX
+ systems root privilege is needed to bind to this port, and
+ in addition, if the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon is running on this machine it also binds to this port.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-A</term>
+ <listitem><para>Interpret <replaceable>name</replaceable> as
+ an IP Address and do a node status query on this address.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ &popt.common.connection;
+ &stdarg.help;
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-B &lt;broadcast address&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Send the query to the given broadcast address. Without
+ this option the default behavior of nmblookup is to send the
+ query to the broadcast address of the network interfaces as
+ either auto-detected or defined in the <ulink
+ url="smb.conf.5.html#INTERFACES"><parameter>interfaces</parameter>
+ </ulink> parameter of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-U &lt;unicast address&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Do a unicast query to the specified address or
+ host <replaceable>unicast address</replaceable>. This option
+ (along with the <parameter>-R</parameter> option) is needed to
+ query a WINS server.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-T</term>
+ <listitem><para>This causes any IP addresses found in the
+ lookup to be looked up via a reverse DNS lookup into a
+ DNS name, and printed out before each</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>IP address .... NetBIOS name</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para> pair that is the normal output.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-f</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Show which flags apply to the name that has been looked up. Possible
+ answers are zero or more of: Response, Authoritative,
+ Truncated, Recursion_Desired, Recursion_Available, Broadcast.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>name</term>
+ <listitem><para>This is the NetBIOS name being queried. Depending
+ upon the previous options this may be a NetBIOS name or IP address.
+ If a NetBIOS name then the different name types may be specified
+ by appending '#&lt;type&gt;' to the name. This name may also be
+ '*', which will return all registered names within a broadcast
+ area.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para><command>nmblookup</command> can be used to query
+ a WINS server (in the same way <command>nslookup</command> is
+ used to query DNS servers). To query a WINS server, <command>nmblookup</command>
+ must be called like this:</para>
+
+ <para><command>nmblookup -U server -R 'name'</command></para>
+
+ <para>For example, running :</para>
+
+ <para><command>nmblookup -U samba.org -R 'IRIX#1B'</command></para>
+
+ <para>would query the WINS server samba.org for the domain
+ master browser (1B name type) for the IRIX workgroup.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>, and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook
+ XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/ntlm_auth.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/ntlm_auth.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..dcf9b42503
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/ntlm_auth.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,409 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="ntlm-auth.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>ntlm_auth</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>ntlm_auth</refname>
+ <refpurpose>tool to allow external access to Winbind's NTLM authentication function</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>ntlm_auth</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d debuglevel</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-l logdir</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s &lt;smb config file&gt;</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>ntlm_auth</command> is a helper utility that authenticates
+ users using NT/LM authentication. It returns 0 if the users is authenticated
+ successfully and 1 if access was denied. ntlm_auth uses winbind to access
+ the user and authentication data for a domain. This utility
+ is only intended to be used by other programs (currently
+ <ulink url="http://www.squid-cache.org/">Squid</ulink>
+ and <ulink url="http://download.samba.org/ftp/unpacked/lorikeet/trunk/mod_ntlm_winbind/">mod_ntlm_winbind</ulink>)
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPERATIONAL REQUIREMENTS</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon must be operational
+ for many of these commands to function.</para>
+
+ <para>Some of these commands also require access to the directory
+ <filename>winbindd_privileged</filename> in
+ <filename>$LOCKDIR</filename>. This should be done either by running
+ this command as root or providing group access
+ to the <filename>winbindd_privileged</filename> directory. For
+ security reasons, this directory should not be world-accessable. </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--helper-protocol=PROTO</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Operate as a stdio-based helper. Valid helper protocols are:
+ </para>
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>squid-2.4-basic</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Server-side helper for use with Squid 2.4's basic (plaintext)
+ authentication. </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>squid-2.5-basic</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Server-side helper for use with Squid 2.5's basic (plaintext)
+ authentication. </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>squid-2.5-ntlmssp</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Server-side helper for use with Squid 2.5's NTLMSSP
+ authentication. </para>
+ <para>Requires access to the directory
+ <filename>winbindd_privileged</filename> in
+ <filename>$LOCKDIR</filename>. The protocol used is
+ described here: <ulink
+ url="http://devel.squid-cache.org/ntlm/squid_helper_protocol.html">http://devel.squid-cache.org/ntlm/squid_helper_protocol.html</ulink>.
+ This protocol has been extended to allow the
+ NTLMSSP Negotiate packet to be included as an argument
+ to the <command>YR</command> command. (Thus avoiding
+ loss of information in the protocol exchange).
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>ntlmssp-client-1</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Client-side helper for use with arbitrary external
+ programs that may wish to use Samba's NTLMSSP
+ authentication knowledge. </para>
+ <para>This helper is a client, and as such may be run by any
+ user. The protocol used is
+ effectively the reverse of the previous protocol. A
+ <command>YR</command> command (without any arguments)
+ starts the authentication exchange.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>gss-spnego</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Server-side helper that implements GSS-SPNEGO. This
+ uses a protocol that is almost the same as
+ <command>squid-2.5-ntlmssp</command>, but has some
+ subtle differences that are undocumented outside the
+ source at this stage.
+ </para>
+ <para>Requires access to the directory
+ <filename>winbindd_privileged</filename> in
+ <filename>$LOCKDIR</filename>.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>gss-spnego-client</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Client-side helper that implements GSS-SPNEGO. This
+ also uses a protocol similar to the above helpers, but
+ is currently undocumented.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>ntlm-server-1</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Server-side helper protocol, intended for use by a
+ RADIUS server or the 'winbind' plugin for pppd, for
+ the provision of MSCHAP and MSCHAPv2 authentication.
+ </para>
+ <para>This protocol consists of lines in the form:
+ <command>Parameter: value</command> and <command>Parameter::
+ Base64-encode value</command>. The presence of a single
+ period <command>.</command> indicates that one side has
+ finished supplying data to the other. (Which in turn
+ could cause the helper to authenticate the
+ user). </para>
+
+ <para>Currently implemented parameters from the
+ external program to the helper are:</para>
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>Username</term>
+
+ <listitem><para>The username, expected to be in
+ Samba's <smbconfoption name="unix charset"/>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para><example>Username: bob</example></para>
+ <para><example>Username:: Ym9i</example></para>
+ </listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>NT-Domain</term>
+ <listitem><para>The user's domain, expected to be in
+ Samba's <smbconfoption name="unix charset"/>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para><example>NT-Domain: WORKGROUP</example></para>
+ <para><example>NT-Domain:: V09SS0dST1VQ</example></para>
+ </listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>Full-Username</term>
+ <listitem><para>The fully qualified username, expected to be in
+ Samba's <smbconfoption name="unix charset"/> and qualified with the
+ <smbconfoption name="winbind separator"/>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para><example>Full-Username: WORKGROUP\bob</example></para>
+ <para><example>Full-Username:: V09SS0dST1VQYm9i</example></para>
+ </listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>LANMAN-Challenge</term>
+
+ <listitem><para>The 8 byte <command>LANMAN Challenge</command> value,
+ generated randomly by the server, or (in cases such as
+ MSCHAPv2) generated in some way by both the server and
+ the client.
+ </para>
+ <para><example>LANMAN-Challenge: 0102030405060708</example></para>
+ </listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>LANMAN-Response</term>
+
+ <listitem><para>The 24 byte <command>LANMAN Response</command> value,
+ calculated from the user's password and the supplied
+ <command>LANMAN Challenge</command>. Typically, this
+ is provided over the network by a client wishing to authenticate.
+ </para>
+ <para><example>LANMAN-Response: 0102030405060708090A0B0C0D0E0F101112131415161718</example></para>
+
+ </listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>NT-Response</term>
+ <listitem><para>The >= 24 byte <command>NT Response</command>
+ calculated from the user's password and the supplied
+ <command>LANMAN Challenge</command>. Typically, this is
+ provided over the network by a client wishing to authenticate.
+ </para>
+ <para><example>NT-Response: 0102030405060708090A0B0C0D0E0F101112131415161718</example></para>
+
+ </listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>Password</term>
+ <listitem><para>The user's password. This would be
+ provided by a network client, if the helper is being
+ used in a legacy situation that exposes plaintext
+ passwords in this way.
+ </para>
+ <para><example>Password: samba2</example></para>
+ <para><example>Password:: c2FtYmEy</example></para>
+
+ </listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>Request-User-Session-Key</term>
+ <listitem><para>Upon successful authenticaiton, return
+ the user session key associated with the login.
+ </para>
+ <para><example>Request-User-Session-Key: Yes</example></para>
+
+ </listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>Request-LanMan-Session-Key</term>
+ <listitem><para>Upon successful authenticaiton, return
+ the LANMAN session key associated with the login.
+ </para>
+ <para><example>Request-LanMan-Session-Key: Yes</example></para>
+
+ </listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <para><warning>Implementers should take care to base64 encode
+ any data (such as usernames/passwords) that may contain malicous user data, such as
+ a newline. They may also need to decode strings from
+ the helper, which likewise may have been base64 encoded.</warning></para>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--username=USERNAME</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Specify username of user to authenticate
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--domain=DOMAIN</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Specify domain of user to authenticate
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--workstation=WORKSTATION</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Specify the workstation the user authenticated from
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--challenge=STRING</term>
+ <listitem><para>NTLM challenge (in HEXADECIMAL)</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--lm-response=RESPONSE</term>
+ <listitem><para>LM Response to the challenge (in HEXADECIMAL)</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--nt-response=RESPONSE</term>
+ <listitem><para>NT or NTLMv2 Response to the challenge (in HEXADECIMAL)</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--password=PASSWORD</term>
+ <listitem><para>User's plaintext password</para><para>If
+ not specified on the command line, this is prompted for when
+ required. </para>
+
+ <para>For the NTLMSSP based server roles, this parameter
+ specifies the expected password, allowing testing without
+ winbindd operational.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--request-lm-key</term>
+ <listitem><para>Retrieve LM session key</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--request-nt-key</term>
+ <listitem><para>Request NT key</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--diagnostics</term>
+ <listitem><para>Perform Diagnostics on the authentication
+ chain. Uses the password from <command>--password</command>
+ or prompts for one.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--require-membership-of={SID|Name}</term>
+ <listitem><para>Require that a user be a member of specified
+ group (either name or SID) for authentication to succeed.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+ &stdarg.help;
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLE SETUP</title>
+
+ <para>To setup ntlm_auth for use by squid 2.5, with both basic and
+ NTLMSSP authentication, the following
+ should be placed in the <filename>squid.conf</filename> file.
+<programlisting>
+auth_param ntlm program ntlm_auth --helper-protocol=squid-2.5-ntlmssp
+auth_param basic program ntlm_auth --helper-protocol=squid-2.5-basic
+auth_param basic children 5
+auth_param basic realm Squid proxy-caching web server
+auth_param basic credentialsttl 2 hours
+</programlisting></para>
+
+<note><para>This example assumes that ntlm_auth has been installed into your
+ path, and that the group permissions on
+ <filename>winbindd_privileged</filename> are as described above.</para></note>
+
+ <para>To setup ntlm_auth for use by squid 2.5 with group limitation in addition to the above
+ example, the following should be added to the <filename>squid.conf</filename> file.
+<programlisting>
+auth_param ntlm program ntlm_auth --helper-protocol=squid-2.5-ntlmssp --require-membership-of='WORKGROUP\Domain Users'
+auth_param basic program ntlm_auth --helper-protocol=squid-2.5-basic --require-membership-of='WORKGROUP\Domain Users'
+</programlisting></para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>TROUBLESHOOTING</title>
+
+ <para>If you're experiencing problems with authenticating Internet Explorer running
+ under MS Windows 9X or Millennium Edition against ntlm_auth's NTLMSSP authentication
+ helper (--helper-protocol=squid-2.5-ntlmssp), then please read
+ <ulink url="http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/Q239/8/69.ASP">
+ the Microsoft Knowledge Base article #239869 and follow instructions described there</ulink>.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba
+ suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The ntlm_auth manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij and
+ Andrew Bartlett.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/pam_winbind.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/pam_winbind.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..14f4e70648
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/pam_winbind.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,264 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="pam_winbind.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>pam_winbind</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">8</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>pam_winbind</refname>
+ <refpurpose>PAM module for Winbind</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>
+ pam_winbind is a PAM module that can authenticate users against the local domain by talking to the Winbind daemon.
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SYNOPSIS</title>
+
+ <para>
+ Edit the PAM system config /etc/pam.d/service and modify it as the following example shows:
+ <programlisting>
+ ...
+ auth required pam_env.so
+ auth sufficient pam_unix2.so
+ +++ auth required pam_winbind.so use_first_pass
+ account requisite pam_unix2.so
+ +++ account required pam_winbind.so use_first_pass
+ +++ password sufficient pam_winbind.so
+ password requisite pam_pwcheck.so cracklib
+ password required pam_unix2.so use_authtok
+ session required pam_unix2.so
+ +++ session required pam_winbind.so
+ ...
+ </programlisting>
+
+ Make sure that pam_winbind is one of the first modules in the session part. It may retrieve
+ kerberos tickets which are needed by other modules.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+ <para>
+
+ pam_winbind supports several options which can either be set in
+ the PAM configuration files or in the pam_winbind configuration
+ file situated at
+ <filename>/etc/security/pam_winbind.conf</filename>. Options
+ from the PAM configuration file take precedence to those from
+ the configuration file. See
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>pam_winbind.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ for further details.
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>debug</term>
+ <listitem><para>Gives debugging output to syslog.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>debug_state</term>
+ <listitem><para>Gives detailed PAM state debugging output to syslog.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>require_membership_of=[SID or NAME]</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ If this option is set, pam_winbind will only succeed if the user is a member of the given SID or NAME. A SID
+ can be either a group-SID, an alias-SID or even an user-SID. It is also possible to give a NAME instead of the
+ SID. That name must have the form: <parameter>MYDOMAIN\\mygroup</parameter> or
+ <parameter>MYDOMAIN\\myuser</parameter>. pam_winbind will, in that case, lookup the SID internally. Note that
+ NAME may not contain any spaces. It is thus recommended to only use SIDs. You can verify the list of SIDs a
+ user is a member of with <command>wbinfo --user-sids=SID</command>.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>use_first_pass</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ By default, pam_winbind tries to get the authentication token from a previous module. If no token is available
+ it asks the user for the old password. With this option, pam_winbind aborts with an error if no authentication
+ token from a previous module is available.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>try_first_pass</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Same as the use_first_pass option (previous item), except that if the primary password is not
+ valid, PAM will prompt for a password.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>use_authtok</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Set the new password to the one provided by the previously stacked password module. If this option is not set
+ pam_winbind will ask the user for the new password.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>krb5_auth</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+
+ pam_winbind can authenticate using Kerberos when winbindd is
+ talking to an Active Directory domain controller. Kerberos
+ authentication must be enabled with this parameter. When
+ Kerberos authentication can not succeed (e.g. due to clock
+ skew), winbindd will fallback to samlogon authentication over
+ MSRPC. When this parameter is used in conjunction with
+ <parameter>winbind refresh tickets</parameter>, winbind will
+ keep your Ticket Granting Ticket (TGT) uptodate by refreshing
+ it whenever necessary.
+
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>krb5_ccache_type=[type]</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+
+ When pam_winbind is configured to try kerberos authentication
+ by enabling the <parameter>krb5_auth</parameter> option, it can
+ store the retrieved Ticket Granting Ticket (TGT) in a
+ credential cache. The type of credential cache can be set with
+ this option. Currently the only supported value is:
+ <parameter>FILE</parameter>. In that case a credential cache in
+ the form of /tmp/krb5cc_UID will be created, where UID is
+ replaced with the numeric user id. Leave empty to just do
+ kerberos authentication without having a ticket cache after the
+ logon has succeeded.
+
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>cached_login</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Winbind allows to logon using cached credentials when <parameter>winbind offline logon</parameter> is enabled. To use this feature from the PAM module this option must be set.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>silent</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Do not emit any messages.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>mkhomedir</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Create homedirectory for a user on-the-fly, option is valid in
+ PAM session block.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>warn_pwd_expire</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Defines number of days before pam_winbind starts to warn about passwords that are
+ going to expire. Defaults to 14 days.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>PAM DATA EXPORTS</title>
+
+ <para>This section describes the data exported in the PAM stack which could be used in other PAM modules.</para>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>PAM_WINBIND_HOMEDIR</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ This is the Windows Home Directory set in the profile tab in the user settings
+ on the Active Directory Server. This could be a local path or a directory on a
+ share mapped to a drive.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>PAM_WINBIND_LOGONSCRIPT</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ The path to the logon script which should be executed if a user logs in. This is
+ normally a relative path to the script stored on the server.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>PAM_WINBIND_LOGONSERVER</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ This exports the Active Directory server we are authenticating against. This can be
+ used as a variable later.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>PAM_WINBIND_PROFILEPATH</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ This is the profile path set in the profile tab in the user settings. Normally
+ the home directory is synced with this directory on a share.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>pam_winbind.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>wbinfo</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of Samba.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed by
+ the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij and Guenther Deschner.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/pam_winbind.conf.5.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/pam_winbind.conf.5.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..113515ce84
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/pam_winbind.conf.5.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,190 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="pam_winbind.conf.5">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>pam_winbind.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">5</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>pam_winbind.conf</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Configuration file of PAM module for Winbind</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This configuration file is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>
+ pam_winbind.conf is the configuration file for the pam_winbind PAM
+ module. See
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>pam_winbind</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ for further details.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SYNOPSIS</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The pam_winbind.conf configuration file is a classic ini-style
+ configuration file. There is only one section (global) where
+ various options are defined.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+ <para>
+
+ pam_winbind supports several options which can either be set in
+ the PAM configuration files or in the pam_winbind configuration
+ file situated at
+ <filename>/etc/security/pam_winbind.conf</filename>. Options
+ from the PAM configuration file take precedence to those from
+ the pam_winbind.conf configuration file.
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>debug = yes|no</term>
+ <listitem><para>Gives debugging output to syslog. Defaults to "no".</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>debug_state = yes|no</term>
+ <listitem><para>Gives detailed PAM state debugging output to syslog. Defaults to "no".</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>require_membership_of = [SID or NAME]</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ If this option is set, pam_winbind will only succeed if the user is a member of the given SID or NAME. A SID
+ can be either a group-SID, an alias-SID or even an user-SID. It is also possible to give a NAME instead of the
+ SID. That name must have the form: <parameter>MYDOMAIN\\mygroup</parameter> or
+ <parameter>MYDOMAIN\\myuser</parameter>. pam_winbind will, in that case, lookup the SID internally. Note that
+ NAME may not contain any spaces. It is thus recommended to only use SIDs. You can verify the list of SIDs a
+ user is a member of with <command>wbinfo --user-sids=SID</command>. This setting is empty by default.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>try_first_pass = yes|no</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ By default, pam_winbind tries to get the authentication token from a previous module. If no token is available
+ it asks the user for the old password. With this option, pam_winbind aborts with an error if no authentication
+ token from a previous module is available. If a primary password is not valid, PAM will prompt for a password.
+ Default to "no".
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>krb5_auth = yes|no</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+
+ pam_winbind can authenticate using Kerberos when winbindd is
+ talking to an Active Directory domain controller. Kerberos
+ authentication must be enabled with this parameter. When
+ Kerberos authentication can not succeed (e.g. due to clock
+ skew), winbindd will fallback to samlogon authentication over
+ MSRPC. When this parameter is used in conjunction with
+ <parameter>winbind refresh tickets</parameter>, winbind will
+ keep your Ticket Granting Ticket (TGT) uptodate by refreshing
+ it whenever necessary. Defaults to "no".
+
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>krb5_ccache_type = [type]</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+
+ When pam_winbind is configured to try kerberos authentication
+ by enabling the <parameter>krb5_auth</parameter> option, it can
+ store the retrieved Ticket Granting Ticket (TGT) in a
+ credential cache. The type of credential cache can be set with
+ this option. Currently the only supported value is:
+ <parameter>FILE</parameter>. In that case a credential cache in
+ the form of /tmp/krb5cc_UID will be created, where UID is
+ replaced with the numeric user id. Leave empty to just do
+ kerberos authentication without having a ticket cache after the
+ logon has succeeded. This setting is empty by default.
+
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>cached_login = yes|no</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Winbind allows to logon using cached credentials when <parameter>winbind offline logon</parameter> is enabled. To use this feature from the PAM module this option must be set. Defaults to "no".
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>silent = yes|no</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Do not emit any messages. Defaults to "no".
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>mkhomedir = yes|no</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Create homedirectory for a user on-the-fly, option is valid in
+ PAM session block. Defaults to "no".
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>warn_pwd_expire = days</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Defines number of days before pam_winbind starts to warn about passwords that are
+ going to expire. Defaults to 14 days.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>pam_winbind</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>wbinfo</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of Samba.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed by
+ the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij and Guenther Deschner.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/pdbedit.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/pdbedit.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..1d0752e234
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/pdbedit.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,547 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="pdbedit.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>pdbedit</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>pdbedit</refname>
+ <refpurpose>manage the SAM database (Database of Samba Users)</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>pdbedit</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-a</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-b passdb-backend</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-c account-control</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-C value</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d debuglevel</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-D drive</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-e passdb-backend</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-f fullname</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--force-initialized-passwords</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-g</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h homedir</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-i passdb-backend</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-I domain</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-K</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-L </arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-m</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-M SID|RID</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-N description</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-P account-policy</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-p profile</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--policies-reset</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-r</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s configfile</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-S script</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-t</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--time-format</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-u username</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-U SID|RID</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-v</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-V</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-w</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-x</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-y</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-z</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-Z</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The pdbedit program is used to manage the users accounts
+ stored in the sam database and can only be run by root.</para>
+
+ <para>The pdbedit tool uses the passdb modular interface and is
+ independent from the kind of users database used (currently there
+ are smbpasswd, ldap, nis+ and tdb based and more can be added
+ without changing the tool).</para>
+
+ <para>There are five main ways to use pdbedit: adding a user account,
+ removing a user account, modifying a user account, listing user
+ accounts, importing users accounts.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-L|--list</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option lists all the user accounts
+ present in the users database.
+ This option prints a list of user/uid pairs separated by
+ the ':' character.</para>
+ <para>Example: <command>pdbedit -L</command></para>
+ <para><programlisting>
+sorce:500:Simo Sorce
+samba:45:Test User
+</programlisting></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-v|--verbose</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option enables the verbose listing format.
+ It causes pdbedit to list the users in the database, printing
+ out the account fields in a descriptive format.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>pdbedit -L -v</command></para>
+ <para><programlisting>
+---------------
+username: sorce
+user ID/Group: 500/500
+user RID/GRID: 2000/2001
+Full Name: Simo Sorce
+Home Directory: \\BERSERKER\sorce
+HomeDir Drive: H:
+Logon Script: \\BERSERKER\netlogon\sorce.bat
+Profile Path: \\BERSERKER\profile
+---------------
+username: samba
+user ID/Group: 45/45
+user RID/GRID: 1090/1091
+Full Name: Test User
+Home Directory: \\BERSERKER\samba
+HomeDir Drive:
+Logon Script:
+Profile Path: \\BERSERKER\profile
+</programlisting></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-w|--smbpasswd-style</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option sets the "smbpasswd" listing format.
+ It will make pdbedit list the users in the database, printing
+ out the account fields in a format compatible with the
+ <filename>smbpasswd</filename> file format. (see the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for details)</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>pdbedit -L -w</command></para>
+ <programlisting>
+sorce:500:508818B733CE64BEAAD3B435B51404EE:
+ D2A2418EFC466A8A0F6B1DBB5C3DB80C:
+ [UX ]:LCT-00000000:
+samba:45:0F2B255F7B67A7A9AAD3B435B51404EE:
+ BC281CE3F53B6A5146629CD4751D3490:
+ [UX ]:LCT-3BFA1E8D:
+</programlisting>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-u|--user username</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option specifies the username to be
+ used for the operation requested (listing, adding, removing).
+ It is <emphasis>required</emphasis> in add, remove and modify
+ operations and <emphasis>optional</emphasis> in list
+ operations.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-f|--fullname fullname</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option can be used while adding or
+ modifying a user account. It will specify the user's full
+ name. </para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>-f "Simo Sorce"</command></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-h|--homedir homedir</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option can be used while adding or
+ modifying a user account. It will specify the user's home
+ directory network path.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>-h "\\\\BERSERKER\\sorce"</command>
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-D|--drive drive</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option can be used while adding or
+ modifying a user account. It will specify the windows drive
+ letter to be used to map the home directory.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>-D "H:"</command>
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-S|--script script</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option can be used while adding or
+ modifying a user account. It will specify the user's logon
+ script path.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>-S "\\\\BERSERKER\\netlogon\\sorce.bat"</command>
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-p|--profile profile</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option can be used while adding or
+ modifying a user account. It will specify the user's profile
+ directory.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>-p "\\\\BERSERKER\\netlogon"</command>
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-M|'--machine SID' SID|rid</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ This option can be used while adding or modifying a machine account. It
+ will specify the machines' new primary group SID (Security Identifier) or
+ rid. </para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>-M S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-1201</command></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-U|'--user SID' SID|rid</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ This option can be used while adding or modifying a user account. It
+ will specify the users' new SID (Security Identifier) or
+ rid. </para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>-U S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-5004</command></para>
+ <para>Example: <command>'--user SID' S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-5004</command></para>
+ <para>Example: <command>-U 5004</command></para>
+ <para>Example: <command>'--user SID' 5004</command></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-c|--account-control account-control</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option can be used while adding or modifying a user
+ account. It will specify the users' account control property. Possible flags are listed below.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>N: No password required</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>D: Account disabled</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>H: Home directory required</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>T: Temporary duplicate of other account</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>U: Regular user account</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>M: MNS logon user account</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>W: Workstation Trust Account</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>S: Server Trust Account</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>L: Automatic Locking</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>X: Password does not expire</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>I: Domain Trust Account</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>-c "[X ]"</command></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-K|--kickoff-time</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option is used to modify the kickoff
+ time for a certain user. Use "never" as argument to set the
+ kickoff time to unlimited.
+ </para>
+ <para>Example: <command>pdbedit -K never user</command></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-a|--create</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option is used to add a user into the
+ database. This command needs a user name specified with
+ the -u switch. When adding a new user, pdbedit will also
+ ask for the password to be used.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>pdbedit -a -u sorce</command>
+<programlisting>new password:
+retype new password
+</programlisting>
+</para>
+
+ <note><para>pdbedit does not call the unix password syncronisation
+ script if <smbconfoption name="unix password sync"/>
+ has been set. It only updates the data in the Samba
+ user database.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>If you wish to add a user and synchronise the password
+ that immediately, use <command>smbpasswd</command>'s <option>-a</option> option.
+ </para>
+ </note>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-t|--password-from-stdin</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option causes pdbedit to read the password
+ from standard input, rather than from /dev/tty (like the
+ <command>passwd(1)</command> program does). The password has
+ to be submitted twice and terminated by a newline each.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-r|--modify</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option is used to modify an existing user
+ in the database. This command needs a user name specified with the -u
+ switch. Other options can be specified to modify the properties of
+ the specified user. This flag is kept for backwards compatibility, but
+ it is no longer necessary to specify it.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-m|--machine</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option may only be used in conjunction
+ with the <parameter>-a</parameter> option. It will make
+ pdbedit to add a machine trust account instead of a user
+ account (-u username will provide the machine name).</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>pdbedit -a -m -u w2k-wks</command>
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-x|--delete</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option causes pdbedit to delete an account
+ from the database. It needs a username specified with the
+ -u switch.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>pdbedit -x -u bob</command></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-i|--import passdb-backend</term>
+ <listitem><para>Use a different passdb backend to retrieve users
+ than the one specified in smb.conf. Can be used to import data into
+ your local user database.</para>
+
+ <para>This option will ease migration from one passdb backend to
+ another.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>pdbedit -i smbpasswd:/etc/smbpasswd.old
+ </command></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-e|--export passdb-backend</term>
+ <listitem><para>Exports all currently available users to the
+ specified password database backend.</para>
+
+ <para>This option will ease migration from one passdb backend to
+ another and will ease backing up.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>pdbedit -e smbpasswd:/root/samba-users.backup</command></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-g|--group</term>
+ <listitem><para>If you specify <parameter>-g</parameter>,
+ then <parameter>-i in-backend -e out-backend</parameter>
+ applies to the group mapping instead of the user database.</para>
+
+ <para>This option will ease migration from one passdb backend to
+ another and will ease backing up.</para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-b|--backend passdb-backend</term>
+ <listitem><para>Use a different default passdb backend. </para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>pdbedit -b xml:/root/pdb-backup.xml -l</command></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-P|--account-policy account-policy</term>
+ <listitem><para>Display an account policy</para>
+ <para>Valid policies are: minimum password age, reset count minutes, disconnect time,
+ user must logon to change password, password history, lockout duration, min password length,
+ maximum password age and bad lockout attempt.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>pdbedit -P "bad lockout attempt"</command></para>
+<para><programlisting>
+account policy value for bad lockout attempt is 0
+</programlisting></para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-C|--value account-policy-value</term>
+ <listitem><para>Sets an account policy to a specified value.
+ This option may only be used in conjunction
+ with the <parameter>-P</parameter> option.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>pdbedit -P "bad lockout attempt" -C 3</command></para>
+<para><programlisting>
+account policy value for bad lockout attempt was 0
+account policy value for bad lockout attempt is now 3
+</programlisting></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-y|--policies</term>
+ <listitem><para>If you specify <parameter>-y</parameter>,
+ then <parameter>-i in-backend -e out-backend</parameter>
+ applies to the account policies instead of the user database.</para>
+
+ <para>This option will allow to migrate account policies from their default
+ tdb-store into a passdb backend, e.g. an LDAP directory server.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>pdbedit -y -i tdbsam: -e ldapsam:ldap://my.ldap.host</command></para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--force-initialized-passwords</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option forces all users to change their
+ password upon next login.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-N|--account-desc description</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option can be used while adding or
+ modifying a user account. It will specify the user's description
+ field.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>-N "test description"</command>
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-Z|--logon-hours-reset</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option can be used while adding or
+ modifying a user account. It will reset the user's allowed logon
+ hours. A user may login at any time afterwards.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>-Z</command>
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-z|--bad-password-count-reset</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option can be used while adding or
+ modifying a user account. It will reset the stored bad login
+ counter from a specified user.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>-z</command>
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--policies-reset</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option can be used to reset the general
+ password policies stored for a domain to their
+ default values.</para>
+ <para>Example: <command>--policies-reset</command>
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-I|--domain</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option can be used while adding or
+ modifying a user account. It will specify the user's domain field.</para>
+
+ <para>Example: <command>-I "MYDOMAIN"</command>
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--time-format</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option is currently not being used.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.help;
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>NOTES</title>
+
+ <para>This command may be used only by root.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The pdbedit manpage was written by Simo Sorce and Jelmer Vernooij.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/profiles.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/profiles.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..fb33217148
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/profiles.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,88 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="profiles.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>profiles</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>profiles</refname>
+ <refpurpose>A utility to report and change SIDs in registry files
+ </refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>profiles</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-v</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-c SID</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-n SID</arg>
+ <arg choice="req">file</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>profiles</command> is a utility that
+ reports and changes SIDs in windows registry files. It currently only
+ supports NT.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>file</term>
+ <listitem><para>Registry file to view or edit. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-v,--verbose</term>
+ <listitem><para>Increases verbosity of messages.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-c SID1 -n SID2</term>
+ <listitem><para>Change all occurrences of SID1 in <filename>file</filename> by SID2.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.help;
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba
+ suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The profiles man page was written by Jelmer Vernooij. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/rpcclient.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/rpcclient.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..4e3d30c097
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/rpcclient.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,542 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="rpcclient.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>rpcclient</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>rpcclient</refname>
+ <refpurpose>tool for executing client side
+ MS-RPC functions</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>rpcclient</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-A authfile</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-c &lt;command string&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d debuglevel</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-l logdir</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-N</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s &lt;smb config file&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-U username[%password]</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-W workgroup</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-I destinationIP</arg>
+ <arg choice="req">server</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>rpcclient</command> is a utility initially developed
+ to test MS-RPC functionality in Samba itself. It has undergone
+ several stages of development and stability. Many system administrators
+ have now written scripts around it to manage Windows NT clients from
+ their UNIX workstation. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>server</term>
+ <listitem><para>NetBIOS name of Server to which to connect.
+ The server can be any SMB/CIFS server. The name is
+ resolved using the <smbconfoption name="name resolve order"/> line from <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-c|--command=&lt;command string&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Execute semicolon separated commands (listed
+ below) </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-I|--dest-ip IP-address</term>
+ <listitem><para><replaceable>IP address</replaceable> is the address of the server to connect to.
+ It should be specified in standard "a.b.c.d" notation. </para>
+
+ <para>Normally the client would attempt to locate a named
+ SMB/CIFS server by looking it up via the NetBIOS name resolution
+ mechanism described above in the <parameter>name resolve order</parameter>
+ parameter above. Using this parameter will force the client
+ to assume that the server is on the machine with the specified IP
+ address and the NetBIOS name component of the resource being
+ connected to will be ignored. </para>
+
+ <para>There is no default for this parameter. If not supplied,
+ it will be determined automatically by the client as described
+ above. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-p|--port port</term>
+ <listitem><para>This number is the TCP port number that will be used
+ when making connections to the server. The standard (well-known)
+ TCP port number for an SMB/CIFS server is 139, which is the
+ default. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+ &popt.common.credentials;
+ &popt.common.connection;
+ &stdarg.help;
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>COMMANDS</title>
+
+ <refsect2>
+ <title>LSARPC</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>lsaquery</term><listitem><para>Query info policy</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>lookupsids</term><listitem><para>Resolve a list
+ of SIDs to usernames.
+ </para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>lookupnames</term><listitem><para>Resolve a list
+ of usernames to SIDs.
+ </para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>enumtrust</term><listitem><para>Enumerate trusted domains</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>enumprivs</term><listitem><para>Enumerate privileges</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>getdispname</term><listitem><para>Get the privilege name</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>lsaenumsid</term><listitem><para>Enumerate the LSA SIDS</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>lsaenumprivsaccount</term><listitem><para>Enumerate the privileges of an SID</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>lsaenumacctrights</term><listitem><para>Enumerate the rights of an SID</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>lsaenumacctwithright</term><listitem><para>Enumerate accounts with a right</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>lsaaddacctrights</term><listitem><para>Add rights to an account</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>lsaremoveacctrights</term><listitem><para>Remove rights from an account</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>lsalookupprivvalue</term><listitem><para>Get a privilege value given its name</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>lsaquerysecobj</term><listitem><para>Query LSA security object</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+ </refsect2>
+
+ <refsect2>
+ <title>LSARPC-DS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>dsroledominfo</term><listitem><para>Get Primary Domain Information</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ <para> </para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>DFS</emphasis></para>
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>dfsexist</term><listitem><para>Query DFS support</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>dfsadd</term><listitem><para>Add a DFS share</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>dfsremove</term><listitem><para>Remove a DFS share</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>dfsgetinfo</term><listitem><para>Query DFS share info</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>dfsenum</term><listitem><para>Enumerate dfs shares</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ </refsect2>
+
+ <refsect2>
+ <title>REG</title>
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>shutdown</term><listitem><para>Remote Shutdown</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>abortshutdown</term><listitem><para>Abort Shutdown</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ </refsect2>
+
+ <refsect2>
+ <title>SRVSVC</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>srvinfo</term><listitem><para>Server query info</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>netshareenum</term><listitem><para>Enumerate shares</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>netfileenum</term><listitem><para>Enumerate open files</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>netremotetod</term><listitem><para>Fetch remote time of day</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+
+ </refsect2>
+
+ <refsect2>
+ <title>SAMR</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>queryuser</term><listitem><para>Query user info</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>querygroup</term><listitem><para>Query group info</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>queryusergroups</term><listitem><para>Query user groups</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>querygroupmem</term><listitem><para>Query group membership</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>queryaliasmem</term><listitem><para>Query alias membership</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>querydispinfo</term><listitem><para>Query display info</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>querydominfo</term><listitem><para>Query domain info</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>enumdomusers</term><listitem><para>Enumerate domain users</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>enumdomgroups</term><listitem><para>Enumerate domain groups</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>enumalsgroups</term><listitem><para>Enumerate alias groups</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>createdomuser</term><listitem><para>Create domain user</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>samlookupnames</term><listitem><para>Look up names</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>samlookuprids</term><listitem><para>Look up names</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>deletedomuser</term><listitem><para>Delete domain user</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>samquerysecobj</term><listitem><para>Query SAMR security object</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>getdompwinfo</term><listitem><para>Retrieve domain password info</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>lookupdomain</term><listitem><para>Look up domain</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ </refsect2>
+
+ <refsect2>
+ <title>SPOOLSS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>adddriver &lt;arch&gt; &lt;config&gt; [&lt;version&gt;]</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Execute an AddPrinterDriver() RPC to install the printer driver
+ information on the server. Note that the driver files should
+ already exist in the directory returned by
+ <command>getdriverdir</command>. Possible values for
+ <parameter>arch</parameter> are the same as those for
+ the <command>getdriverdir</command> command.
+ The <parameter>config</parameter> parameter is defined as
+ follows: </para>
+
+<para><programlisting>
+Long Printer Name:\
+Driver File Name:\
+Data File Name:\
+Config File Name:\
+Help File Name:\
+Language Monitor Name:\
+Default Data Type:\
+Comma Separated list of Files
+</programlisting></para>
+
+ <para>Any empty fields should be enter as the string "NULL". </para>
+
+ <para>Samba does not need to support the concept of Print Monitors
+ since these only apply to local printers whose driver can make
+ use of a bi-directional link for communication. This field should
+ be "NULL". On a remote NT print server, the Print Monitor for a
+ driver must already be installed prior to adding the driver or
+ else the RPC will fail. </para>
+
+ <para>The <parameter>version</parameter> parameter lets you
+ specify the printer driver version number. If omitted, the
+ default driver version for the specified architecture will
+ be used. This option can be used to upload Windows 2000
+ (version 3) printer drivers.</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>addprinter &lt;printername&gt;
+ &lt;sharename&gt; &lt;drivername&gt; &lt;port&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Add a printer on the remote server. This printer
+ will be automatically shared. Be aware that the printer driver
+ must already be installed on the server (see <command>adddriver</command>)
+ and the <parameter>port</parameter>must be a valid port name (see
+ <command>enumports</command>.</para>
+ </listitem></varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry><term>deldriver &lt;driver&gt;</term><listitem><para>Delete the
+ specified printer driver for all architectures. This
+ does not delete the actual driver files from the server,
+ only the entry from the server's list of drivers.
+ </para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>deldriverex &lt;driver&gt; [architecture] [version] [flags]
+ </term><listitem><para>Delete the specified printer driver and optionally files
+ associated with the driver.
+ You can limit this action to a specific architecture and a specific version.
+ If no architecture is given, all driver files of that driver will be deleted.
+ <parameter>flags</parameter> correspond to numeric DPD_* values, i.e. a value
+ of 3 requests (DPD_DELETE_UNUSED_FILES | DPD_DELETE_SPECIFIC_VERSION).
+ </para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>enumdata</term><listitem><para>Enumerate all
+ printer setting data stored on the server. On Windows NT clients,
+ these values are stored in the registry, while Samba servers
+ store them in the printers TDB. This command corresponds
+ to the MS Platform SDK GetPrinterData() function (* This
+ command is currently unimplemented).</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>enumdataex</term><listitem><para>Enumerate printer data for a key</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>enumjobs &lt;printer&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>List the jobs and status of a given printer.
+ This command corresponds to the MS Platform SDK EnumJobs()
+ function</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>enumkey</term><listitem><para>Enumerate
+ printer keys</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>enumports [level]</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Executes an EnumPorts() call using the specified
+ info level. Currently only info levels 1 and 2 are supported.
+ </para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry><term>enumdrivers [level]</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Execute an EnumPrinterDrivers() call. This lists the various installed
+ printer drivers for all architectures. Refer to the MS Platform SDK
+ documentation for more details of the various flags and calling
+ options. Currently supported info levels are 1, 2, and 3.</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry><term>enumprinters [level]</term>
+ <listitem><para>Execute an EnumPrinters() call. This lists the various installed
+ and share printers. Refer to the MS Platform SDK documentation for
+ more details of the various flags and calling options. Currently
+ supported info levels are 1, 2 and 5.</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry><term>getdata &lt;printername&gt; &lt;valuename;&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Retrieve the data for a given printer setting. See
+ the <command>enumdata</command> command for more information.
+ This command corresponds to the GetPrinterData() MS Platform
+ SDK function. </para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>getdataex</term><listitem><para>Get
+ printer driver data with
+ keyname</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry><term>getdriver &lt;printername&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Retrieve the printer driver information (such as driver file,
+ config file, dependent files, etc...) for
+ the given printer. This command corresponds to the GetPrinterDriver()
+ MS Platform SDK function. Currently info level 1, 2, and 3 are supported.
+ </para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry><term>getdriverdir &lt;arch&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Execute a GetPrinterDriverDirectory()
+ RPC to retrieve the SMB share name and subdirectory for
+ storing printer driver files for a given architecture. Possible
+ values for <parameter>arch</parameter> are "Windows 4.0"
+ (for Windows 95/98), "Windows NT x86", "Windows NT PowerPC", "Windows
+ Alpha_AXP", and "Windows NT R4000". </para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry><term>getprinter &lt;printername&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Retrieve the current printer information. This command
+ corresponds to the GetPrinter() MS Platform SDK function.
+ </para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>getprintprocdir</term><listitem><para>Get
+ print processor
+ directory</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>openprinter &lt;printername&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Execute an OpenPrinterEx() and ClosePrinter() RPC
+ against a given printer. </para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>setdriver &lt;printername&gt;
+ &lt;drivername&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Execute a SetPrinter() command to update the printer driver
+ associated with an installed printer. The printer driver must
+ already be correctly installed on the print server. </para>
+
+ <para>See also the <command>enumprinters</command> and
+ <command>enumdrivers</command> commands for obtaining a list of
+ of installed printers and drivers.</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>addform</term><listitem><para>Add form</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>setform</term><listitem><para>Set form</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>getform</term><listitem><para>Get form</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>deleteform</term><listitem><para>Delete form</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>enumforms</term><listitem><para>Enumerate form</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>setprinter</term><listitem><para>Set printer comment</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>setprinterdata</term><listitem><para>Set REG_SZ printer data</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>setprintername &lt;printername&gt;
+ &lt;newprintername&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Set printer name</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>rffpcnex</term><listitem><para>Rffpcnex test</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+
+ </variablelist>
+
+ </refsect2>
+
+ <refsect2>
+ <title>NETLOGON</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>logonctrl2</term>
+ <listitem><para>Logon Control 2</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>logonctrl</term>
+ <listitem><para>Logon Control</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>samsync</term>
+ <listitem><para>Sam Synchronisation</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>samdeltas</term>
+ <listitem><para>Query Sam Deltas</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>samlogon</term>
+ <listitem><para>Sam Logon</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+ </refsect2>
+
+ <refsect2>
+ <title>FSRVP</title>
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>fss_is_path_sup</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Check whether a share supports shadow-copy
+ requests</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>fss_get_sup_version</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Get supported FSRVP version from server</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>fss_create_expose</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Request shadow-copy creation and exposure</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>fss_delete</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Request shadow-copy share deletion</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>fss_has_shadow_copy</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Check for an associated share shadow-copy</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>fss_get_mapping</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Get shadow-copy share mapping information</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>fss_recovery_complete</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Flag read-write snapshot as recovery complete,
+ allowing further shadow-copy requests</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+ </refsect2>
+
+ <refsect2>
+ <title>GENERAL COMMANDS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>debuglevel</term><listitem><para>Set the current
+ debug level used to log information.</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>help (?)</term><listitem><para>Print a listing of all
+ known commands or extended help on a particular command.
+ </para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>quit (exit)</term><listitem><para>Exit <command>rpcclient
+ </command>.</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+ </refsect2>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>BUGS</title>
+
+ <para><command>rpcclient</command> is designed as a developer testing tool
+ and may not be robust in certain areas (such as command line parsing).
+ It has been known to generate a core dump upon failures when invalid
+ parameters where passed to the interpreter. </para>
+
+ <para>From Luke Leighton's original rpcclient man page:</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>WARNING!</emphasis> The MSRPC over SMB code has
+ been developed from examining Network traces. No documentation is
+ available from the original creators (Microsoft) on how MSRPC over
+ SMB works, or how the individual MSRPC services work. Microsoft's
+ implementation of these services has been demonstrated (and reported)
+ to be... a bit flaky in places. </para>
+
+ <para>The development of Samba's implementation is also a bit rough,
+ and as more of the services are understood, it can even result in
+ versions of <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>rpcclient</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> that are incompatible for some commands or services. Additionally,
+ the developers are sending reports to Microsoft, and problems found
+ or reported to Microsoft are fixed in Service Packs, which may
+ result in incompatibilities.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba
+ suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original rpcclient man page was written by Matthew
+ Geddes, Luke Kenneth Casson Leighton, and rewritten by Gerald Carter.
+ The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald
+ Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was
+ done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/samba.7.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/samba.7.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..1e1d71d121
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/samba.7.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,334 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="samba.7">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">Miscellanea</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>samba</refname>
+ <refpurpose>A Windows SMB/CIFS fileserver for UNIX</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis><command>samba</command></cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>The Samba software suite is a collection of programs
+ that implements the Server Message Block (commonly abbreviated
+ as SMB) protocol for UNIX systems. This protocol is sometimes
+ also referred to as the Common Internet File System (CIFS). For a
+ more thorough description, see <ulink url="http://www.ubiqx.org/cifs/">
+ http://www.ubiqx.org/cifs/</ulink>. Samba also implements the NetBIOS
+ protocol in nmbd.</para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <command>smbd</command> daemon provides the file and print services to
+ SMB clients, such as Windows 95/98, Windows NT, Windows
+ for Workgroups or LanManager. The configuration file
+ for this daemon is described in <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <command>nmbd</command>
+ daemon provides NetBIOS nameservice and browsing
+ support. The configuration file for this daemon
+ is described in <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <command>smbclient</command>
+ program implements a simple ftp-like client. This
+ is useful for accessing SMB shares on other compatible
+ servers (such as Windows NT), and can also be used
+ to allow a UNIX box to print to a printer attached to
+ any SMB server (such as a PC running Windows NT).</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>testparm</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <command>testparm</command>
+ utility is a simple syntax checker for Samba's <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> configuration file.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbstatus</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <command>smbstatus</command>
+ tool provides access to information about the
+ current connections to <command>smbd</command>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmblookup</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <command>nmblookup</command>
+ tools allows NetBIOS name queries to be made
+ from a UNIX host.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <command>smbpasswd</command>
+ command is a tool for changing LanMan and Windows NT
+ password hashes on Samba and Windows NT servers.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbcacls</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <command>smbcacls</command> command is
+ a tool to set ACL's on remote CIFS servers. </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbtree</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <command>smbtree</command> command
+ is a text-based network neighborhood tool.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbtar</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <command>smbtar</command> can make
+ backups of data on CIFS/SMB servers.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbspool</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para><command>smbspool</command> is a
+ helper utility for printing on printers connected
+ to CIFS servers. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbcontrol</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para><command>smbcontrol</command> is a utility
+ that can change the behaviour of running samba daemons.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>rpcclient</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para><command>rpcclient</command> is a utility
+ that can be used to execute RPC commands on remote
+ CIFS servers.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>pdbedit</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <command>pdbedit</command> command
+ can be used to maintain the local user database on
+ a samba server.</para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>findsmb</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <command>findsmb</command> command
+ can be used to find SMB servers on the local network.
+ </para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>net</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <command>net</command> command
+ is supposed to work similar to the DOS/Windows
+ NET.EXE command.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>swat</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para><command>swat</command> is a web-based
+ interface to configuring <filename>smb.conf</filename>.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para><command>winbindd</command> is a daemon
+ that is used for integrating authentication and
+ the user database into unix.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>wbinfo</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para><command>wbinfo</command> is a utility
+ that retrieves and stores information related to winbind.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>profiles</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para><command>profiles</command> is a command-line
+ utility that can be used to replace all occurrences of
+ a certain SID with another SID.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>log2pcap</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para><command>log2pcap</command> is a utility
+ for generating pcap trace files from Samba log
+ files.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>vfstest</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para><command>vfstest</command> is a utility
+ that can be used to test vfs modules.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>ntlm_auth</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para><command>ntlm_auth</command> is a helper-utility
+ for external programs wanting to do NTLM-authentication.
+ </para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbcquotas</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para><command>smbcquotas</command> is a tool that
+ can set remote QUOTA's on server with NTFS 5. </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>COMPONENTS</title>
+
+ <para>The Samba suite is made up of several components. Each
+ component is described in a separate manual page. It is strongly
+ recommended that you read the documentation that comes with Samba
+ and the manual pages of those components that you use. If the
+ manual pages and documents aren't clear enough then please visit
+ <ulink url="http://devel.samba.org/">http://devel.samba.org</ulink>
+ for information on how to file a bug report or submit a patch.</para>
+
+ <para>If you require help, visit the Samba webpage at
+ <ulink url="http://samba.org/">http://www.samba.org/</ulink> and
+ explore the many option available to you.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AVAILABILITY</title>
+
+ <para>The Samba software suite is licensed under the
+ GNU Public License(GPL). A copy of that license should
+ have come with the package in the file COPYING. You are
+ encouraged to distribute copies of the Samba suite, but
+ please obey the terms of this license.</para>
+
+ <para>The latest version of the Samba suite can be
+ obtained via anonymous ftp from samba.org in the
+ directory pub/samba/. It is also available on several
+ mirror sites worldwide.</para>
+
+ <para>You may also find useful information about Samba
+ on the newsgroup <ulink url="news:comp.protocols.smb">
+ comp.protocol.smb</ulink> and the Samba mailing
+ list. Details on how to join the mailing list are given in
+ the README file that comes with Samba.</para>
+
+ <para>If you have access to a WWW viewer (such as Mozilla
+ or Konqueror) then you will also find lots of useful information,
+ including back issues of the Samba mailing list, at
+ <ulink url="http://lists.samba.org/">http://lists.samba.org</ulink>.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the
+ Samba suite. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CONTRIBUTIONS</title>
+
+ <para>If you wish to contribute to the Samba project,
+ then I suggest you join the Samba mailing list at
+ <ulink url="http://lists.samba.org/">http://lists.samba.org</ulink>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>If you have patches to submit, visit
+ <ulink url="http://devel.samba.org/">http://devel.samba.org/</ulink>
+ for information on how to do it properly. We prefer patches
+ in <command>diff -u</command> format.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CONTRIBUTORS</title>
+
+ <para>Contributors to the project are now too numerous
+ to mention here but all deserve the thanks of all Samba
+ users. To see a full list, look at the
+ <filename>change-log</filename> in the source package
+ for the pre-CVS changes and at <ulink
+ url="http://cvs.samba.org/">
+ http://cvs.samba.org/</ulink>
+ for the contributors to Samba post-CVS. CVS is the Open Source
+ source code control system used by the Samba Team to develop
+ Samba. The project would have been unmanageable without it.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML
+ 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/sharesec.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/sharesec.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..6618c027e5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/sharesec.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,220 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="sharesec.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>sharesec</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>sharesec</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Set or get share ACLs</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>sharesec</command>
+ <arg choice="req">sharename</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-r, --remove=ACL</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-m, --modify=ACL</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-a, --add=ACL</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-R, --replace=ACLs</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-D, --delete</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-v, --view</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-M, --machine-sid</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-F, --force</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d, --debuglevel=DEBUGLEVEL</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s, --configfile=CONFIGFILE</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-l, --log-basename=LOGFILEBASE</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-V, --version</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-?, --help</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--usage</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>sharesec</command> program manipulates share permissions
+ on SMB file shares.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <para>The following options are available to the <command>sharesec</command> program.
+ The format of ACLs is described in the section ACL FORMAT </para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-a|--add=ACL</term>
+ <listitem><para>Add the ACEs specified to the ACL list.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-D|--delete</term>
+ <listitem><para>Delete the entire security descriptor.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-F|--force</term>
+ <listitem><para>Force storing the ACL.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-m|--modify=ACL</term>
+ <listitem><para>Modify existing ACEs.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-M|--machine-sid</term>
+ <listitem><para>Initialize the machine SID.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-r|--remove=ACL</term>
+ <listitem><para>Remove ACEs.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-R|--replace=ACLS</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Overwrite an existing share permission ACL.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.help;
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>ACL FORMAT</title>
+
+ <para>The format of an ACL is one or more ACL entries separated by
+ either commas or newlines. An ACL entry is one of the following: </para>
+
+ <para><programlisting>
+ REVISION:&lt;revision number&gt;
+ OWNER:&lt;sid or name&gt;
+ GROUP:&lt;sid or name&gt;
+ ACL:&lt;sid or name&gt;:&lt;type&gt;/&lt;flags&gt;/&lt;mask&gt;
+ </programlisting></para>
+
+ <para>The revision of the ACL specifies the internal Windows
+ NT ACL revision for the security descriptor.
+ If not specified it defaults to 1. Using values other than 1 may
+ cause strange behaviour.</para>
+
+ <para>The owner and group specify the owner and group SIDs for the
+ object. If a SID in the format S-1-x-y-z is specified this is used,
+ otherwise the name specified is resolved using the server on which
+ the file or directory resides.</para>
+
+ <para>ACLs specify permissions granted to the SID. This SID
+ can be specified in S-1-x-y-z format or as a name in which case
+ it is resolved against the server on which the file or directory
+ resides. The type, flags and mask values determine the type of
+ access granted to the SID.</para>
+
+ <para>The type can be either ALLOWED or DENIED to allow/deny access
+ to the SID. The flags values are generally zero for share ACLs.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>The mask is a value which expresses the access right
+ granted to the SID. It can be given as a decimal or hexadecimal value,
+ or by using one of the following text strings which map to the NT
+ file permissions of the same name.</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>R</emphasis> - Allow read access </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>W</emphasis> - Allow write access</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>X</emphasis> - Execute permission on the object</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>D</emphasis> - Delete the object</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>P</emphasis> - Change permissions</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>O</emphasis> - Take ownership</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>The following combined permissions can be specified:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>READ</emphasis> - Equivalent to 'RX'
+ permissions</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>CHANGE</emphasis> - Equivalent to 'RXWD' permissions
+ </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>FULL</emphasis> - Equivalent to 'RWXDPO'
+ permissions</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXIT STATUS</title>
+
+ <para>The <command>sharesec</command> program sets the exit status
+ depending on the success or otherwise of the operations performed.
+ The exit status may be one of the following values. </para>
+
+ <para>If the operation succeeded, sharesec returns and exit
+ status of 0. If <command>sharesec</command> couldn't connect to the specified server,
+ or there was an error getting or setting the ACLs, an exit status
+ of 1 is returned. If there was an error parsing any command line
+ arguments, an exit status of 2 is returned. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Add full access for SID
+ <parameter>S-1-5-21-1866488690-1365729215-3963860297-17724</parameter> on
+ <parameter>share</parameter>:
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ host:~ # sharesec share -a S-1-5-21-1866488690-1365729215-3963860297-17724:ALLOWED/0/FULL
+ </programlisting>
+
+ <para>List all ACEs for <parameter>share</parameter>:
+ </para>
+
+ <programlisting>
+ host:~ # sharesec share -v
+ REVISION:1
+ OWNER:(NULL SID)
+ GROUP:(NULL SID)
+ ACL:S-1-1-0:ALLOWED/0/0x101f01ff
+ ACL:S-1-5-21-1866488690-1365729215-3963860297-17724:ALLOWED/0/FULL
+ </programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smb.conf.5.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smb.conf.5.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..becea22531
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smb.conf.5.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,827 @@
+<refentry id="smb.conf.5" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2003/XInclude"
+ xmlns:samba="http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">File Formats and Conventions</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smb.conf</refname>
+ <refpurpose>The configuration file for the Samba suite</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SYNOPSIS</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The <filename moreinfo="none">smb.conf</filename> file is a configuration file for the Samba suite. <filename
+ moreinfo="none">smb.conf</filename> contains runtime configuration information for the Samba programs. The
+ <filename moreinfo="none">smb.conf</filename> file is designed to be configured and administered by the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>swat</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> program. The
+ complete description of the file format and possible parameters held within are here for reference purposes.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1 id="FILEFORMATSECT">
+ <title>FILE FORMAT</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The file consists of sections and parameters. A section begins with the name of the section in square brackets
+ and continues until the next section begins. Sections contain parameters of the form:
+<programlisting>
+<replaceable>name</replaceable> = <replaceable>value </replaceable>
+</programlisting>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The file is line-based - that is, each newline-terminated line represents either a comment, a section name or
+ a parameter.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>Section and parameter names are not case sensitive.</para>
+
+ <para>
+ Only the first equals sign in a parameter is significant. Whitespace before or after the first equals sign is
+ discarded. Leading, trailing and internal whitespace in section and parameter names is irrelevant. Leading
+ and trailing whitespace in a parameter value is discarded. Internal whitespace within a parameter value is
+ retained verbatim.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ Any line beginning with a semicolon (<quote>;</quote>) or a hash (<quote>#</quote>)
+ character is ignored, as are lines containing only whitespace.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ Any line ending in a <quote><literal>\</literal></quote> is continued on the next line in the customary UNIX fashion.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The values following the equals sign in parameters are all either a string (no quotes needed) or a boolean,
+ which may be given as yes/no, 1/0 or true/false. Case is not significant in boolean values, but is preserved
+ in string values. Some items such as create masks are numeric.
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SECTION DESCRIPTIONS</title>
+
+ <para>
+ Each section in the configuration file (except for the [global] section) describes a shared resource (known as
+ a <quote>share</quote>). The section name is the name of the shared resource and the parameters within the
+ section define the shares attributes.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ There are three special sections, [global], [homes] and [printers], which are described under
+ <emphasis>special sections</emphasis>. The following notes apply to ordinary section descriptions.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ A share consists of a directory to which access is being given plus a description of the access rights
+ which are granted to the user of the service. Some housekeeping options are also specifiable.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ Sections are either file share services (used by the client as an extension of their native file systems)
+ or printable services (used by the client to access print services on the host running the server).
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ Sections may be designated <emphasis>guest</emphasis> services, in which case no password is required to
+ access them. A specified UNIX <emphasis>guest account</emphasis> is used to define access privileges in this
+ case.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ Sections other than guest services will require a password to access them. The client provides the
+ username. As older clients only provide passwords and not usernames, you may specify a list of usernames to
+ check against the password using the <literal>user =</literal> option in the share definition. For modern clients
+ such as Windows 95/98/ME/NT/2000, this should not be necessary.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The access rights granted by the server are masked by the access rights granted to the specified or guest
+ UNIX user by the host system. The server does not grant more access than the host system grants.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The following sample section defines a file space share. The user has write access to the path <filename
+ moreinfo="none">/home/bar</filename>. The share is accessed via the share name <literal>foo</literal>:
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[foo]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/home/bar</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="read only">no</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The following sample section defines a printable share. The share is read-only, but printable. That is,
+ the only write access permitted is via calls to open, write to and close a spool file. The <emphasis>guest
+ ok</emphasis> parameter means access will be permitted as the default guest user (specified elsewhere):
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[aprinter]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/usr/spool/public</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="read only">yes</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="printable">yes</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="guest ok">yes</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SPECIAL SECTIONS</title>
+
+ <refsect2>
+ <title>The [global] section</title>
+
+ <para>
+ Parameters in this section apply to the server as a whole, or are defaults for sections that do not
+ specifically define certain items. See the notes under PARAMETERS for more information.
+ </para>
+ </refsect2>
+
+ <refsect2 id="HOMESECT">
+ <title>The [homes] section</title>
+
+ <para>
+ If a section called [homes] is included in the configuration file, services connecting clients
+ to their home directories can be created on the fly by the server.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ When the connection request is made, the existing sections are scanned. If a match is found, it is
+ used. If no match is found, the requested section name is treated as a username and looked up in the local
+ password file. If the name exists and the correct password has been given, a share is created by cloning the
+ [homes] section.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ Some modifications are then made to the newly created share:
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ The share name is changed from homes to the located username.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ If no path was given, the path is set to the user's home directory.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>
+ If you decide to use a <emphasis>path =</emphasis> line in your [homes] section, it may be useful
+ to use the %S macro. For example:
+<programlisting>
+<userinput moreinfo="none">path = /data/pchome/%S</userinput>
+</programlisting>
+ is useful if you have different home directories for your PCs than for UNIX access.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ This is a fast and simple way to give a large number of clients access to their home directories with a minimum
+ of fuss.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ A similar process occurs if the requested section name is <quote>homes</quote>, except that the share
+ name is not changed to that of the requesting user. This method of using the [homes] section works well if
+ different users share a client PC.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The [homes] section can specify all the parameters a normal service section can specify, though some make more sense
+ than others. The following is a typical and suitable [homes] section:
+<programlisting>
+<smbconfsection name="[homes]"/>
+<smbconfoption name="read only">no</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ An important point is that if guest access is specified in the [homes] section, all home directories will be
+ visible to all clients <emphasis>without a password</emphasis>. In the very unlikely event that this is actually
+ desirable, it is wise to also specify <emphasis>read only access</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The <emphasis>browseable</emphasis> flag for auto home directories will be inherited from the global browseable
+ flag, not the [homes] browseable flag. This is useful as it means setting <emphasis>browseable = no</emphasis> in
+ the [homes] section will hide the [homes] share but make any auto home directories visible.
+ </para>
+ </refsect2>
+
+ <refsect2 id="PRINTERSSECT">
+ <title>The [printers] section</title>
+
+ <para>
+ This section works like [homes], but for printers.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ If a [printers] section occurs in the configuration file, users are able to connect to any printer
+ specified in the local host's printcap file.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ When a connection request is made, the existing sections are scanned. If a match is found, it is used.
+ If no match is found, but a [homes] section exists, it is used as described above. Otherwise, the requested
+ section name is treated as a printer name and the appropriate printcap file is scanned to see if the requested
+ section name is a valid printer share name. If a match is found, a new printer share is created by cloning the
+ [printers] section.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ A few modifications are then made to the newly created share:
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>The share name is set to the located printer name</para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>If no printer name was given, the printer name is set to the located printer name</para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>If the share does not permit guest access and no username was given, the username is set
+ to the located printer name.</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>
+ The [printers] service MUST be printable - if you specify otherwise, the server will refuse
+ to load the configuration file.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ Typically the path specified is that of a world-writeable spool directory with the sticky bit set on
+ it. A typical [printers] entry looks like this:
+<programlisting>
+<smbconfsection name="[printers]"/>
+<smbconfoption name="path">/usr/spool/public</smbconfoption>
+<smbconfoption name="guest ok">yes</smbconfoption>
+<smbconfoption name="printable">yes</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ All aliases given for a printer in the printcap file are legitimate printer names as far as the server is concerned.
+ If your printing subsystem doesn't work like that, you will have to set up a pseudo-printcap. This is a file
+ consisting of one or more lines like this:
+<programlisting>
+alias|alias|alias|alias...
+</programlisting>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ Each alias should be an acceptable printer name for your printing subsystem. In the [global] section,
+ specify the new file as your printcap. The server will only recognize names found in your pseudo-printcap,
+ which of course can contain whatever aliases you like. The same technique could be used simply to limit access
+ to a subset of your local printers.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ An alias, by the way, is defined as any component of the first entry of a printcap record. Records are separated by newlines,
+ components (if there are more than one) are separated by vertical bar symbols (<literal>|</literal>).
+ </para>
+
+ <note><para>
+ On SYSV systems which use lpstat to determine what printers are defined on the system you may be able to use
+ <literal>printcap name = lpstat</literal> to automatically obtain a list of printers. See the
+ <literal>printcap name</literal> option for more details.
+ </para></note>
+ </refsect2>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>USERSHARES</title>
+
+ <para>Starting with Samba version 3.0.23 the capability for non-root users to add, modify, and delete
+ their own share definitions has been added. This capability is called <emphasis>usershares</emphasis> and
+ is controlled by a set of parameters in the [global] section of the smb.conf.
+ The relevant parameters are :
+ </para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>usershare allow guests</term>
+ <listitem><para>Controls if usershares can permit guest access.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>usershare max shares</term>
+ <listitem><para>Maximum number of user defined shares allowed.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>usershare owner only</term>
+ <listitem><para>If set only directories owned by the sharing user can be shared.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>usershare path</term>
+ <listitem><para>Points to the directory containing the user defined share definitions.
+ The filesystem permissions on this directory control who can create user defined shares.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>usershare prefix allow list</term>
+ <listitem><para>Comma-separated list of absolute pathnames restricting what directories
+ can be shared. Only directories below the pathnames in this list are permitted.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>usershare prefix deny list</term>
+ <listitem><para>Comma-separated list of absolute pathnames restricting what directories
+ can be shared. Directories below the pathnames in this list are prohibited.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>usershare template share</term>
+ <listitem><para>Names a pre-existing share used as a template for creating new usershares.
+ All other share parameters not specified in the user defined share definition
+ are copied from this named share.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ <para>To allow members of the UNIX group <literal>foo</literal> to create user defined
+ shares, create the directory to contain the share definitions as follows:
+ </para>
+ <para>Become root:</para>
+<programlisting>
+mkdir /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
+chgrp foo /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
+chmod 1770 /usr/local/samba/lib/usershares
+</programlisting>
+<para>Then add the parameters
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfoption name="usershare path">/usr/local/samba/lib/usershares</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="usershare max shares">10</smbconfoption> # (or the desired number of shares)
+</programlisting>
+
+ to the global
+ section of your <filename>smb.conf</filename>. Members of the group foo may then manipulate the user defined shares
+ using the following commands.</para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>net usershare add sharename path [comment] [acl] [guest_ok=[y|n]]</term>
+ <listitem><para>To create or modify (overwrite) a user defined share.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>net usershare delete sharename</term>
+ <listitem><para>To delete a user defined share.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>net usershare list wildcard-sharename</term>
+ <listitem><para>To list user defined shares.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>net usershare info wildcard-sharename</term>
+ <listitem><para>To print information about user defined shares.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>PARAMETERS</title>
+
+ <para>Parameters define the specific attributes of sections.</para>
+
+ <para>
+ Some parameters are specific to the [global] section (e.g., <emphasis>security</emphasis>). Some parameters
+ are usable in all sections (e.g., <emphasis>create mask</emphasis>). All others are permissible only in normal
+ sections. For the purposes of the following descriptions the [homes] and [printers] sections will be
+ considered normal. The letter <emphasis>G</emphasis> in parentheses indicates that a parameter is specific to
+ the [global] section. The letter <emphasis>S</emphasis> indicates that a parameter can be specified in a
+ service specific section. All <emphasis>S</emphasis> parameters can also be specified in the [global] section
+ - in which case they will define the default behavior for all services.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ Parameters are arranged here in alphabetical order - this may not create best bedfellows, but at least you can
+ find them! Where there are synonyms, the preferred synonym is described, others refer to the preferred
+ synonym.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VARIABLE SUBSTITUTIONS</title>
+
+ <para>
+ Many of the strings that are settable in the config file can take substitutions. For example the option
+ <quote>path = /tmp/%u</quote> is interpreted as <quote>path = /tmp/john</quote> if the user connected with the
+ username john.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ These substitutions are mostly noted in the descriptions below, but there are some general substitutions
+ which apply whenever they might be relevant. These are:
+ </para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%U</term>
+ <listitem><para>session username (the username that the client wanted, not
+ necessarily the same as the one they got).</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%G</term>
+ <listitem><para>primary group name of %U.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%h</term>
+ <listitem><para>the Internet hostname that Samba is running on.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%m</term>
+ <listitem><para>the NetBIOS name of the client machine (very useful).</para>
+
+ <para>This parameter is not available when Samba listens on port 445, as clients no longer
+ send this information. If you use this macro in an include statement on a domain that has
+ a Samba domain controller be sure to set in the [global] section <parameter>smb ports =
+ 139</parameter>. This will cause Samba to not listen on port 445 and will permit include
+ functionality to function as it did with Samba 2.x.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%L</term>
+ <listitem><para>the NetBIOS name of the server. This allows you to change your config based on what
+ the client calls you. Your server can have a <quote>dual personality</quote>.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%M</term>
+ <listitem><para>the Internet name of the client machine.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%R</term>
+ <listitem><para>the selected protocol level after protocol negotiation. It can be one of CORE, COREPLUS,
+ LANMAN1, LANMAN2 or NT1.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%d</term>
+ <listitem><para>the process id of the current server
+ process.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%a</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ The architecture of the remote
+ machine. It currently recognizes Samba (<constant>Samba</constant>),
+ the Linux CIFS file system (<constant>CIFSFS</constant>), OS/2, (<constant>OS2</constant>),
+ Mac OS X (<constant>OSX</constant>), Windows for Workgroups (<constant>WfWg</constant>), Windows 9x/ME
+ (<constant>Win95</constant>), Windows NT (<constant>WinNT</constant>),
+ Windows 2000 (<constant>Win2K</constant>),
+ Windows XP (<constant>WinXP</constant>),
+ Windows XP 64-bit(<constant>WinXP64</constant>),
+ Windows 2003 including
+ 2003R2 (<constant>Win2K3</constant>), and Windows
+ Vista (<constant>Vista</constant>). Anything else will be known as
+ <constant>UNKNOWN</constant>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%I</term>
+ <listitem><para>the IP address of the client machine.</para>
+ <para>Before 3.6.0 it could contain IPv4 mapped IPv6 addresses,
+ now it only contains IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%i</term>
+ <listitem><para>the local IP address to which a client connected.</para>
+ <para>Before 3.6.0 it could contain IPv4 mapped IPv6 addresses,
+ now it only contains IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%T</term>
+ <listitem><para>the current date and time.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%D</term>
+ <listitem><para>name of the domain or workgroup of the current user.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%w</term>
+ <listitem><para>the winbind separator.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%$(<replaceable>envvar</replaceable>)</term>
+ <listitem><para>the value of the environment variable
+ <replaceable>envar</replaceable>.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ <para>
+ The following substitutes apply only to some configuration options (only those that are
+ used when a connection has been established):
+ </para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%S</term>
+ <listitem><para>the name of the current service, if any.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%P</term>
+ <listitem><para>the root directory of the current service, if any.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%u</term>
+ <listitem><para>username of the current service, if any.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%g</term>
+ <listitem><para>primary group name of %u.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%H</term>
+ <listitem><para>the home directory of the user given by %u.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%N</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ the name of your NIS home directory server. This is obtained from your NIS auto.map entry.
+ If you have not compiled Samba with the <emphasis>--with-automount</emphasis> option, this
+ value will be the same as %L.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>%p</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ the path of the service's home directory, obtained from your NIS auto.map entry. The NIS
+ auto.map entry is split up as <literal>%N:%p</literal>.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ <para>
+ There are some quite creative things that can be done with these substitutions and other
+ <filename moreinfo="none">smb.conf</filename> options.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1 id="NAMEMANGLINGSECT">
+ <title>NAME MANGLING</title>
+
+ <para>
+ Samba supports <literal>name mangling</literal> so that DOS and Windows clients can use files that don't
+ conform to the 8.3 format. It can also be set to adjust the case of 8.3 format filenames.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ There are several options that control the way mangling is performed, and they are grouped here rather
+ than listed separately. For the defaults look at the output of the testparm program.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ These options can be set separately for each service.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The options are:
+ </para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>case sensitive = yes/no/auto</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ controls whether filenames are case sensitive. If they aren't, Samba must do a filename search and match on
+ passed names. The default setting of auto allows clients that support case sensitive filenames (Linux CIFSVFS
+ and smbclient 3.0.5 and above currently) to tell the Samba server on a per-packet basis that they wish to
+ access the file system in a case-sensitive manner (to support UNIX case sensitive semantics). No Windows or
+ DOS system supports case-sensitive filename so setting this option to auto is that same as setting it to no
+ for them. Default <emphasis>auto</emphasis>.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>default case = upper/lower</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ controls what the default case is for new filenames (ie. files that don't currently exist in the filesystem).
+ Default <emphasis>lower</emphasis>. IMPORTANT NOTE: As part of the optimizations for directories containing
+ large numbers of files, the following special case applies. If the options
+ <smbconfoption name="case sensitive">yes</smbconfoption>, <smbconfoption name="preserve case">No</smbconfoption>, and
+ <smbconfoption name="short preserve case">No</smbconfoption> are set, then the case of <emphasis>all</emphasis>
+ incoming client filenames, not just new filenames, will be modified. See additional notes below.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>preserve case = yes/no</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ controls whether new files (ie. files that don't currently exist in the filesystem) are created with the case
+ that the client passes, or if they are forced to be the <literal>default</literal> case. Default
+ <emphasis>yes</emphasis>.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>short preserve case = yes/no</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ controls if new files (ie. files that don't currently exist in the filesystem) which conform to 8.3 syntax,
+ that is all in upper case and of suitable length, are created upper case, or if they are forced to be the
+ <literal>default</literal> case. This option can be used with <literal>preserve case = yes</literal> to permit
+ long filenames to retain their case, while short names are lowercased. Default <emphasis>yes</emphasis>.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ <para>
+ By default, Samba 3.0 has the same semantics as a Windows NT server, in that it is case insensitive
+ but case preserving. As a special case for directories with large numbers of files, if the case
+ options are set as follows, "case sensitive = yes", "case preserve = no", "short preserve case = no"
+ then the "default case" option will be applied and will modify all filenames sent from the client
+ when accessing this share.
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>REGISTRY-BASED CONFIGURATION</title>
+
+ <para>
+ Starting with Samba version 3.2.0, the capability to
+ store Samba configuration in the registry is available.
+ The configuration is stored in the registry key
+ <emphasis><literal>HKLM\Software\Samba\smbconf</literal></emphasis>.
+ There are two levels of registry configuration:
+ </para>
+
+ <orderedlist continuation="restarts" inheritnum="ignore" numeration="arabic">
+ <listitem><para>Share definitions stored in registry are used.
+ This is triggered by setting the global
+ parameter <parameter>registry shares</parameter>
+ to <quote>yes</quote> in <emphasis>smb.conf</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>The registry shares are loaded not at startup but
+ on demand at runtime by <emphasis>smbd</emphasis>.
+ Shares defined in <emphasis>smb.conf</emphasis> take
+ priority over shares of the same name defined in
+ registry.</para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Global <emphasis>smb.conf</emphasis>
+ options stored in registry are used. This can be activated
+ in two different ways:</para>
+
+ <para>Firstly, a registry only configuration is triggered
+ by setting
+ <smbconfoption name="config backend">registry</smbconfoption>
+ in the [global] section of <emphasis>smb.conf</emphasis>.
+ This resets everything that has been read from config files
+ to this point and reads the content of the global configuration
+ section from the registry.
+ This is the recommended method of using registry based
+ configuration.</para>
+
+ <para>Secondly, a mixed configuration can be activated
+ by a special new meaning of the parameter
+ <smbconfoption name="include">registry</smbconfoption>
+ in the [global] section of <emphasis>smb.conf</emphasis>.
+ This reads the global options from registry with the same
+ priorities as for an include of a text file.
+ This may be especially useful in cases where an initial
+ configuration is needed to access the registry.</para>
+
+ <para>Activation of global registry options automatically
+ activates registry shares. So in the registry only case,
+ shares are loaded on demand only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <para>
+ Note: To make registry-based configurations foolproof
+ at least to a certain extent, the use
+ of <parameter>lock directory</parameter> and
+ <parameter>config backend</parameter>
+ inside the registry configuration has been disabled:
+ Especially by changing the
+ <parameter>lock directory</parameter> inside the registry
+ configuration, one would create a broken setup where the daemons
+ do not see the configuration they loaded once it is active.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The registry configuration can be accessed with
+ tools like <emphasis>regedit</emphasis> or <emphasis>net (rpc)
+ registry</emphasis> in the key
+ <emphasis><literal>HKLM\Software\Samba\smbconf</literal></emphasis>.
+
+ More conveniently, the <emphasis>conf</emphasis> subcommand of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>net</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> utility
+ offers a dedicated interface to read and write the
+ registry based configuration locally, i.e. directly
+ accessing the database file, circumventing the
+ server.
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXPLANATION OF EACH PARAMETER</title>
+
+ <samba:parameterlist>
+ <xi:include href="../smbdotconf/parameters.all.xml" parse="xml"/>
+ </samba:parameterlist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>WARNINGS</title>
+
+ <para>
+ Although the configuration file permits service names to contain spaces, your client software may not.
+ Spaces will be ignored in comparisons anyway, so it shouldn't be a problem - but be aware of the possibility.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ On a similar note, many clients - especially DOS clients - limit service names to eight characters.
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle> <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> has no such
+ limitation, but attempts to connect from such clients will fail if they truncate the service names. For this
+ reason you should probably keep your service names down to eight characters in length.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ Use of the <literal>[homes]</literal> and <literal>[printers]</literal> special sections make life
+ for an administrator easy, but the various combinations of default attributes can be tricky. Take extreme
+ care when designing these sections. In particular, ensure that the permissions on spool directories are
+ correct.
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para>
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>swat</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmblookup</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>testparm</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>testprns</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink noescape="1" url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0 release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion
+ to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done by
+ Alexander Bokovoy.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smbcacls.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smbcacls.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..8674ecf1f4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smbcacls.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,265 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="smbcacls.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smbcacls</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smbcacls</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Set or get ACLs on an NT file or directory names</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbcacls</command>
+ <arg choice="req">//server/share</arg>
+ <arg choice="req">/filename</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-D|--delete acls</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-M|--modify acls</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-a|--add acls</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-S|--set acls</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-C|--chown name</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-G|--chgrp name</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-I allow|romove|copy</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--numeric</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-t</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-U username</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>smbcacls</command> program manipulates NT Access Control
+ Lists (ACLs) on SMB file shares. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <para>The following options are available to the <command>smbcacls</command> program.
+ The format of ACLs is described in the section ACL FORMAT </para>
+
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-a|--add acls</term>
+ <listitem><para>Add the ACLs specified to the ACL list. Existing
+ access control entries are unchanged. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-M|--modify acls</term>
+ <listitem><para>Modify the mask value (permissions) for the ACLs
+ specified on the command line. An error will be printed for each
+ ACL specified that was not already present in the ACL list
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-D|--delete acls</term>
+ <listitem><para>Delete any ACLs specified on the command line.
+ An error will be printed for each ACL specified that was not
+ already present in the ACL list. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-S|--set acls</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command sets the ACLs on the file with
+ only the ones specified on the command line. All other ACLs are
+ erased. Note that the ACL specified must contain at least a revision,
+ type, owner and group for the call to succeed. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-C|--chown name</term>
+ <listitem><para>The owner of a file or directory can be changed
+ to the name given using the <parameter>-C</parameter> option.
+ The name can be a sid in the form S-1-x-y-z or a name resolved
+ against the server specified in the first argument. </para>
+
+ <para>This command is a shortcut for -M OWNER:name.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-G|--chgrp name</term>
+ <listitem><para>The group owner of a file or directory can
+ be changed to the name given using the <parameter>-G</parameter>
+ option. The name can be a sid in the form S-1-x-y-z or a name
+ resolved against the server specified n the first argument.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This command is a shortcut for -M GROUP:name.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-I|--inherit allow|remove|copy</term>
+ <listitem><para>Set or unset the windows "Allow inheritable
+ permissions" check box using the <parameter>-I</parameter>
+ option. To set the check box pass allow. To unset the check
+ box pass either remove or copy. Remove will remove all
+ inherited acls. Copy will copy all the inherited acls.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--numeric</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option displays all ACL information in numeric
+ format. The default is to convert SIDs to names and ACE types
+ and masks to a readable string format. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-t|--test-args</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Don't actually do anything, only validate the correctness of
+ the arguments.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.help;
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+ &popt.common.credentials;
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>ACL FORMAT</title>
+
+ <para>The format of an ACL is one or more ACL entries separated by
+ either commas or newlines. An ACL entry is one of the following: </para>
+
+<para><programlisting>
+REVISION:&lt;revision number&gt;
+OWNER:&lt;sid or name&gt;
+GROUP:&lt;sid or name&gt;
+ACL:&lt;sid or name&gt;:&lt;type&gt;/&lt;flags&gt;/&lt;mask&gt;
+</programlisting></para>
+
+
+ <para>The revision of the ACL specifies the internal Windows
+ NT ACL revision for the security descriptor.
+ If not specified it defaults to 1. Using values other than 1 may
+ cause strange behaviour. </para>
+
+ <para>The owner and group specify the owner and group sids for the
+ object. If a SID in the format S-1-x-y-z is specified this is used,
+ otherwise the name specified is resolved using the server on which
+ the file or directory resides. </para>
+
+ <para>ACLs specify permissions granted to the SID. This SID again
+ can be specified in S-1-x-y-z format or as a name in which case
+ it is resolved against the server on which the file or directory
+ resides. The type, flags and mask values determine the type of
+ access granted to the SID. </para>
+
+ <para>The type can be either ALLOWED or DENIED to allow/deny access
+ to the SID. The flags values are generally zero for file ACLs and
+ either 9 or 2 for directory ACLs. Some common flags are: </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><constant>#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_OBJECT_INHERIT 0x1</constant></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><constant>#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_CONTAINER_INHERIT 0x2</constant></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><constant>#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_NO_PROPAGATE_INHERIT 0x4</constant></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><constant>#define SEC_ACE_FLAG_INHERIT_ONLY 0x8</constant></para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>At present flags can only be specified as decimal or
+ hexadecimal values.</para>
+
+ <para>The mask is a value which expresses the access right
+ granted to the SID. It can be given as a decimal or hexadecimal value,
+ or by using one of the following text strings which map to the NT
+ file permissions of the same name. </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>R</emphasis> - Allow read access </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>W</emphasis> - Allow write access</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>X</emphasis> - Execute permission on the object</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>D</emphasis> - Delete the object</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>P</emphasis> - Change permissions</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>O</emphasis> - Take ownership</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+
+ <para>The following combined permissions can be specified:</para>
+
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>READ</emphasis> - Equivalent to 'RX'
+ permissions</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>CHANGE</emphasis> - Equivalent to 'RXWD' permissions
+ </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>FULL</emphasis> - Equivalent to 'RWXDPO'
+ permissions</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXIT STATUS</title>
+
+ <para>The <command>smbcacls</command> program sets the exit status
+ depending on the success or otherwise of the operations performed.
+ The exit status may be one of the following values. </para>
+
+ <para>If the operation succeeded, smbcacls returns and exit
+ status of 0. If <command>smbcacls</command> couldn't connect to the specified server,
+ or there was an error getting or setting the ACLs, an exit status
+ of 1 is returned. If there was an error parsing any command line
+ arguments, an exit status of 2 is returned. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para><command>smbcacls</command> was written by Andrew Tridgell
+ and Tim Potter.</para>
+
+ <para>The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done
+ by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0 was done
+ by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smbclient.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smbclient.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..d815dcd6da
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smbclient.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,1193 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="smbclient.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smbclient</refname>
+ <refpurpose>ftp-like client to access SMB/CIFS resources
+ on servers</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbclient</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-b &lt;buffer size&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d debuglevel</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-e</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-L &lt;netbios name&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-U username</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-I destinationIP</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-M &lt;netbios name&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-m maxprotocol</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-A authfile</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-N</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-C</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-g</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-i scope</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-O &lt;socket options&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-p port</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s &lt;smb config file&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-k</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-P</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-c &lt;command&gt;</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbclient</command>
+ <arg choice="req">servicename</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">password</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-b &lt;buffer size&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d debuglevel</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-e</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-D Directory</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-U username</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-W workgroup</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-M &lt;netbios name&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-m maxprotocol</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-A authfile</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-N</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-C</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-g</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-l log-basename</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-I destinationIP</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-E</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-c &lt;command string&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-i scope</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-O &lt;socket options&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-p port</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s &lt;smb config file&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-T&lt;c|x&gt;IXFqgbNan</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-k</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>smbclient</command> is a client that can
+ 'talk' to an SMB/CIFS server. It offers an interface
+ similar to that of the ftp program (see <citerefentry><refentrytitle>ftp</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>).
+ Operations include things like getting files from the server
+ to the local machine, putting files from the local machine to
+ the server, retrieving directory information from the server
+ and so on. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>servicename</term>
+ <listitem><para>servicename is the name of the service
+ you want to use on the server. A service name takes the form
+ <filename>//server/service</filename> where <parameter>server
+ </parameter> is the NetBIOS name of the SMB/CIFS server
+ offering the desired service and <parameter>service</parameter>
+ is the name of the service offered. Thus to connect to
+ the service "printer" on the SMB/CIFS server "smbserver",
+ you would use the servicename <filename>//smbserver/printer
+ </filename></para>
+
+ <para>Note that the server name required is NOT necessarily
+ the IP (DNS) host name of the server ! The name required is
+ a NetBIOS server name, which may or may not be the
+ same as the IP hostname of the machine running the server.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>The server name is looked up according to either
+ the <parameter>-R</parameter> parameter to <command>smbclient</command> or
+ using the name resolve order parameter in
+ the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file,
+ allowing an administrator to change the order and methods
+ by which server names are looked up. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>password</term>
+ <listitem><para>The password required to access the specified
+ service on the specified server. If this parameter is
+ supplied, the <parameter>-N</parameter> option (suppress
+ password prompt) is assumed. </para>
+
+ <para>There is no default password. If no password is supplied
+ on the command line (either by using this parameter or adding
+ a password to the <parameter>-U</parameter> option (see
+ below)) and the <parameter>-N</parameter> option is not
+ specified, the client will prompt for a password, even if
+ the desired service does not require one. (If no password is
+ required, simply press ENTER to provide a null password.)
+ </para>
+
+ <para>Note: Some servers (including OS/2 and Windows for
+ Workgroups) insist on an uppercase password. Lowercase
+ or mixed case passwords may be rejected by these servers.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>Be cautious about including passwords in scripts.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-R|--name-resolve &lt;name resolve order&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option is used by the programs in the Samba
+ suite to determine what naming services and in what order to resolve
+ host names to IP addresses. The option takes a space-separated
+ string of different name resolution options.</para>
+
+ <para>The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They
+ cause names to be resolved as follows:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><constant>lmhosts</constant>: Lookup an IP
+ address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the line in lmhosts has
+ no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see
+ the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>lmhosts</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for details) then
+ any name type matches for lookup.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><constant>host</constant>: Do a standard host
+ name to IP address resolution, using the system <filename>/etc/hosts
+ </filename>, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name resolution
+ is operating system dependent, for instance on IRIX or Solaris this
+ may be controlled by the <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename>
+ file). Note that this method is only used if the NetBIOS name
+ type being queried is the 0x20 (server) name type, otherwise
+ it is ignored.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><constant>wins</constant>: Query a name with
+ the IP address listed in the <parameter>wins server</parameter>
+ parameter. If no WINS server has
+ been specified this method will be ignored.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><constant>bcast</constant>: Do a broadcast on
+ each of the known local interfaces listed in the
+ <parameter>interfaces</parameter>
+ parameter. This is the least reliable of the name resolution
+ methods as it depends on the target host being on a locally
+ connected subnet.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>If this parameter is not set then the name resolve order
+ defined in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file parameter
+ (name resolve order) will be used. </para>
+
+ <para>The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast and without
+ this parameter or any entry in the <parameter>name resolve order
+ </parameter> parameter of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file the name resolution
+ methods will be attempted in this order. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-M|--message NetBIOS name</term>
+ <listitem><para>This options allows you to send messages, using
+ the "WinPopup" protocol, to another computer. Once a connection is
+ established you then type your message, pressing ^D (control-D) to
+ end. </para>
+
+ <para>If the receiving computer is running WinPopup the user will
+ receive the message and probably a beep. If they are not running
+ WinPopup the message will be lost, and no error message will
+ occur. </para>
+
+ <para>The message is also automatically truncated if the message
+ is over 1600 bytes, as this is the limit of the protocol.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ One useful trick is to pipe the message through <command>smbclient</command>.
+ For example: smbclient -M FRED &lt; mymessage.txt will send the
+ message in the file <filename>mymessage.txt</filename> to the
+ machine FRED.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>You may also find the <parameter>-U</parameter> and
+ <parameter>-I</parameter> options useful, as they allow you to
+ control the FROM and TO parts of the message. </para>
+
+ <para>See the <parameter>message command</parameter> parameter in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for a description of how to handle incoming
+ WinPopup messages in Samba. </para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Note</emphasis>: Copy WinPopup into the startup group
+ on your WfWg PCs if you want them to always be able to receive
+ messages. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-p|--port port</term>
+ <listitem><para>This number is the TCP port number that will be used
+ when making connections to the server. The standard (well-known)
+ TCP port number for an SMB/CIFS server is 139, which is the
+ default. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-g|--grepable</term>
+ <listitem><para>This parameter provides combined with
+ <parameter>-L</parameter> easy parseable output that allows processing
+ with utilities such as grep and cut.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-m|--max-protocol protocol</term>
+ <listitem><para>This parameter sets the maximum protocol version announced by the client.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-P|--machine-pass</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Make queries to the external server using the machine account of the local server.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.help;
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-I|--ip-address IP-address</term>
+ <listitem><para><replaceable>IP address</replaceable> is the address of the server to connect to.
+ It should be specified in standard "a.b.c.d" notation. </para>
+
+ <para>Normally the client would attempt to locate a named
+ SMB/CIFS server by looking it up via the NetBIOS name resolution
+ mechanism described above in the <parameter>name resolve order</parameter>
+ parameter above. Using this parameter will force the client
+ to assume that the server is on the machine with the specified IP
+ address and the NetBIOS name component of the resource being
+ connected to will be ignored. </para>
+
+ <para>There is no default for this parameter. If not supplied,
+ it will be determined automatically by the client as described
+ above. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-E|--stderr</term>
+ <listitem><para>This parameter causes the client to write messages
+ to the standard error stream (stderr) rather than to the standard
+ output stream. </para>
+
+ <para>By default, the client writes messages to standard output
+ - typically the user's tty. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-L|--list</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option allows you to look at what services
+ are available on a server. You use it as <command>smbclient -L
+ host</command> and a list should appear. The <parameter>-I
+ </parameter> option may be useful if your NetBIOS names don't
+ match your TCP/IP DNS host names or if you are trying to reach a
+ host on another network. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-b|--send-buffer buffersize</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option changes the transmit/send buffer
+ size when getting or putting a file from/to the server. The default
+ is 65520 bytes. Setting this value smaller (to 1200 bytes) has been
+ observed to speed up file transfers to and from a Win9x server.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-e|--encrypt</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command line parameter requires the remote
+ server support the UNIX extensions. Request that the connection be
+ encrypted. This is new for Samba 3.2 and will only work with Samba
+ 3.2 or above servers. Negotiates SMB encryption using GSSAPI. Uses
+ the given credentials for the encryption negotiation (either kerberos
+ or NTLMv1/v2 if given domain/username/password triple. Fails the
+ connection if encryption cannot be negotiated.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.client.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+ &popt.common.credentials;
+ &popt.common.connection;
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-T|--tar tar options</term>
+ <listitem><para>smbclient may be used to create <command>tar(1)
+ </command> compatible backups of all the files on an SMB/CIFS
+ share. The secondary tar flags that can be given to this option
+ are : </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><parameter>c</parameter> - Create a tar file on UNIX.
+ Must be followed by the name of a tar file, tape device
+ or "-" for standard output. If using standard output you must
+ turn the log level to its lowest value -d0 to avoid corrupting
+ your tar file. This flag is mutually exclusive with the
+ <parameter>x</parameter> flag. </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><parameter>x</parameter> - Extract (restore) a local
+ tar file back to a share. Unless the -D option is given, the tar
+ files will be restored from the top level of the share. Must be
+ followed by the name of the tar file, device or "-" for standard
+ input. Mutually exclusive with the <parameter>c</parameter> flag.
+ Restored files have their creation times (mtime) set to the
+ date saved in the tar file. Directories currently do not get
+ their creation dates restored properly. </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><parameter>I</parameter> - Include files and directories.
+ Is the default behavior when filenames are specified above. Causes
+ files to be included in an extract or create (and therefore
+ everything else to be excluded). See example below. Filename globbing
+ works in one of two ways. See <parameter>r</parameter> below. </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><parameter>X</parameter> - Exclude files and directories.
+ Causes files to be excluded from an extract or create. See
+ example below. Filename globbing works in one of two ways now.
+ See <parameter>r</parameter> below. </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><parameter>F</parameter> - File containing a list of files and directories.
+ The <parameter>F</parameter> causes the name following the tarfile to
+ create to be read as a filename that contains a list of files and directories to
+ be included in an extract or create (and therefore everything else to be excluded).
+ See example below. Filename globbing works in one of two ways.
+ See <parameter>r</parameter> below.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><parameter>b</parameter> - Blocksize. Must be followed
+ by a valid (greater than zero) blocksize. Causes tar file to be
+ written out in blocksize*TBLOCK (usually 512 byte) blocks.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><parameter>g</parameter> - Incremental. Only back up
+ files that have the archive bit set. Useful only with the
+ <parameter>c</parameter> flag. </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><parameter>q</parameter> - Quiet. Keeps tar from printing
+ diagnostics as it works. This is the same as tarmode quiet.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><parameter>r</parameter> - Regular expression include
+ or exclude. Uses regular expression matching for
+ excluding or excluding files if compiled with HAVE_REGEX_H.
+ However this mode can be very slow. If not compiled with
+ HAVE_REGEX_H, does a limited wildcard match on '*' and '?'.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><parameter>N</parameter> - Newer than. Must be followed
+ by the name of a file whose date is compared against files found
+ on the share during a create. Only files newer than the file
+ specified are backed up to the tar file. Useful only with the
+ <parameter>c</parameter> flag. </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><parameter>a</parameter> - Set archive bit. Causes the
+ archive bit to be reset when a file is backed up. Useful with the
+ <parameter>g</parameter> and <parameter>c</parameter> flags.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Tar Long File Names</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para><command>smbclient</command>'s tar option now supports long
+ file names both on backup and restore. However, the full path
+ name of the file must be less than 1024 bytes. Also, when
+ a tar archive is created, <command>smbclient</command>'s tar option places all
+ files in the archive with relative names, not absolute names.
+ </para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Tar Filenames</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>All file names can be given as DOS path names (with '\\'
+ as the component separator) or as UNIX path names (with '/' as
+ the component separator). </para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Examples</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Restore from tar file <filename>backup.tar</filename> into myshare on mypc
+ (no password on share). </para>
+
+ <para><command>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -Tx backup.tar
+ </command></para>
+
+ <para>Restore everything except <filename>users/docs</filename>
+ </para>
+
+ <para><command>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -TXx backup.tar
+ users/docs</command></para>
+
+ <para>Create a tar file of the files beneath <filename>
+ users/docs</filename>. </para>
+
+ <para><command>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -Tc
+ backup.tar users/docs </command></para>
+
+ <para>Create the same tar file as above, but now use
+ a DOS path name. </para>
+
+ <para><command>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -tc backup.tar
+ users\edocs </command></para>
+
+ <para>Create a tar file of the files listed in the file <filename>tarlist</filename>.</para>
+
+ <para><command>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -TcF
+ backup.tar tarlist</command></para>
+
+ <para>Create a tar file of all the files and directories in
+ the share. </para>
+
+ <para><command>smbclient //mypc/myshare "" -N -Tc backup.tar *
+ </command></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-D|--directory initial directory</term>
+ <listitem><para>Change to initial directory before starting. Probably
+ only of any use with the tar -T option. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-c|--command command string</term>
+ <listitem><para>command string is a semicolon-separated list of
+ commands to be executed instead of prompting from stdin. <parameter>
+ -N</parameter> is implied by <parameter>-c</parameter>.</para>
+
+ <para>This is particularly useful in scripts and for printing stdin
+ to the server, e.g. <command>-c 'print -'</command>. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPERATIONS</title>
+
+ <para>Once the client is running, the user is presented with
+ a prompt : </para>
+
+ <para><prompt>smb:\&gt; </prompt></para>
+
+ <para>The backslash ("\\") indicates the current working directory
+ on the server, and will change if the current working directory
+ is changed. </para>
+
+ <para>The prompt indicates that the client is ready and waiting to
+ carry out a user command. Each command is a single word, optionally
+ followed by parameters specific to that command. Command and parameters
+ are space-delimited unless these notes specifically
+ state otherwise. All commands are case-insensitive. Parameters to
+ commands may or may not be case sensitive, depending on the command.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>You can specify file names which have spaces in them by quoting
+ the name with double quotes, for example "a long file name". </para>
+
+ <para>Parameters shown in square brackets (e.g., "[parameter]") are
+ optional. If not given, the command will use suitable defaults. Parameters
+ shown in angle brackets (e.g., "&lt;parameter&gt;") are required.
+ </para>
+
+
+ <para>Note that all commands operating on the server are actually
+ performed by issuing a request to the server. Thus the behavior may
+ vary from server to server, depending on how the server was implemented.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>The commands available are given here in alphabetical order. </para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>? [command]</term>
+ <listitem><para>If <replaceable>command</replaceable> is specified, the ? command will display
+ a brief informative message about the specified command. If no
+ command is specified, a list of available commands will
+ be displayed. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>! [shell command]</term>
+ <listitem><para>If <replaceable>shell command</replaceable> is specified, the !
+ command will execute a shell locally and run the specified shell
+ command. If no command is specified, a local shell will be run.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>allinfo file</term>
+ <listitem><para>The client will request that the server return
+ all known information about a file or directory (including streams).
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>altname file</term>
+ <listitem><para>The client will request that the server return
+ the "alternate" name (the 8.3 name) for a file or directory.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>archive &lt;number&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Sets the archive level when operating on files.
+ 0 means ignore the archive bit, 1 means only operate on files with this bit set,
+ 2 means only operate on files with this bit set and reset it after operation,
+ 3 means operate on all files and reset it after operation. The default is 0.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>backup</term>
+ <listitem><para>Toggle the state of the "backup intent" flag
+ sent to the server on directory listings and file opens. If
+ the "backup intent" flag is true, the server will try and
+ bypass some file system checks if the user has been granted
+ SE_BACKUP or SE_RESTORE privilages. This state is useful when
+ performing a backup or restore operation.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>blocksize &lt;number&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Sets the blocksize parameter for a tar operation. The default is 20.
+ Causes tar file to be written out in blocksize*TBLOCK (normally 512 byte) units.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>cancel jobid0 [jobid1] ... [jobidN]</term>
+ <listitem><para>The client will request that the server cancel
+ the printjobs identified by the given numeric print job ids.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>case_sensitive</term>
+ <listitem><para>Toggles the setting of the flag in SMB packets that
+ tells the server to treat filenames as case sensitive. Set to OFF by
+ default (tells file server to treat filenames as case insensitive). Only
+ currently affects Samba 3.0.5 and above file servers with the case sensitive
+ parameter set to auto in the smb.conf.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>cd &lt;directory name&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>If "directory name" is specified, the current
+ working directory on the server will be changed to the directory
+ specified. This operation will fail if for any reason the specified
+ directory is inaccessible. </para>
+
+ <para>If no directory name is specified, the current working
+ directory on the server will be reported. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>chmod file mode in octal</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. The client requests that the server
+ change the UNIX permissions to the given octal mode, in standard UNIX format.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>chown file uid gid</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. The client requests that the server
+ change the UNIX user and group ownership to the given decimal values. Note there is
+ currently no way to remotely look up the UNIX uid and gid values for a given name.
+ This may be addressed in future versions of the CIFS UNIX extensions.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>close &lt;fileid&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Closes a file explicitly opened by the open command. Used for
+ internal Samba testing purposes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>del &lt;mask&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>The client will request that the server attempt
+ to delete all files matching <replaceable>mask</replaceable> from the current working
+ directory on the server. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>dir &lt;mask&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>A list of the files matching <replaceable>mask</replaceable> in the current
+ working directory on the server will be retrieved from the server
+ and displayed. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>du &lt;filename&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Does a directory listing and then prints out the current disk usage and free space on a share.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>echo &lt;number&gt; &lt;data&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Does an SMBecho request to ping the server. Used for internal Samba testing purposes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>exit</term>
+ <listitem><para>Terminate the connection with the server and exit
+ from the program. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>get &lt;remote file name&gt; [local file name]</term>
+ <listitem><para>Copy the file called <filename>remote file name</filename> from
+ the server to the machine running the client. If specified, name
+ the local copy <filename>local file name</filename>. Note that all transfers in
+ <command>smbclient</command> are binary. See also the
+ lowercase command. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>getfacl &lt;filename&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Requires the server support the UNIX extensions. Requests and prints
+ the POSIX ACL on a file.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>hardlink &lt;src&gt; &lt;dest&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Creates a hardlink on the server using Windows CIFS semantics.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>help [command]</term>
+ <listitem><para>See the ? command above. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>history</term> <listitem><para>Displays the command history.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>iosize &lt;bytes&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>When sending or receiving files, smbclient uses an
+ internal memory buffer by default of size 64512 bytes. This command
+ allows this size to be set to any range between 16384 (0x4000) bytes
+ and 16776960 (0xFFFF00) bytes. Larger sizes may mean more efficient
+ data transfer as smbclient will try and use the most efficient
+ read and write calls for the connected server.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>lcd [directory name]</term>
+ <listitem><para>If <replaceable>directory name</replaceable> is specified, the current
+ working directory on the local machine will be changed to
+ the directory specified. This operation will fail if for any
+ reason the specified directory is inaccessible. </para>
+
+ <para>If no directory name is specified, the name of the
+ current working directory on the local machine will be reported.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>link target linkname</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. The client requests that the server
+ create a hard link between the linkname and target files. The linkname file
+ must not exist.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>listconnect</term>
+ <listitem><para>Show the current connections held for DFS purposes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>lock &lt;filenum&gt; &lt;r|w&gt; &lt;hex-start&gt; &lt;hex-len&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. Tries to set a POSIX
+ fcntl lock of the given type on the given range. Used for internal Samba testing purposes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>logon &lt;username&gt; &lt;password&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Establishes a new vuid for this session by logging on again.
+ Replaces the current vuid. Prints out the new vuid. Used for internal Samba testing purposes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>logoff</term>
+ <listitem><para>Logs the user off the server, closing the session.
+ Used for internal Samba testing purposes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>lowercase</term>
+ <listitem><para>Toggle lowercasing of filenames for the get and
+ mget commands.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>When lowercasing is toggled ON, local filenames are converted
+ to lowercase when using the get and mget commands. This is
+ often useful when copying (say) MSDOS files from a server, because
+ lowercase filenames are the norm on UNIX systems. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>ls &lt;mask&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>See the dir command above. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>mask &lt;mask&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command allows the user to set up a mask
+ which will be used during recursive operation of the mget and
+ mput commands. </para>
+
+ <para>The masks specified to the mget and mput commands act as
+ filters for directories rather than files when recursion is
+ toggled ON. </para>
+
+ <para>The mask specified with the mask command is necessary
+ to filter files within those directories. For example, if the
+ mask specified in an mget command is "source*" and the mask
+ specified with the mask command is "*.c" and recursion is
+ toggled ON, the mget command will retrieve all files matching
+ "*.c" in all directories below and including all directories
+ matching "source*" in the current working directory. </para>
+
+ <para>Note that the value for mask defaults to blank (equivalent
+ to "*") and remains so until the mask command is used to change it.
+ It retains the most recently specified value indefinitely. To
+ avoid unexpected results it would be wise to change the value of
+ mask back to "*" after using the mget or mput commands. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>md &lt;directory name&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>See the mkdir command. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>mget &lt;mask&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Copy all files matching <replaceable>mask</replaceable> from the server to
+ the machine running the client. </para>
+
+ <para>Note that <replaceable>mask</replaceable> is interpreted differently during recursive
+ operation and non-recursive operation - refer to the recurse and
+ mask commands for more information. Note that all transfers in
+ <command>smbclient</command> are binary. See also the lowercase command. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>mkdir &lt;directory name&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Create a new directory on the server (user access
+ privileges permitting) with the specified name. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>more &lt;file name&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Fetch a remote file and view it with the contents
+ of your PAGER environment variable.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>mput &lt;mask&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Copy all files matching <replaceable>mask</replaceable> in the current working
+ directory on the local machine to the current working directory on
+ the server. </para>
+
+ <para>Note that <replaceable>mask</replaceable> is interpreted differently during recursive
+ operation and non-recursive operation - refer to the recurse and mask
+ commands for more information. Note that all transfers in <command>smbclient</command>
+ are binary. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>posix</term>
+ <listitem><para>Query the remote server to see if it supports the CIFS UNIX
+ extensions and prints out the list of capabilities supported. If so, turn
+ on POSIX pathname processing and large file read/writes (if available),.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>posix_encrypt &lt;domain&gt; &lt;username&gt; &lt;password&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. Attempt to negotiate
+ SMB encryption on this connection. If smbclient connected with kerberos
+ credentials (-k) the arguments to this command are ignored and the kerberos
+ credentials are used to negotiate GSSAPI signing and sealing instead. See
+ also the -e option to smbclient to force encryption on initial connection.
+ This command is new with Samba 3.2.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>posix_open &lt;filename&gt; &lt;octal mode&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. Opens a remote file
+ using the CIFS UNIX extensions and prints a fileid. Used for internal Samba
+ testing purposes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>posix_mkdir &lt;directoryname&gt; &lt;octal mode&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. Creates a remote directory
+ using the CIFS UNIX extensions with the given mode.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>posix_rmdir &lt;directoryname&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. Deletes a remote directory
+ using the CIFS UNIX extensions.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>posix_unlink &lt;filename&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. Deletes a remote file
+ using the CIFS UNIX extensions.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>print &lt;file name&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Print the specified file from the local machine
+ through a printable service on the server. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>prompt</term>
+ <listitem><para>Toggle prompting for filenames during operation
+ of the mget and mput commands. </para>
+
+ <para>When toggled ON, the user will be prompted to confirm
+ the transfer of each file during these commands. When toggled
+ OFF, all specified files will be transferred without prompting.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>put &lt;local file name&gt; [remote file name]</term>
+ <listitem><para>Copy the file called <filename>local file name</filename> from the
+ machine running the client to the server. If specified,
+ name the remote copy <filename>remote file name</filename>. Note that all transfers
+ in <command>smbclient</command> are binary. See also the lowercase command.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>queue</term>
+ <listitem><para>Displays the print queue, showing the job id,
+ name, size and current status. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>quit</term>
+ <listitem><para>See the exit command. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>readlink symlinkname</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. Print
+ the value of the symlink "symlinkname".
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>rd &lt;directory name&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>See the rmdir command. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>recurse</term>
+ <listitem><para>Toggle directory recursion for the commands mget
+ and mput. </para>
+
+ <para>When toggled ON, these commands will process all directories
+ in the source directory (i.e., the directory they are copying
+ from ) and will recurse into any that match the mask specified
+ to the command. Only files that match the mask specified using
+ the mask command will be retrieved. See also the mask command.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>When recursion is toggled OFF, only files from the current
+ working directory on the source machine that match the mask specified
+ to the mget or mput commands will be copied, and any mask specified
+ using the mask command will be ignored. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>rename &lt;old filename&gt; &lt;new filename&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Rename files in the current working directory on the
+ server from <replaceable>old filename</replaceable> to
+ <replaceable>new filename</replaceable>. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>rm &lt;mask&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Remove all files matching <replaceable>mask</replaceable> from the current
+ working directory on the server. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>rmdir &lt;directory name&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Remove the specified directory (user access
+ privileges permitting) from the server. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>setmode &lt;filename&gt; &lt;perm=[+|\-]rsha&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>A version of the DOS attrib command to set
+ file permissions. For example: </para>
+
+ <para><command>setmode myfile +r </command></para>
+
+ <para>would make myfile read only. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>showconnect</term>
+ <listitem><para>Show the currently active connection held for DFS purposes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>stat file</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. The client requests the
+ UNIX basic info level and prints out the same info that the Linux stat command
+ would about the file. This includes the size, blocks used on disk, file type,
+ permissions, inode number, number of links and finally the three timestamps
+ (access, modify and change). If the file is a special file (symlink, character or
+ block device, fifo or socket) then extra information may also be printed.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>symlink target linkname</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. The client requests that the server
+ create a symbolic hard link between the target and linkname files. The linkname file
+ must not exist. Note that the server will not create a link to any path that lies
+ outside the currently connected share. This is enforced by the Samba server.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>tar &lt;c|x&gt;[IXbgNa]</term>
+ <listitem><para>Performs a tar operation - see the <parameter>-T
+ </parameter> command line option above. Behavior may be affected
+ by the tarmode command (see below). Using g (incremental) and N
+ (newer) will affect tarmode settings. Note that using the "-" option
+ with tar x may not work - use the command line option instead.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>blocksize &lt;blocksize&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Blocksize. Must be followed by a valid (greater
+ than zero) blocksize. Causes tar file to be written out in
+ <replaceable>blocksize</replaceable>*TBLOCK (usually 512 byte) blocks. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>tarmode &lt;full|inc|reset|noreset&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Changes tar's behavior with regard to archive
+ bits. In full mode, tar will back up everything regardless of the
+ archive bit setting (this is the default mode). In incremental mode,
+ tar will only back up files with the archive bit set. In reset mode,
+ tar will reset the archive bit on all files it backs up (implies
+ read/write share). </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>unlock &lt;filenum&gt; &lt;hex-start&gt; &lt;hex-len&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command depends on the server supporting the CIFS
+ UNIX extensions and will fail if the server does not. Tries to unlock a POSIX
+ fcntl lock on the given range. Used for internal Samba testing purposes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>volume</term>
+ <listitem><para>Prints the current volume name of the share.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>vuid &lt;number&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Changes the currently used vuid in the protocol to
+ the given arbitrary number. Without an argument prints out the current
+ vuid being used. Used for internal Samba testing purposes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>tcon &lt;sharename&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Establishes a new tree connect (connection to a share).
+ Replaces the current tree connect. Prints the new tid (tree id).
+ Used for internal Samba testing purposes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>tdis</term>
+ <listitem><para>Close the current share connection (tree disconnect).
+ Used for internal Samba testing purposes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>tid &lt;number&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Changes the current tree id (tid) in the
+ protocol to a new arbitrary number. Without an argument, it
+ prints out the tid currently used.
+ Used for internal Samba testing purposes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>NOTES</title>
+
+ <para>Some servers are fussy about the case of supplied usernames,
+ passwords, share names (AKA service names) and machine names.
+ If you fail to connect try giving all parameters in uppercase.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>It is often necessary to use the -n option when connecting
+ to some types of servers. For example OS/2 LanManager insists
+ on a valid NetBIOS name being used, so you need to supply a valid
+ name that would be known to the server.</para>
+
+ <para>smbclient supports long file names where the server
+ supports the LANMAN2 protocol or above. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</title>
+
+ <para>The variable <envar>USER</envar> may contain the
+ username of the person using the client. This information is
+ used only if the protocol level is high enough to support
+ session-level passwords.</para>
+
+
+ <para>The variable <envar>PASSWD</envar> may contain
+ the password of the person using the client. This information is
+ used only if the protocol level is high enough to support
+ session-level passwords. </para>
+
+ <para>The variable <envar>LIBSMB_PROG</envar> may contain
+ the path, executed with system(), which the client should connect
+ to instead of connecting to a server. This functionality is primarily
+ intended as a development aid, and works best when using a LMHOSTS
+ file</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>INSTALLATION</title>
+
+ <para>The location of the client program is a matter for
+ individual system administrators. The following are thus
+ suggestions only. </para>
+
+ <para>It is recommended that the smbclient software be installed
+ in the <filename>/usr/local/samba/bin/</filename> or <filename>
+ /usr/samba/bin/</filename> directory, this directory readable
+ by all, writeable only by root. The client program itself should
+ be executable by all. The client should <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> be
+ setuid or setgid! </para>
+
+ <para>The client log files should be put in a directory readable
+ and writeable only by the user. </para>
+
+ <para>To test the client, you will need to know the name of a
+ running SMB/CIFS server. It is possible to run <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> as an ordinary user - running that server as a daemon
+ on a user-accessible port (typically any port number over 1024)
+ would provide a suitable test server. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DIAGNOSTICS</title>
+
+ <para>Most diagnostics issued by the client are logged in a
+ specified log file. The log file name is specified at compile time,
+ but may be overridden on the command line. </para>
+
+ <para>The number and nature of diagnostics available depends
+ on the debug level used by the client. If you have problems,
+ set the debug level to 3 and peruse the log files. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.2 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba 3.0
+ was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smbcontrol.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smbcontrol.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..fbed772039
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smbcontrol.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,330 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="smbcontrol.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smbcontrol</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smbcontrol</refname>
+ <refpurpose>send messages to smbd, nmbd or winbindd processes</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbcontrol</command>
+ <arg>-i</arg>
+ <arg>-s</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbcontrol</command>
+ <arg>destination</arg>
+ <arg>message-type</arg>
+ <arg>parameter</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>smbcontrol</command> is a very small program, which
+ sends messages to a <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, a <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, or a <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon running on the system.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ &stdarg.help;
+ &stdarg.configfile;
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-i</term>
+ <listitem><para>Run interactively. Individual commands
+ of the form destination message-type parameters can be entered
+ on STDIN. An empty command line or a "q" will quit the
+ program.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>destination</term>
+ <listitem><para>One of <parameter>nmbd</parameter>, <parameter>smbd</parameter> or a process ID.</para>
+
+ <para>The <parameter>all</parameter> destination causes the
+ message to "broadcast" to all running daemons including nmbd and
+ winbind. This is a change for Samba 3.3, prior to this the
+ parameter smbd used to do this.</para>
+
+ <para>The <parameter>smbd</parameter> destination causes the
+ message to be sent to the smbd daemon specified in the
+ <filename>smbd.pid</filename> file.</para>
+
+ <para>The <parameter>nmbd</parameter> destination causes the
+ message to be sent to the nmbd daemon specified in the
+ <filename>nmbd.pid</filename> file.</para>
+
+ <para>The <parameter>winbindd</parameter> destination causes the
+ message to be sent to the winbind daemon specified in the
+ <filename>winbindd.pid</filename> file.</para>
+
+ <para>If a single process ID is given, the message is sent
+ to only that process.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>message-type</term>
+ <listitem><para>Type of message to send. See
+ the section <constant>MESSAGE-TYPES</constant> for details.
+ </para></listitem></varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>parameters</term>
+ <listitem><para>any parameters required for the message-type</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>MESSAGE-TYPES</title>
+
+ <para>Available message types are:</para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>close-share</term>
+ <listitem><para>Order smbd to close the client
+ connections to the named share. Note that this doesn't affect client
+ connections to any other shares. This message-type takes an argument of the
+ share name for which client connections will be closed, or the
+ "*" character which will close all currently open shares.
+ This may be useful if you made changes to the access controls on the share.
+ This message can only be sent to <constant>smbd</constant>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>debug</term>
+ <listitem><para>Set debug level to the value specified by the
+ parameter. This can be sent to any of the destinations. If this
+ message is sent to either the smbd or winbindd daemons, the parent
+ process will rebroadcast the message to all child processes changing
+ the debug level in each one.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>force-election</term>
+ <listitem><para>This message causes the <command>nmbd</command> daemon to
+ force a new browse master election. </para>
+ </listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>ping</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Send specified number of "ping" messages and
+ wait for the same number of reply "pong" messages. This can be sent to
+ any of the destinations.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>profile</term>
+ <listitem><para>Change profile settings of a daemon, based on the
+ parameter. The parameter can be "on" to turn on profile stats
+ collection, "off" to turn off profile stats collection, "count"
+ to enable only collection of count stats (time stats are
+ disabled), and "flush" to zero the current profile stats. This can
+ be sent to any smbd or nmbd destinations.</para>
+ </listitem></varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>debuglevel</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Request debuglevel of a certain daemon and write it to stdout. This
+ can be sent to any of the destinations.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>profilelevel</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Request profilelevel of a certain daemon and write it to stdout.
+ This can be sent to any smbd or nmbd destinations.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>printnotify</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Order smbd to send a printer notify message to any Windows NT clients
+ connected to a printer. This message-type takes the following arguments:
+ </para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>queuepause printername</term>
+ <listitem><para>Send a queue pause change notify
+ message to the printer specified.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>queueresume printername</term>
+ <listitem><para>Send a queue resume change notify
+ message for the printer specified.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>jobpause printername unixjobid</term>
+ <listitem><para>Send a job pause change notify
+ message for the printer and unix jobid
+ specified.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>jobresume printername unixjobid</term>
+ <listitem><para>Send a job resume change notify
+ message for the printer and unix jobid
+ specified.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>jobdelete printername unixjobid</term>
+ <listitem><para>Send a job delete change notify
+ message for the printer and unix jobid
+ specified.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ <para>
+ Note that this message only sends notification that an
+ event has occurred. It doesn't actually cause the
+ event to happen.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This message can only be sent to <constant>smbd</constant>. </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>dmalloc-mark</term>
+ <listitem><para>Set a mark for dmalloc. Can be sent to both smbd and nmbd. Only available if samba is built with dmalloc support. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>dmalloc-log-changed</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Dump the pointers that have changed since the mark set by dmalloc-mark.
+ Can be sent to both smbd and nmbd. Only available if samba is built with dmalloc support. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>shutdown</term>
+ <listitem><para>Shut down specified daemon. Can be sent to both smbd and nmbd.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>pool-usage</term>
+ <listitem><para>Print a human-readable description of all
+ talloc(pool) memory usage by the specified daemon/process. Available
+ for both smbd and nmbd.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>drvupgrade</term>
+ <listitem><para>Force clients of printers using specified driver
+ to update their local version of the driver. Can only be
+ sent to smbd.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>reload-config</term>
+ <listitem><para>Force daemon to reload smb.conf configuration file. Can be sent
+ to <constant>smbd</constant>, <constant>nmbd</constant>, or <constant>winbindd</constant>.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>reload-printers</term>
+ <listitem><para>Force smbd to reload printers. Can only be sent to
+ <constant>smbd</constant>.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>idmap</term>
+ <listitem><para>Notify about changes of id mapping. Can be sent
+ to <constant>smbd</constant> or (not implemented yet) <constant>winbindd</constant>.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>flush [uid|gid]</term>
+ <listitem><para>Flush caches for sid &lt;-&gt; gid and/or sid &lt;-&gt; uid mapping.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>delete &lt;ID&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Remove a mapping from cache. The mapping is given by &lt;ID&gt;
+ which may either be a sid: S-x-..., a gid: "GID number" or a uid: "UID number".
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>kill &lt;ID&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>Remove a mapping from cache. Terminate <constant>smbd</constant> if
+ the id is currently in use.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+</variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for
+ Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smbcquotas.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smbcquotas.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..de43878ca7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smbcquotas.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,183 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="smbcquotas.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smbcquotas</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smbcquotas</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Set or get QUOTAs of NTFS 5 shares</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbcquotas</command>
+ <arg choice="req">//server/share</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-u user</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-L</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-F</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-S QUOTA_SET_COMMAND</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-n</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-t</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-v</arg>
+
+ <arg choice="opt">-d debuglevel</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s configfile</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-l logdir</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-V</arg>
+
+ <arg choice="opt">-U username</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-N</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-k</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-A</arg>
+
+
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>smbcquotas</command> program manipulates NT Quotas on SMB file shares. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <para>The following options are available to the <command>smbcquotas</command> program. </para>
+
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-u user</term>
+ <listitem><para> Specifies the user of whom the quotas are get or set.
+ By default the current user's username will be used.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-L</term>
+ <listitem><para>Lists all quota records of the share.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-F</term>
+ <listitem><para>Show the share quota status and default limits.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-S QUOTA_SET_COMMAND</term>
+ <listitem><para>This command sets/modifies quotas for a user or on the share,
+ depending on the QUOTA_SET_COMMAND parameter which is described later.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-n</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option displays all QUOTA information in numeric
+ format. The default is to convert SIDs to names and QUOTA limits
+ to a readable string format.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-t</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Don't actually do anything, only validate the correctness of the arguments.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-v</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Be verbose.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.help;
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+ &popt.common.credentials;
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>QUOTA_SET_COMMAND</title>
+
+ <para>The format of an the QUOTA_SET_COMMAND is an operation
+ name followed by a set of parameters specific to that operation.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>To set user quotas for the user specified by -u or for the
+ current username: </para>
+
+ <para><userinput>
+ UQLIM:&lt;username&gt;:&lt;softlimit&gt;/&lt;hardlimit&gt;
+ </userinput></para>
+
+ <para>To set the default quotas for a share:
+ </para>
+
+ <para><userinput>
+ FSQLIM:&lt;softlimit&gt;/&lt;hardlimit&gt;
+ </userinput></para>
+
+ <para>
+ To change the share quota settings:
+ </para>
+
+ <para><userinput>
+ FSQFLAGS:QUOTA_ENABLED/DENY_DISK/LOG_SOFTLIMIT/LOG_HARD_LIMIT
+ </userinput></para>
+
+ <para>All limits are specified as a number of bytes.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXIT STATUS</title>
+
+ <para>The <command>smbcquotas</command> program sets the exit status
+ depending on the success or otherwise of the operations performed.
+ The exit status may be one of the following values. </para>
+
+ <para>If the operation succeeded, smbcquotas returns an exit
+ status of 0. If <command>smbcquotas</command> couldn't connect to the specified server,
+ or when there was an error getting or setting the quota(s), an exit status
+ of 1 is returned. If there was an error parsing any command line
+ arguments, an exit status of 2 is returned. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para><command>smbcquotas</command> was written by Stefan Metzmacher.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smbd.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smbd.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..618ff821f4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smbd.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,445 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="smbd.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smbd</refname>
+ <refpurpose>server to provide SMB/CIFS services to clients</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbd</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-D</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-F</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-S</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-i</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-V</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-b</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d &lt;debug level&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-l &lt;log directory&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-p &lt;port number(s)&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-P &lt;profiling level&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-O &lt;socket option&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+ <para>This program is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>smbd</command> is the server daemon that
+ provides filesharing and printing services to Windows clients.
+ The server provides filespace and printer services to
+ clients using the SMB (or CIFS) protocol. This is compatible
+ with the LanManager protocol, and can service LanManager
+ clients. These include MSCLIENT 3.0 for DOS, Windows for
+ Workgroups, Windows 95/98/ME, Windows NT, Windows 2000,
+ OS/2, DAVE for Macintosh, and smbfs for Linux.</para>
+
+ <para>An extensive description of the services that the
+ server can provide is given in the man page for the
+ configuration file controlling the attributes of those
+ services (see <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>. This man page will not describe the
+ services, but will concentrate on the administrative aspects
+ of running the server.</para>
+
+ <para>Please note that there are significant security
+ implications to running this server, and the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> manual page should be regarded as mandatory reading before
+ proceeding with installation.</para>
+
+ <para>A session is created whenever a client requests one.
+ Each client gets a copy of the server for each session. This
+ copy then services all connections made by the client during
+ that session. When all connections from its client are closed,
+ the copy of the server for that client terminates.</para>
+
+ <para>The configuration file, and any files that it includes,
+ are automatically reloaded every minute, if they change. You
+ can force a reload by sending a SIGHUP to the server. Reloading
+ the configuration file will not affect connections to any service
+ that is already established. Either the user will have to
+ disconnect from the service, or <command>smbd</command> killed and restarted.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-D</term>
+ <listitem><para>If specified, this parameter causes
+ the server to operate as a daemon. That is, it detaches
+ itself and runs in the background, fielding requests
+ on the appropriate port. Operating the server as a
+ daemon is the recommended way of running <command>smbd</command> for
+ servers that provide more than casual use file and
+ print services. This switch is assumed if <command>smbd
+ </command> is executed on the command line of a shell.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-F</term>
+ <listitem><para>If specified, this parameter causes
+ the main <command>smbd</command> process to not daemonize,
+ i.e. double-fork and disassociate with the terminal.
+ Child processes are still created as normal to service
+ each connection request, but the main process does not
+ exit. This operation mode is suitable for running
+ <command>smbd</command> under process supervisors such
+ as <command>supervise</command> and <command>svscan</command>
+ from Daniel J. Bernstein's <command>daemontools</command>
+ package, or the AIX process monitor.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-S</term>
+ <listitem><para>If specified, this parameter causes
+ <command>smbd</command> to log to standard output rather
+ than a file.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-i</term>
+ <listitem><para>If this parameter is specified it causes the
+ server to run "interactively", not as a daemon, even if the
+ server is executed on the command line of a shell. Setting this
+ parameter negates the implicit daemon mode when run from the
+ command line. <command>smbd</command> also logs to standard
+ output, as if the <command>-S</command> parameter had been
+ given.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+ &stdarg.help;
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-b</term>
+ <listitem><para>Prints information about how
+ Samba was built.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-p|--port&lt;port number(s)&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para><replaceable>port number(s)</replaceable> is a
+ space or comma-separated list of TCP ports smbd should listen on.
+ The default value is taken from the <smbconfoption name="ports"/> parameter in &smb.conf;</para>
+
+ <para>The default ports are 139 (used for SMB over NetBIOS over TCP)
+ and port 445 (used for plain SMB over TCP).
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-P|--profiling-level&lt;profiling level&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para><replaceable>profiling level</replaceable> is a
+ number specifying the level of profiling data to be collected.
+ 0 turns off profiling, 1 turns on counter profiling only,
+ 2 turns on complete profiling, and 3 resets all profiling data.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>FILES</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><filename>/etc/inetd.conf</filename></term>
+ <listitem><para>If the server is to be run by the
+ <command>inetd</command> meta-daemon, this file
+ must contain suitable startup information for the
+ meta-daemon.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><filename>/etc/rc</filename></term>
+ <listitem><para>or whatever initialization script your
+ system uses).</para>
+
+ <para>If running the server as a daemon at startup,
+ this file will need to contain an appropriate startup
+ sequence for the server. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><filename>/etc/services</filename></term>
+ <listitem><para>If running the server via the
+ meta-daemon <command>inetd</command>, this file
+ must contain a mapping of service name (e.g., netbios-ssn)
+ to service port (e.g., 139) and protocol type (e.g., tcp).
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><filename>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</filename></term>
+ <listitem><para>This is the default location of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> server configuration file. Other common places that systems
+ install this file are <filename>/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</filename>
+ and <filename>/etc/samba/smb.conf</filename>.</para>
+
+ <para>This file describes all the services the server
+ is to make available to clients. See <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for more information.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>LIMITATIONS</title>
+ <para>On some systems <command>smbd</command> cannot change uid back
+ to root after a setuid() call. Such systems are called
+ trapdoor uid systems. If you have such a system,
+ you will be unable to connect from a client (such as a PC) as
+ two different users at once. Attempts to connect the
+ second user will result in access denied or
+ similar.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><envar>PRINTER</envar></term>
+ <listitem><para>If no printer name is specified to
+ printable services, most systems will use the value of
+ this variable (or <constant>lp</constant> if this variable is
+ not defined) as the name of the printer to use. This
+ is not specific to the server, however.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>PAM INTERACTION</title>
+ <para>Samba uses PAM for authentication (when presented with a plaintext
+ password), for account checking (is this account disabled?) and for
+ session management. The degree too which samba supports PAM is restricted
+ by the limitations of the SMB protocol and the <smbconfoption name="obey pam restrictions"/> <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> parameter. When this is set, the following restrictions apply:
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>Account Validation</emphasis>: All accesses to a
+ samba server are checked
+ against PAM to see if the account is valid, not disabled and is permitted to
+ login at this time. This also applies to encrypted logins.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>Session Management</emphasis>: When not using share
+ level security, users must pass PAM's session checks before access
+ is granted. Note however, that this is bypassed in share level security.
+ Note also that some older pam configuration files may need a line
+ added for session support.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DIAGNOSTICS</title>
+
+ <para>Most diagnostics issued by the server are logged
+ in a specified log file. The log file name is specified
+ at compile time, but may be overridden on the command line.</para>
+
+ <para>The number and nature of diagnostics available depends
+ on the debug level used by the server. If you have problems, set
+ the debug level to 3 and peruse the log files.</para>
+
+ <para>Most messages are reasonably self-explanatory. Unfortunately,
+ at the time this man page was created, there are too many diagnostics
+ available in the source code to warrant describing each and every
+ diagnostic. At this stage your best bet is still to grep the
+ source code and inspect the conditions that gave rise to the
+ diagnostics you are seeing.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>TDB FILES</title>
+
+ <para>Samba stores it's data in several TDB (Trivial Database) files, usually located in <filename>/var/lib/samba</filename>.</para>
+
+ <para>
+ (*) information persistent across restarts (but not
+ necessarily important to backup).
+ </para>
+
+<variablelist>
+<varlistentry><term>account_policy.tdb*</term>
+<listitem>
+<para>NT account policy settings such as pw expiration, etc...</para>
+</listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>brlock.tdb</term>
+<listitem><para>byte range locks</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>browse.dat</term>
+<listitem><para>browse lists</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>connections.tdb</term>
+<listitem><para>share connections (used to enforce max connections, etc...)</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>gencache.tdb</term>
+<listitem><para>generic caching db</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>group_mapping.tdb*</term>
+<listitem><para>group mapping information</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>locking.tdb</term>
+<listitem><para>share modes &amp; oplocks</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>login_cache.tdb*</term>
+<listitem><para>bad pw attempts</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>messages.tdb</term>
+<listitem><para>Samba messaging system</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>netsamlogon_cache.tdb*</term>
+<listitem><para>cache of user net_info_3 struct from net_samlogon() request (as a domain member)</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>ntdrivers.tdb*</term>
+<listitem><para>installed printer drivers</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>ntforms.tdb*</term>
+<listitem><para>installed printer forms</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>ntprinters.tdb*</term>
+<listitem><para>installed printer information</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>printing/</term>
+<listitem><para>directory containing tdb per print queue of cached lpq output</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>registry.tdb</term>
+<listitem><para>Windows registry skeleton (connect via regedit.exe)</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>sessionid.tdb</term>
+<listitem><para>session information (e.g. support for 'utmp = yes')</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>share_info.tdb*</term>
+<listitem><para>share acls</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>winbindd_cache.tdb</term>
+<listitem><para>winbindd's cache of user lists, etc...</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>winbindd_idmap.tdb*</term>
+<listitem><para>winbindd's local idmap db</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+<varlistentry><term>wins.dat*</term>
+<listitem><para>wins database when 'wins support = yes'</para></listitem>
+</varlistentry>
+
+</variablelist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SIGNALS</title>
+
+ <para>Sending the <command>smbd</command> a SIGHUP will cause it to
+ reload its <filename>smb.conf</filename> configuration
+ file within a short period of time.</para>
+
+ <para>To shut down a user's <command>smbd</command> process it is recommended
+ that <command>SIGKILL (-9)</command> <emphasis>NOT</emphasis>
+ be used, except as a last resort, as this may leave the shared
+ memory area in an inconsistent state. The safe way to terminate
+ an <command>smbd</command> is to send it a SIGTERM (-15) signal and wait for
+ it to die on its own.</para>
+
+ <para>The debug log level of <command>smbd</command> may be raised
+ or lowered using <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbcontrol</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> program (SIGUSR[1|2] signals are no longer
+ used since Samba 2.2). This is to allow transient problems to be diagnosed,
+ whilst still running at a normally low log level.</para>
+
+ <para>Note that as the signal handlers send a debug write,
+ they are not re-entrant in <command>smbd</command>. This you should wait until
+ <command>smbd</command> is in a state of waiting for an incoming SMB before
+ issuing them. It is possible to make the signal handlers safe
+ by un-blocking the signals before the select call and re-blocking
+ them after, however this would affect performance.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>hosts_access</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>inetd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>testparm</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>testprns</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, and the
+ Internet RFC's <filename>rfc1001.txt</filename>, <filename>rfc1002.txt</filename>.
+ In addition the CIFS (formerly SMB) specification is available
+ as a link from the Web page <ulink noescape="1" url="http://samba.org/cifs/">
+ http://samba.org/cifs/</ulink>.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for
+ Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smbget.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smbget.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..99ff5c69c0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smbget.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,217 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="smbget.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smbget</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smbget</refname>
+ <refpurpose>wget-like utility for download files over SMB</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbget</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-a, --guest</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-r, --resume</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-R, --recursive</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-u, --username=STRING</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-p, --password=STRING</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-w, --workgroup=STRING</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-n, --nonprompt</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d, --debuglevel=INT</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-D, --dots</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-P, --keep-permissions</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-o, --outputfile</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-f, --rcfile</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-q, --quiet</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-v, --verbose</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-b, --blocksize</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-O, --stdout</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-?, --help</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--usage</arg>
+ <arg choice="req">smb://host/share/path/to/file</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">smb://url2/</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">...</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>smbget is a simple utility with wget-like semantics, that can download files from SMB servers. You can specify the files you would like to download on the command-line.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The files should be in the smb-URL standard, e.g. use smb://host/share/file
+ for the UNC path <emphasis>\\\\HOST\\SHARE\\file</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-a, --guest</term>
+ <listitem><para>Work as user guest</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-r, --resume</term>
+ <listitem><para>Automatically resume aborted files</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-R, --recursive</term>
+ <listitem><para>Recursively download files</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-u, --username=STRING</term>
+ <listitem><para>Username to use</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-p, --password=STRING</term>
+ <listitem><para>Password to use</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-w, --workgroup=STRING</term>
+ <listitem><para>Workgroup to use (optional)</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-n, --nonprompt</term>
+ <listitem><para>Don't ask anything (non-interactive)</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-d, --debuglevel=INT</term>
+ <listitem><para>Debuglevel to use</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-D, --dots</term>
+ <listitem><para>Show dots as progress indication</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-P, --keep-permissions</term>
+ <listitem><para>Set same permissions on local file as are set on remote file.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-o, --outputfile</term>
+ <listitem><para>Write the file that is being downloaded to the specified file. Can not be used together with -R.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-O, --stdout</term>
+ <listitem><para>Write the file that is being downloaded to standard output.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-f, --rcfile</term>
+ <listitem><para>Use specified rcfile. This will be loaded in the order it was specified - e.g. if you specify any options before this one, they might get overridden by the contents of the rcfile.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-q, --quiet</term>
+ <listitem><para>Be quiet</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-v, --verbose</term>
+ <listitem><para>Be verbose</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-b, --blocksize</term>
+ <listitem><para>Number of bytes to download in a block. Defaults to 64000.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-?, --help</term>
+ <listitem><para>Show help message</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--usage</term>
+ <listitem><para>Display brief usage message</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SMB URLS</title>
+
+ <para> SMB URL's should be specified in the following format:</para>
+
+ <para><programlisting>
+smb://[[[domain;]user[:password@]]server[/share[/path[/file]]]]
+</programlisting></para>
+
+<para><programlisting>
+smb:// means all the workgroups
+</programlisting></para>
+
+<para><programlisting>
+smb://name/ means, if <replaceable>name</replaceable> is a workgroup, all the servers in this workgroup, or if <replaceable>name</replaceable> is a server, all the shares on this server.
+</programlisting></para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+<programlisting>
+# Recursively download 'src' directory
+smbget -R smb://rhonwyn/jelmer/src
+# Download FreeBSD ISO and enable resuming
+smbget -r smb://rhonwyn/isos/FreeBSD5.1.iso
+# Recursively download all ISOs
+smbget -Rr smb://rhonwyn/isos
+# Backup my data on rhonwyn
+smbget -Rr smb://rhonwyn/
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>BUGS</title>
+
+ <para>Permission denied is returned in some cases where the cause of the error is unknown
+(such as an illegally formatted smb:// url or trying to get a directory without -R
+turned on).</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The smbget manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smbgetrc.5.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smbgetrc.5.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..d4749f2bac
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smbgetrc.5.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,116 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="smbgetrc.5">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smbgetrc</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">File Formats and Conventions</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smbgetrc</refname>
+ <refpurpose>configuration file for smbget</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <para><filename>smbgetrc</filename></para>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>
+ This manual page documents the format and options of the <emphasis>smbgetrc</emphasis>
+ file. This is the configuration file used by the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbget</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ utility. The file contains of key-value pairs, one pair on each line. The key
+ and value should be separated by a space.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>By default, smbget reads its configuration from <emphasis>$HOME/.smbgetrc</emphasis>, though
+ other locations can be specified using the command-line options.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The following keys can be set:
+</para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry><term>resume on|off</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Whether aborted downloads should be automatically resumed.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>recursive on|off</term>
+ <listitem><para>Whether directories should be downloaded recursively</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>username <replaceable>name</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Username to use when logging in to the remote server. Use an empty string for anonymous access.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>password <replaceable>pass</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Password to use when logging in.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>workgroup <replaceable>wg</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Workgroup to use when logging in</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>nonprompt on|off</term>
+ <listitem><para>Turns off asking for username and password. Useful for scripts.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>debuglevel <replaceable>int</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>(Samba) debuglevel to run at. Useful for tracking down protocol level problems.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>dots on|off</term>
+ <listitem><para>Whether a single dot should be printed for each block that has been downloaded, instead of the default progress indicator.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry><term>blocksize <replaceable>int</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Number of bytes to put in a block. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbget</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>This manual page was written by Jelmer Vernooij</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
+
+
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smbpasswd.5.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smbpasswd.5.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..34676f64ee
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smbpasswd.5.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,211 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="smbpasswd.5">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">File Formats and Conventions</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smbpasswd</refname>
+ <refpurpose>The Samba encrypted password file</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <para><filename>smbpasswd</filename></para>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>smbpasswd is the Samba encrypted password file. It contains
+ the username, Unix user id and the SMB hashed passwords of the
+ user, as well as account flag information and the time the
+ password was last changed. This file format has been evolving with
+ Samba and has had several different formats in the past. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>FILE FORMAT</title>
+
+ <para>The format of the smbpasswd file used by Samba 2.2
+ is very similar to the familiar Unix <filename>passwd(5)</filename>
+ file. It is an ASCII file containing one line for each user. Each field
+ ithin each line is separated from the next by a colon. Any entry
+ beginning with '#' is ignored. The smbpasswd file contains the
+ following information for each user: </para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>name</term>
+ <listitem><para> This is the user name. It must be a name that
+ already exists in the standard UNIX passwd file. </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>uid</term>
+ <listitem><para>This is the UNIX uid. It must match the uid
+ field for the same user entry in the standard UNIX passwd file.
+ If this does not match then Samba will refuse to recognize
+ this smbpasswd file entry as being valid for a user.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>Lanman Password Hash</term>
+ <listitem><para>This is the LANMAN hash of the user's password,
+ encoded as 32 hex digits. The LANMAN hash is created by DES
+ encrypting a well known string with the user's password as the
+ DES key. This is the same password used by Windows 95/98 machines.
+ Note that this password hash is regarded as weak as it is
+ vulnerable to dictionary attacks and if two users choose the
+ same password this entry will be identical (i.e. the password
+ is not "salted" as the UNIX password is). If the user has a
+ null password this field will contain the characters "NO PASSWORD"
+ as the start of the hex string. If the hex string is equal to
+ 32 'X' characters then the user's account is marked as
+ <constant>disabled</constant> and the user will not be able to
+ log onto the Samba server. </para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>WARNING !!</emphasis> Note that, due to
+ the challenge-response nature of the SMB/CIFS authentication
+ protocol, anyone with a knowledge of this password hash will
+ be able to impersonate the user on the network. For this
+ reason these hashes are known as <emphasis>plain text
+ equivalents</emphasis> and must <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> be made
+ available to anyone but the root user. To protect these passwords
+ the smbpasswd file is placed in a directory with read and
+ traverse access only to the root user and the smbpasswd file
+ itself must be set to be read/write only by root, with no
+ other access. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>NT Password Hash</term>
+ <listitem><para>This is the Windows NT hash of the user's
+ password, encoded as 32 hex digits. The Windows NT hash is
+ created by taking the user's password as represented in
+ 16-bit, little-endian UNICODE and then applying the MD4
+ (internet rfc1321) hashing algorithm to it. </para>
+
+ <para>This password hash is considered more secure than
+ the LANMAN Password Hash as it preserves the case of the
+ password and uses a much higher quality hashing algorithm.
+ However, it is still the case that if two users choose the same
+ password this entry will be identical (i.e. the password is
+ not "salted" as the UNIX password is). </para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>WARNING !!</emphasis>. Note that, due to
+ the challenge-response nature of the SMB/CIFS authentication
+ protocol, anyone with a knowledge of this password hash will
+ be able to impersonate the user on the network. For this
+ reason these hashes are known as <emphasis>plain text
+ equivalents</emphasis> and must <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> be made
+ available to anyone but the root user. To protect these passwords
+ the smbpasswd file is placed in a directory with read and
+ traverse access only to the root user and the smbpasswd file
+ itself must be set to be read/write only by root, with no
+ other access. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>Account Flags</term>
+ <listitem><para>This section contains flags that describe
+ the attributes of the users account. This field is bracketed by
+ '[' and ']' characters and is always 13 characters in length
+ (including the '[' and ']' characters).
+ The contents of this field may be any of the following characters:
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>U</emphasis> - This means
+ this is a "User" account, i.e. an ordinary user.</para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>N</emphasis> - This means the
+ account has no password (the passwords in the fields LANMAN
+ Password Hash and NT Password Hash are ignored). Note that this
+ will only allow users to log on with no password if the <parameter>
+ null passwords</parameter> parameter is set in the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> config file. </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>D</emphasis> - This means the account
+ is disabled and no SMB/CIFS logins will be allowed for this user. </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>X</emphasis> - This means the password
+ does not expire. </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><emphasis>W</emphasis> - This means this account
+ is a "Workstation Trust" account. This kind of account is used
+ in the Samba PDC code stream to allow Windows NT Workstations
+ and Servers to join a Domain hosted by a Samba PDC. </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>Other flags may be added as the code is extended in future.
+ The rest of this field space is filled in with spaces. For further
+ information regarding the flags that are supported please refer to the
+ man page for the <command>pdbedit</command> command.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>Last Change Time</term>
+ <listitem><para>This field consists of the time the account was
+ last modified. It consists of the characters 'LCT-' (standing for
+ "Last Change Time") followed by a numeric encoding of the UNIX time
+ in seconds since the epoch (1970) that the last change was made.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ <para>All other colon separated fields are ignored at this time.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>, and
+ the Internet RFC1321 for details on the MD4 algorithm.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink noescape="1" url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
+ for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smbpasswd.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smbpasswd.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..7477f07f71
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smbpasswd.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,431 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="smbpasswd.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smbpasswd</refname>
+ <refpurpose>change a user's SMB password</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbpasswd</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-a</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-c &lt;config file&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-x</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-e</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-D debuglevel</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-n</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-r &lt;remote machine&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-R &lt;name resolve order&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-m</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-U username[%password]</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-w pass</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-W</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-i</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-L</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">username</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The smbpasswd program has several different
+ functions, depending on whether it is run by the <emphasis>root</emphasis> user
+ or not. When run as a normal user it allows the user to change
+ the password used for their SMB sessions on any machines that store
+ SMB passwords. </para>
+
+ <para>By default (when run with no arguments) it will attempt to
+ change the current user's SMB password on the local machine. This is
+ similar to the way the <command>passwd(1)</command> program works. <command>
+ smbpasswd</command> differs from how the passwd program works
+ however in that it is not <emphasis>setuid root</emphasis> but works in
+ a client-server mode and communicates with a
+ locally running <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>. As a consequence in order for this to
+ succeed the smbd daemon must be running on the local machine. On a
+ UNIX machine the encrypted SMB passwords are usually stored in
+ the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file. </para>
+
+ <para>When run by an ordinary user with no options, smbpasswd
+ will prompt them for their old SMB password and then ask them
+ for their new password twice, to ensure that the new password
+ was typed correctly. No passwords will be echoed on the screen
+ whilst being typed. If you have a blank SMB password (specified by
+ the string "NO PASSWORD" in the smbpasswd file) then just press
+ the &lt;Enter&gt; key when asked for your old password. </para>
+
+ <para>smbpasswd can also be used by a normal user to change their
+ SMB password on remote machines, such as Windows NT Primary Domain
+ Controllers. See the (<parameter>-r</parameter>) and <parameter>-U</parameter> options
+ below. </para>
+
+ <para>When run by root, smbpasswd allows new users to be added
+ and deleted in the smbpasswd file, as well as allows changes to
+ the attributes of the user in this file to be made. When run by root, <command>
+ smbpasswd</command> accesses the local smbpasswd file
+ directly, thus enabling changes to be made even if smbd is not
+ running. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-a</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ This option specifies that the username following should be added to the local smbpasswd file, with the new
+ password typed (type &lt;Enter&gt; for the old password). This option is ignored if the username following
+ already exists in the smbpasswd file and it is treated like a regular change password command. Note that the
+ default passdb backends require the user to already exist in the system password file (usually
+ <filename>/etc/passwd</filename>), else the request to add the user will fail.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This option is only available when running smbpasswd
+ as root. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-c</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ This option can be used to specify the path and file name of the &smb.conf; configuration file when it
+ is important to use other than the default file and / or location.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-x</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ This option specifies that the username following should be deleted from the local smbpasswd file.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ This option is only available when running smbpasswd as root.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-d</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option specifies that the username following
+ should be <constant>disabled</constant> in the local smbpasswd
+ file. This is done by writing a <constant>'D'</constant> flag
+ into the account control space in the smbpasswd file. Once this
+ is done all attempts to authenticate via SMB using this username
+ will fail. </para>
+
+ <para>If the smbpasswd file is in the 'old' format (pre-Samba 2.0
+ format) there is no space in the user's password entry to write
+ this information and the command will FAIL. See <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for details on the 'old' and new password file formats.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as
+ root.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-e</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option specifies that the username following
+ should be <constant>enabled</constant> in the local smbpasswd file,
+ if the account was previously disabled. If the account was not
+ disabled this option has no effect. Once the account is enabled then
+ the user will be able to authenticate via SMB once again. </para>
+
+ <para>If the smbpasswd file is in the 'old' format, then <command>
+ smbpasswd</command> will FAIL to enable the account.
+ See <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for
+ details on the 'old' and new password file formats. </para>
+
+ <para>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as root.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-D debuglevel</term>
+ <listitem><para><replaceable>debuglevel</replaceable> is an integer
+ from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is not specified
+ is zero. </para>
+
+ <para>The higher this value, the more detail will be logged to the
+ log files about the activities of smbpasswd. At level 0, only
+ critical errors and serious warnings will be logged. </para>
+
+ <para>Levels above 1 will generate considerable amounts of log
+ data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels
+ above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate
+ HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-n</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option specifies that the username following
+ should have their password set to null (i.e. a blank password) in
+ the local smbpasswd file. This is done by writing the string "NO
+ PASSWORD" as the first part of the first password stored in the
+ smbpasswd file. </para>
+
+ <para>Note that to allow users to logon to a Samba server once
+ the password has been set to "NO PASSWORD" in the smbpasswd
+ file the administrator must set the following parameter in the [global]
+ section of the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file : </para>
+
+ <para><command>null passwords = yes</command></para>
+
+ <para>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as
+ root.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-r remote machine name</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option allows a user to specify what machine
+ they wish to change their password on. Without this parameter
+ smbpasswd defaults to the local host. The <replaceable>remote
+ machine name</replaceable> is the NetBIOS name of the SMB/CIFS
+ server to contact to attempt the password change. This name is
+ resolved into an IP address using the standard name resolution
+ mechanism in all programs of the Samba suite. See the <parameter>-R
+ name resolve order</parameter> parameter for details on changing
+ this resolving mechanism. </para>
+
+ <para>The username whose password is changed is that of the
+ current UNIX logged on user. See the <parameter>-U username</parameter>
+ parameter for details on changing the password for a different
+ username. </para>
+
+ <para>Note that if changing a Windows NT Domain password the
+ remote machine specified must be the Primary Domain Controller for
+ the domain (Backup Domain Controllers only have a read-only
+ copy of the user account database and will not allow the password
+ change).</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Note</emphasis> that Windows 95/98 do not have
+ a real password database so it is not possible to change passwords
+ specifying a Win95/98 machine as remote machine target. </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-R name resolve order</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option allows the user of smbpasswd to determine
+ what name resolution services to use when looking up the NetBIOS
+ name of the host being connected to. </para>
+
+ <para>The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They
+ cause names to be resolved as follows: </para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><constant>lmhosts</constant>: Lookup an IP
+ address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the line in lmhosts has
+ no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>lmhosts</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> for details) then
+ any name type matches for lookup.</para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><constant>host</constant>: Do a standard host
+ name to IP address resolution, using the system <filename>/etc/hosts
+ </filename>, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name resolution
+ is operating system depended for instance on IRIX or Solaris this
+ may be controlled by the <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename>
+ file). Note that this method is only used if the NetBIOS name
+ type being queried is the 0x20 (server) name type, otherwise
+ it is ignored.</para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><constant>wins</constant>: Query a name with
+ the IP address listed in the <parameter>wins server</parameter>
+ parameter. If no WINS server has been specified this method
+ will be ignored.</para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><constant>bcast</constant>: Do a broadcast on
+ each of the known local interfaces listed in the
+ <parameter>interfaces</parameter> parameter. This is the least
+ reliable of the name resolution methods as it depends on the
+ target host being on a locally connected subnet.</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>The default order is <command>lmhosts, host, wins, bcast</command>
+ and without this parameter or any entry in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file the name resolution methods will
+ be attempted in this order. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-m</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option tells smbpasswd that the account
+ being changed is a MACHINE account. Currently this is used
+ when Samba is being used as an NT Primary Domain Controller.</para>
+
+ <para>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as root.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-U username</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option may only be used in conjunction
+ with the <parameter>-r</parameter> option. When changing
+ a password on a remote machine it allows the user to specify
+ the user name on that machine whose password will be changed. It
+ is present to allow users who have different user names on
+ different systems to change these passwords. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-h</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option prints the help string for <command>
+ smbpasswd</command>, selecting the correct one for running as root
+ or as an ordinary user. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-s</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option causes smbpasswd to be silent (i.e.
+ not issue prompts) and to read its old and new passwords from
+ standard input, rather than from <filename>/dev/tty</filename>
+ (like the <command>passwd(1)</command> program does). This option
+ is to aid people writing scripts to drive smbpasswd</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-w password</term>
+ <listitem><para>This parameter is only available if Samba
+ has been compiled with LDAP support. The <parameter>-w</parameter>
+ switch is used to specify the password to be used with the
+ <smbconfoption name="ldap admin dn"/>. Note that the password is stored in
+ the <filename>secrets.tdb</filename> and is keyed off
+ of the admin's DN. This means that if the value of <parameter>ldap
+ admin dn</parameter> ever changes, the password will need to be
+ manually updated as well.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-W</term>
+ <listitem><para><command>NOTE: </command> This option is same as "-w"
+ except that the password should be entered using stdin.
+ </para>
+ <para>This parameter is only available if Samba
+ has been compiled with LDAP support. The <parameter>-W</parameter>
+ switch is used to specify the password to be used with the
+ <smbconfoption name="ldap admin dn"/>. Note that the password is stored in
+ the <filename>secrets.tdb</filename> and is keyed off
+ of the admin's DN. This means that if the value of <parameter>ldap
+ admin dn</parameter> ever changes, the password will need to be
+ manually updated as well.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-i</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option tells smbpasswd that the account
+ being changed is an interdomain trust account. Currently this is used
+ when Samba is being used as an NT Primary Domain Controller.
+ The account contains the info about another trusted domain.</para>
+
+ <para>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as root.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-L</term>
+ <listitem><para>Run in local mode.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>username</term>
+ <listitem><para>This specifies the username for all of the
+ <emphasis>root only</emphasis> options to operate on. Only root
+ can specify this parameter as only root has the permission needed
+ to modify attributes directly in the local smbpasswd file.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>NOTES</title>
+
+ <para>Since <command>smbpasswd</command> works in client-server
+ mode communicating with a local smbd for a non-root user then
+ the smbd daemon must be running for this to work. A common problem
+ is to add a restriction to the hosts that may access the <command>
+ smbd</command> running on the local machine by specifying either <parameter>allow
+ hosts</parameter> or <parameter>deny hosts</parameter> entry in
+ the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file and neglecting to
+ allow "localhost" access to the smbd. </para>
+
+ <para>In addition, the smbpasswd command is only useful if Samba
+ has been set up to use encrypted passwords. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbpasswd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>Samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
+ for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smbspool.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smbspool.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..ee5cc0d173
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smbspool.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,133 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="smbspool.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smbspool</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smbspool</refname>
+ <refpurpose>send a print file to an SMB printer</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbspool</command>
+ <arg choice="req">job</arg>
+ <arg choice="req">user</arg>
+ <arg choice="req">title</arg>
+ <arg choice="req">copies</arg>
+ <arg choice="req">options</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">filename</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>smbspool is a very small print spooling program that
+ sends a print file to an SMB printer. The command-line arguments
+ are position-dependent for compatibility with the Common UNIX
+ Printing System, but you can use smbspool with any printing system
+ or from a program or script.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>DEVICE URI</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>smbspool specifies the destination using a Uniform Resource
+ Identifier ("URI") with a method of "smb". This string can take
+ a number of forms:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>smb://server[:port]/printer</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>smb://workgroup/server[:port]/printer</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>smb://username:password@server[:port]/printer</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>smb://username:password@workgroup/server[:port]/printer</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>smbspool tries to get the URI from the environment variable
+ <envar>DEVICE_URI</envar>. If <envar>DEVICE_URI</envar> is not present,
+ smbspool will use argv[0] if that starts with <quote>smb://</quote>
+ or argv[1] if that is not the case.</para>
+
+ <para>Programs using the <command>exec(2)</command> functions can
+ pass the URI in argv[0], while shell scripts must set the
+ <envar>DEVICE_URI</envar> environment variable prior to
+ running smbspool.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>The job argument (argv[1]) contains the
+ job ID number and is presently not used by smbspool.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>The user argument (argv[2]) contains the
+ print user's name and is presently not used by smbspool.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>The title argument (argv[3]) contains the
+ job title string and is passed as the remote file name
+ when sending the print job.</para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>The copies argument (argv[4]) contains
+ the number of copies to be printed of the named file. If
+ no filename is provided then this argument is not used by
+ smbspool.</para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>The options argument (argv[5]) contains
+ the print options in a single string and is currently
+ not used by smbspool.</para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>The filename argument (argv[6]) contains the
+ name of the file to print. If this argument is not specified
+ then the print file is read from the standard input.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para><command>smbspool</command> was written by Michael Sweet
+ at Easy Software Products.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
+ for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smbstatus.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smbstatus.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..e3bc251924
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smbstatus.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,158 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="smbstatus.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smbstatus</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smbstatus</refname>
+ <refpurpose>report on current Samba connections</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbstatus</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-P</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-b</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d &lt;debug level&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-v</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-L</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-B</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-p</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-S</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-N</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-f</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s &lt;configuration file&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-u &lt;username&gt;</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>smbstatus</command> is a very simple program to
+ list the current Samba connections.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-P|--profile</term>
+ <listitem><para>If samba has been compiled with the
+ profiling option, print only the contents of the profiling
+ shared memory area.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-b|--brief</term>
+ <listitem><para>gives brief output.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-v|--verbose</term>
+ <listitem><para>gives verbose output.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-L|--locks</term>
+ <listitem><para>causes smbstatus to only list locks.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-B|--byterange</term>
+ <listitem><para>causes smbstatus to include byte range locks.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-p|--processes</term>
+ <listitem><para>print a list of <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> processes and exit.
+ Useful for scripting.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-S|--shares</term>
+ <listitem><para>causes smbstatus to only list shares.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-N|--notify</term>
+ <listitem><para>causes smbstatus to display registered file
+ notifications</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-f|--fast</term>
+ <listitem><para>causes smbstatus to not check if the status data
+ is valid by checking if the processes that the status data refer to all still
+ exist. This speeds up execution on busy systems and clusters but
+ might display stale data of processes that died without cleaning up properly.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.help;
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-u|--user=&lt;username&gt;</term>
+ <listitem><para>selects information relevant to <parameter>username</parameter> only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
+ for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smbta-util.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smbta-util.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..6e53aaab0a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smbta-util.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,119 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.2//EN" "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd">
+<refentry id="smbta-util.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smbta-util</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smbta-util</refname>
+ <refpurpose>control encryption in VFS smb_traffic_analyzer</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbta-util</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbta-util</command>
+ <arg rep="repeat" choice="opt">
+ <replaceable>COMMANDS</replaceable>
+ </arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>smbta-util</command> is a tool to ease the
+ configuration of the vfs_smb_traffic_analyzer module regarding
+ data encryption.</para>
+ <para>The user can generate a key, install a key (activating
+ encryption), or uninstall a key (deactivating encryption).
+ Any operation that installs a key will create a File containing
+ the key. This file can be used by smbta-tool on other machines
+ to install the same key from the file.</para>
+
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>COMMANDS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>-h</option></term>
+ <listitem><para>Show a short help text on the command line.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>-f</option>
+ <replaceable>KEYFILE</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Open an existing keyfile, read the key from
+ the file, and install the key, activating encryption.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>-g</option>
+ <replaceable>KEYFILE</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Generate a new random key, install the key,
+ activate encryption, and store the key into the file KEYFILE.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>-u</option></term>
+ <listitem><para>Uninstall the key, deactivating encryption.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>-s</option></term>
+ <listitem><para>Check if a key is installed.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>-c</option>
+ <replaceable>KEYFILE</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Create a KEYFILE from an installed key.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.4 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+ <para> The original version of smbta-util was created by Holger Hetterich.
+ </para>
+ <para> The original Samba software and related utilities were
+ created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed by the
+ Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
+ Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smbtar.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smbtar.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..7ce564c8dc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smbtar.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,237 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="smbtar.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smbtar</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smbtar</refname>
+ <refpurpose>shell script for backing up SMB/CIFS shares
+ directly to UNIX tape drives</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbtar</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-r</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-i</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-a</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-v</arg>
+ <arg choice="req">-s server</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-p password</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-x services</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-X</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-N filename</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-b blocksize</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d directory</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-l loglevel</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-u user</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-t tape</arg>
+ <arg choice="req">filenames</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>smbtar</command> is a very small shell script on top
+ of <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry> which dumps SMB shares directly to tape.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-s server</term>
+ <listitem><para>The SMB/CIFS server that the share resides
+ upon.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-x service</term>
+ <listitem><para>The share name on the server to connect to.
+ The default is "backup".</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-X</term>
+ <listitem><para>Exclude mode. Exclude filenames... from tar
+ create or restore. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-d directory</term>
+ <listitem><para>Change to initial <parameter>directory
+ </parameter> before restoring / backing up files. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-v</term>
+ <listitem><para>Verbose mode.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-p password</term>
+ <listitem><para>The password to use to access a share.
+ Default: none </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-u user</term>
+ <listitem><para>The user id to connect as. Default:
+ UNIX login name. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-a</term>
+ <listitem><para>Reset DOS archive bit mode to
+ indicate file has been archived. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-t tape</term>
+ <listitem><para>Tape device. May be regular file or tape
+ device. Default: <parameter>$TAPE</parameter> environmental
+ variable; if not set, a file called <filename>tar.out
+ </filename>. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-b blocksize</term>
+ <listitem><para>Blocking factor. Defaults to 20. See
+ <command>tar(1)</command> for a fuller explanation. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-N filename</term>
+ <listitem><para>Backup only files newer than filename. Could
+ be used (for example) on a log file to implement incremental
+ backups. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-i</term>
+ <listitem><para>Incremental mode; tar files are only backed
+ up if they have the archive bit set. The archive bit is reset
+ after each file is read. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-r</term>
+ <listitem><para>Restore. Files are restored to the share
+ from the tar file. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-l log level</term>
+ <listitem><para>Log (debug) level. Corresponds to the
+ <parameter>-d</parameter> flag of <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry>.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</title>
+
+ <para>The <parameter>$TAPE</parameter> variable specifies the
+ default tape device to write to. May be overridden
+ with the -t option. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>BUGS</title>
+
+ <para>The <command>smbtar</command> script has different
+ options from ordinary tar and from smbclient's tar command. </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CAVEATS</title>
+
+ <para>Sites that are more careful about security may not like
+ the way the script handles PC passwords. Backup and restore work
+ on entire shares; should work on file lists. smbtar works best
+ with GNU tar and may not work well with other versions. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DIAGNOSTICS</title>
+
+ <para>See the <emphasis>DIAGNOSTICS</emphasis> section for the <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry> command.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smbclient</refentrytitle><manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+<para><ulink noescape="1" url="mailto:poultenr@logica.co.uk">Ricky Poulten</ulink>
+ wrote the tar extension and this man page. The <command>smbtar</command>
+ script was heavily rewritten and improved by <ulink noescape="1"
+ url="mailto:Martin.Kraemer@mch.sni.de">Martin Kraemer</ulink>. Many
+ thanks to everyone who suggested extensions, improvements, bug
+ fixes, etc. The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink noescape="1" url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for
+ Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/smbtree.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/smbtree.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..d69aef13ba
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/smbtree.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,96 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="smbtree.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smbtree</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>smbtree</refname>
+ <refpurpose>A text based smb network browser
+ </refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>smbtree</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-b</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-D</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-S</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>smbtree</command> is a smb browser program
+ in text mode. It is similar to the "Network Neighborhood" found
+ on Windows computers. It prints a tree with all
+ the known domains, the servers in those domains and
+ the shares on the servers.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-b|--broadcast</term>
+ <listitem><para>Query network nodes by sending requests
+ as broadcasts instead of querying the local master browser.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-D|--domains</term>
+ <listitem><para>Only print a list of all
+ the domains known on broadcast or by the
+ master browser</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-S|--servers</term>
+ <listitem><para>Only print a list of
+ all the domains and servers responding on broadcast or
+ known by the master browser.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+ &popt.common.credentials;
+ &stdarg.help;
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba
+ suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The smbtree man page was written by Jelmer Vernooij. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/swat.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/swat.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..ec102130b4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/swat.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,237 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="swat.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>swat</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>swat</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Samba Web Administration Tool</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>swat</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s &lt;smb config file&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-a</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-P</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+
+ <para><command>swat</command> allows a Samba administrator to
+ configure the complex <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file via a Web browser. In addition,
+ a <command>swat</command> configuration page has help links
+ to all the configurable options in the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file allowing an
+ administrator to easily look up the effects of any change. </para>
+
+ <para><command>swat</command> is run from <command>inetd</command> </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-s smb configuration file</term>
+ <listitem><para>The default configuration file path is
+ determined at compile time. The file specified contains
+ the configuration details required by the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> server. This is the file
+ that <command>swat</command> will modify.
+ The information in this file includes server-specific
+ information such as what printcap file to use, as well as
+ descriptions of all the services that the server is to provide.
+ See <filename>smb.conf</filename> for more information.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-a</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option disables authentication and
+ places <command>swat</command> in demo mode. In that mode anyone will be able to modify
+ the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file. </para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>WARNING: Do NOT enable this option on a production
+ server. </emphasis></para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-P</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option restricts read-only users to the password
+ management page. <command>swat</command> can then be used to change
+ user passwords without users seeing the "View" and "Status" menu
+ buttons.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+ &stdarg.help;
+
+ </variablelist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+
+ <title>INSTALLATION</title>
+
+ <para>Swat is included as binary package with most distributions. The
+ package manager in this case takes care of the installation and
+ configuration. This section is only for those who have compiled
+ swat from scratch.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>After you compile SWAT you need to run <command>make install
+ </command> to install the <command>swat</command> binary
+ and the various help files and images. A default install would put
+ these in: </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>/usr/local/samba/sbin/swat</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>/usr/local/samba/swat/images/*</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>/usr/local/samba/swat/help/*</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <refsect2>
+ <title>Inetd Installation</title>
+
+ <para>You need to edit your <filename>/etc/inetd.conf
+ </filename> and <filename>/etc/services</filename>
+ to enable SWAT to be launched via <command>inetd</command>.</para>
+
+ <para>In <filename>/etc/services</filename> you need to
+ add a line like this: </para>
+
+ <para><command>swat 901/tcp</command></para>
+
+ <para>Note for NIS/YP and LDAP users - you may need to rebuild the
+ NIS service maps rather than alter your local <filename>
+ /etc/services</filename> file. </para>
+
+ <para>the choice of port number isn't really important
+ except that it should be less than 1024 and not currently
+ used (using a number above 1024 presents an obscure security
+ hole depending on the implementation details of your
+ <command>inetd</command> daemon). </para>
+
+ <para>In <filename>/etc/inetd.conf</filename> you should
+ add a line like this: </para>
+
+ <para><command>swat stream tcp nowait.400 root
+ /usr/local/samba/sbin/swat swat</command></para>
+
+ <para>Once you have edited <filename>/etc/services</filename>
+ and <filename>/etc/inetd.conf</filename> you need to send a
+ HUP signal to inetd. To do this use <command>kill -1 PID
+ </command> where PID is the process ID of the inetd daemon. </para>
+
+ </refsect2>
+
+
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>LAUNCHING</title>
+
+ <para>To launch SWAT just run your favorite web browser and
+ point it at "http://localhost:901/".</para>
+
+ <para>Note that you can attach to SWAT from any IP connected
+ machine but connecting from a remote machine leaves your
+ connection open to password sniffing as passwords will be sent
+ in the clear over the wire. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>FILES</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><filename>/etc/inetd.conf</filename></term>
+ <listitem><para>This file must contain suitable startup
+ information for the meta-daemon.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><filename>/etc/services</filename></term>
+ <listitem><para>This file must contain a mapping of service name
+ (e.g., swat) to service port (e.g., 901) and protocol type
+ (e.g., tcp). </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><filename>/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</filename></term>
+ <listitem><para>This is the default location of the <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry> server configuration file that swat edits. Other
+ common places that systems install this file are <filename>
+ /usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</filename> and <filename>/etc/smb.conf
+ </filename>. This file describes all the services the server
+ is to make available to clients. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>WARNINGS</title>
+
+ <para><command>swat</command> will rewrite your <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry> file. It will rearrange the entries and delete all
+ comments, <parameter>include=</parameter> and <parameter>copy=
+ </parameter> options. If you have a carefully crafted <filename>
+ smb.conf</filename> then back it up or don't use swat! </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><command>inetd(5)</command>, <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry>, <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for
+ Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/tdbbackup.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/tdbbackup.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..93f773feb8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/tdbbackup.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,136 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.2//EN" "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd">
+<refentry id="tdbbackup.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>tdbbackup</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>tdbbackup</refname>
+ <refpurpose>tool for backing up and for validating the integrity of samba .tdb files</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>tdbbackup</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s suffix</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-v</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>tdbbackup</command> is a tool that may be used to backup samba .tdb
+ files. This tool may also be used to verify the integrity of the .tdb files prior
+ to samba startup or during normal operation. If it finds file damage and it finds
+ a prior backup the backup file will be restored.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-h</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Get help information.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-s suffix</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ The <command>-s</command> option allows the administrator to specify a file
+ backup extension. This way it is possible to keep a history of tdb backup
+ files by using a new suffix for each backup.
+ </para> </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-v</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ The <command>-v</command> will check the database for damages (corrupt data)
+ which if detected causes the backup to be restored.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>COMMANDS</title>
+
+ <para><emphasis>GENERAL INFORMATION</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>
+ The <command>tdbbackup</command> utility can safely be run at any time. It was designed so
+ that it can be used at any time to validate the integrity of tdb files, even during Samba
+ operation. Typical usage for the command will be:
+ </para>
+
+ <para>tdbbackup [-s suffix] *.tdb</para>
+
+ <para>
+ Before restarting samba the following command may be run to validate .tdb files:
+ </para>
+
+ <para>tdbbackup -v [-s suffix] *.tdb</para>
+
+ <para>
+ Samba .tdb files are stored in various locations, be sure to run backup all
+ .tdb file on the system. Important files includes:
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>secrets.tdb</command> - usual location is in the /usr/local/samba/private
+ directory, or on some systems in /etc/samba.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>passdb.tdb</command> - usual location is in the /usr/local/samba/private
+ directory, or on some systems in /etc/samba.
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>*.tdb</command> located in the /usr/local/samba/var directory or on some
+ systems in the /var/cache or /var/lib/samba directories.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities were created by Andrew Tridgell.
+ Samba is now developed by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way
+ the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>The tdbbackup man page was written by John H Terpstra.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/tdbdump.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/tdbdump.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..90465e53e8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/tdbdump.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,61 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.2//EN" "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd">
+<refentry id="tdbdump.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>tdbdump</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>tdbdump</refname>
+ <refpurpose>tool for printing the contents of a TDB file</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>tdbdump</command>
+ <arg choice="req">filename</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>tdbdump</command> is a very simple utility that 'dumps' the
+ contents of a TDB (Trivial DataBase) file to standard output in a
+ human-readable format.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This tool can be used when debugging problems with TDB files. It is
+ intended for those who are somewhat familiar with Samba internals.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities were created by Andrew Tridgell.
+ Samba is now developed by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way
+ the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>The tdbdump man page was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/tdbtool.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/tdbtool.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..51fc540fc9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/tdbtool.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,243 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.2//EN" "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.2/docbookx.dtd">
+<refentry id="tdbtool.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>tdbtool</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>tdbtool</refname>
+ <refpurpose>manipulate the contents TDB files</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>tdbtool</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>tdbtool</command>
+ <arg choice="plain">
+ <replaceable>TDBFILE</replaceable>
+ </arg>
+ <arg rep="repeat" choice="opt">
+ <replaceable>COMMANDS</replaceable>
+ </arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>tdbtool</command> a tool for displaying and
+ altering the contents of Samba TDB (Trivial DataBase) files. Each
+ of the commands listed below can be entered interactively or
+ provided on the command line.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>COMMANDS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>create</option>
+ <replaceable>TDBFILE</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Create a new database named
+ <replaceable>TDBFILE</replaceable>.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>open</option>
+ <replaceable>TDBFILE</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Open an existing database named
+ <replaceable>TDBFILE</replaceable>.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>erase</option></term>
+ <listitem><para>Erase the current database.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>dump</option></term>
+ <listitem><para>Dump the current database as strings.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>cdump</option></term>
+ <listitem><para>Dump the current database as connection records.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>keys</option></term>
+ <listitem><para>Dump the current database keys as strings.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>hexkeys</option></term>
+ <listitem><para>Dump the current database keys as hex values.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>info</option></term>
+ <listitem><para>Print summary information about the
+ current database.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>insert</option>
+ <replaceable>KEY</replaceable>
+ <replaceable>DATA</replaceable>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>Insert a record into the
+ current database.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>move</option>
+ <replaceable>KEY</replaceable>
+ <replaceable>TDBFILE</replaceable>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>Move a record from the
+ current database into <replaceable>TDBFILE</replaceable>.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>store</option>
+ <replaceable>KEY</replaceable>
+ <replaceable>DATA</replaceable>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>Store (replace) a record in the
+ current database.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>show</option>
+ <replaceable>KEY</replaceable>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>Show a record by key.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>delete</option>
+ <replaceable>KEY</replaceable>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>Delete a record by key.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>list</option>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>Print the current database hash table and free list.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>free</option>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>Print the current database and free list.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><option>!</option>
+ <replaceable>COMMAND</replaceable>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>Execute the given system command.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>
+ <option>first</option>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>Print the first record in the current database.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>
+ <option>next</option>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>Print the next record in the current database.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>
+ <option>check</option>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>Check the integrity of the current database.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>
+ <option>repack</option>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>Repack a database using a temporary file to remove fragmentation.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>
+ <option>quit</option>
+ </term>
+ <listitem><para>Exit <command>tdbtool</command>.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CAVEATS</title>
+ <para>The contents of the Samba TDB files are private
+ to the implementation and should not be altered with
+ <command>tdbtool</command>.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.6 of the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para> The original Samba software and related utilities were
+ created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed by the
+ Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the
+ Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/testparm.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/testparm.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..8d7cc22204
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/testparm.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,202 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="testparm.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>testparm</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>testparm</refname>
+ <refpurpose>check an smb.conf configuration file for
+ internal correctness</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>testparm</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-v</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-t &lt;encoding&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="req">config filename</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">hostname hostIP</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>testparm</command> is a very simple test program
+ to check an <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> configuration file for
+ internal correctness. If this program reports no problems, you
+ can use the configuration file with confidence that <command>smbd
+ </command> will successfully load the configuration file.</para>
+
+
+ <para>Note that this is <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> a guarantee that
+ the services specified in the configuration file will be
+ available or will operate as expected. </para>
+
+ <para>If the optional host name and host IP address are
+ specified on the command line, this test program will run through
+ the service entries reporting whether the specified host
+ has access to each service. </para>
+
+ <para>If <command>testparm</command> finds an error in the <filename>
+ smb.conf</filename> file it returns an exit code of 1 to the calling
+ program, else it returns an exit code of 0. This allows shell scripts
+ to test the output from <command>testparm</command>.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-s</term>
+ <listitem><para>Without this option, <command>testparm</command>
+ will prompt for a carriage return after printing the service
+ names and before dumping the service definitions.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.help;
+ &stdarg.version;
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-v</term>
+ <listitem><para>If this option is specified, testparm
+ will also output all options that were not used in <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry> and are thus set to their defaults.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-t encoding</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Output data in specified encoding.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--parameter-name parametername</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Dumps the named parameter. If no section-name is set the view
+ is limited by default to the global section.
+
+ It is also possible to dump a parametrical option. Therefore
+ the option has to be separated by a colon from the
+ parametername.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--section-name sectionname</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Dumps the named section.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>configfilename</term>
+ <listitem><para>This is the name of the configuration file
+ to check. If this parameter is not present then the
+ default <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry> file will be checked.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>hostname</term>
+ <listitem><para>If this parameter and the following are
+ specified, then <command>testparm</command> will examine the <parameter>hosts
+ allow</parameter> and <parameter>hosts deny</parameter>
+ parameters in the <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry> file to
+ determine if the hostname with this IP address would be
+ allowed access to the <command>smbd</command> server. If
+ this parameter is supplied, the hostIP parameter must also
+ be supplied.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>hostIP</term>
+ <listitem><para>This is the IP address of the host specified
+ in the previous parameter. This address must be supplied
+ if the hostname parameter is supplied. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>FILES</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry></term>
+ <listitem><para>This is usually the name of the configuration
+ file used by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry>.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DIAGNOSTICS</title>
+
+ <para>The program will issue a message saying whether the
+ configuration file loaded OK or not. This message may be preceded by
+ errors and warnings if the file did not load. If the file was
+ loaded OK, the program then dumps all known service details
+ to stdout. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry>, <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry></para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
+ The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
+ excellent piece of Open Source software, available at <ulink noescape="1" url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
+ ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
+ release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
+ Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2
+ for Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_acl_tdb.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_acl_tdb.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..7c22dec5de
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_acl_tdb.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,79 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_acl_tdb.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_acl_tdb</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_acl_tdb</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Save NTFS-ACLs in a tdb file</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = acl_tdb</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_acl_tdb</command> VFS module stores
+ NTFS Access Control Lists (ACLs) in a tdb file.
+ This enables the full mapping of Windows ACLs on Samba
+ servers.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The ACL settings are stored in
+ <filename>$LOCKDIR/file_ntacls.tdb</filename>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <!-- please keep in sync with the other acl vfs modules that provide the same options -->
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>acl_tdb:ignore system acls = [yes|no]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ When set to <emphasis>yes</emphasis>, a best effort mapping
+ from/to the POSIX ACL layer will <emphasis>not</emphasis> be
+ done by this module. The default is <emphasis>no</emphasis>,
+ which means that Samba keeps setting and evaluating both the
+ system ACLs and the NT ACLs. This is better if you need your
+ system ACLs be set for local or NFS file access, too. If you only
+ access the data via Samba you might set this to yes to achieve
+ better NT ACL compatibility.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_acl_xattr.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_acl_xattr.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..41a8a9750a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_acl_xattr.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,83 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_acl_xattr.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_acl_xattr</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_acl_xattr</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Save NTFS-ACLs in Extended Attributes (EAs)</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = acl_xattr</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_acl_xattr</command> VFS module stores
+ NTFS Access Control Lists (ACLs) in Extended Attributes (EAs).
+ This enables the full mapping of Windows ACLs on Samba
+ servers.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>The ACLs are stored in the Extended Attribute
+ <parameter>security.NTACL</parameter> of a file or directory.
+ This Attribute is <emphasis>not</emphasis> listed by
+ <command>getfattr -d <filename>filename</filename></command>.
+ To show the current value, the name of the EA must be specified
+ (e.g. <command>getfattr -n security.NTACL <filename>filename</filename>
+ </command>).
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <!-- please keep in sync with the other acl vfs modules that provide the same options -->
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>acl_xattr:ignore system acls = [yes|no]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ When set to <emphasis>yes</emphasis>, a best effort mapping
+ from/to the POSIX ACL layer will <emphasis>not</emphasis> be
+ done by this module. The default is <emphasis>no</emphasis>,
+ which means that Samba keeps setting and evaluating both the
+ system ACLs and the NT ACLs. This is better if you need your
+ system ACLs be set for local or NFS file access, too. If you only
+ access the data via Samba you might set this to yes to achieve
+ better NT ACL compatibility.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_aio_fork.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_aio_fork.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..af69d9ab0d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_aio_fork.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,86 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_aio_fork.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_aio_fork</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_aio_fork</refname>
+ <refpurpose>implement async I/O in Samba vfs</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = aio_fork</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>aio_fork</command> VFS module enables async
+ I/O for Samba on platforms where the system level Posix AIO
+ interface is insufficient. Posix AIO can suffer from severe
+ limitations. For example, on some Linux versions the
+ real-time signals that it uses are broken under heavy load.
+ Other systems only allow AIO when special kernel modules are
+ loaded or only allow a certain system-wide amount of async
+ requests being scheduled. Systems based on glibc (most Linux
+ systems) only allow a single outstanding request per file
+ descriptor. </para>
+
+ <para>To work around all these limitations, the aio_fork module
+ was written. It uses forked helper processes instead of the
+ internal Posix AIO interface to create asynchronousity for
+ read and write calls. It has no parameters, it will create
+ helper processes when async requests come in as needed. Idle
+ helper processes will be removed every 30 seconds.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Straight forward use:</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[cooldata]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/data/ice</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">aio_fork</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.6.0 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_aio_linux.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_aio_linux.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..dac94a5794
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_aio_linux.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,115 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_aio_linux.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_aio_linux</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_aio_linux</refname>
+ <refpurpose>implement async I/O in Samba vfs using Linux kernel aio calls</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = aio_linux</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>aio_linux</command> VFS module enables asynchronous
+ I/O for Samba on Linux kernels that have the kernel AIO calls available
+ without using the Posix AIO interface. Posix AIO can suffer from severe
+ limitations. For example, on some Linux versions the
+ real-time signals that it uses are broken under heavy load.
+ Other systems only allow AIO when special kernel modules are
+ loaded or only allow a certain system-wide amount of async
+ requests being scheduled. Systems based on glibc (most Linux
+ systems) only allow a single outstanding request per file
+ descriptor which essentially makes Posix AIO useless on systems
+ using the glibc implementation.</para>
+
+ <para>To work around all these limitations, the aio_linux module
+ was written. It uses the Linux kernel AIO interface instead of the
+ internal Posix AIO interface to allow read and write calls
+ to be processed asynchronously. A queue size of 128 events
+ is used by default. To change this limit set the "aio num events"
+ parameter below.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ Note that the smb.conf parameters <command>aio read size</command>
+ and <command>aio write size</command> must also be set appropriately
+ for this module to be active.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module MUST be listed last in any module stack as
+ the Samba VFS pread/pwrite interface is not thread-safe. This
+ module makes direct pread and pwrite system calls and does
+ NOT call the Samba VFS pread and pwrite interfaces.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Straight forward use:</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[cooldata]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/data/ice</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="aio read size">1024</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="aio write size">1024</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">aio_linux</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>aio_linux:aio num events = INTEGER</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Set the maximum size of the event queue
+ that is used to limit outstanding IO requests.
+ </para>
+ <para>By default this is set to 128.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.6.6 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_aio_pthread.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_aio_pthread.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..3e41ee9e18
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_aio_pthread.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,120 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_aio_pthread.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_aio_pthread</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_aio_pthread</refname>
+ <refpurpose>implement async I/O in Samba vfs using a pthread pool</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = aio_pthread</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>aio_pthread</command> VFS module enables asynchronous
+ I/O for Samba on platforms which have the pthreads API available,
+ without using the Posix AIO interface. Posix AIO can suffer from severe
+ limitations. For example, on some Linux versions the
+ real-time signals that it uses are broken under heavy load.
+ Other systems only allow AIO when special kernel modules are
+ loaded or only allow a certain system-wide amount of async
+ requests being scheduled. Systems based on glibc (most Linux
+ systems) only allow a single outstanding request per file
+ descriptor which essentially makes Posix AIO useless on systems
+ using the glibc implementation.</para>
+
+ <para>To work around all these limitations, the aio_pthread module
+ was written. It uses a pthread pool instead of the
+ internal Posix AIO interface to allow read and write calls
+ to be process asynchronously. A pthread pool is created
+ which expands dynamically by creating new threads as work is
+ given to it to a maximum of 100 threads per smbd process.
+ To change this limit see the "aio num threads" parameter
+ below. New threads are not created if idle threads are
+ available when a new read or write request is received,
+ the new work is given to an existing idle thread. Threads
+ terminate themselves if idle for one second.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ Note that the smb.conf parameters <command>aio read size</command>
+ and <command>aio write size</command> must also be set appropriately
+ for this module to be active.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module MUST be listed last in any module stack as
+ the Samba VFS pread/pwrite interface is not thread-safe. This
+ module makes direct pread and pwrite system calls and does
+ NOT call the Samba VFS pread and pwrite interfaces.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Straight forward use:</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[cooldata]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/data/ice</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="aio read size">1024</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="aio write size">1024</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">aio_pthread</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>aio_pthread:aio num threads = INTEGER</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Limit the maximum number of threads per smbd that
+ will be created in the thread pool to service IO requests.
+ </para>
+ <para>By default this is set to 100.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.6.3 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_audit.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_audit.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..48936fcc08
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_audit.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,122 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_audit.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_audit</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_audit</refname>
+ <refpurpose>record selected Samba VFS operations in the system log</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = audit</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_audit</command> VFS module records selected
+ client operations to the system log using
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>syslog</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>3</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>
+
+ <para>The following Samba VFS operations are recorded:</para>
+ <simplelist>
+ <member>connect</member>
+ <member>disconnect</member>
+ <member>opendir</member>
+ <member>mkdir</member>
+ <member>rmdir</member>
+ <member>open</member>
+ <member>close</member>
+ <member>rename</member>
+ <member>unlink</member>
+ <member>chmod</member>
+ <member>fchmod</member>
+ <member>chmod_acl</member>
+ <member>fchmod_acl</member>
+ </simplelist>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>audit:facility = FACILITY</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Log messages to the named
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>syslog</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>3</manvolnum></citerefentry> facility.
+
+ </para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>audit:priority = PRIORITY</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Log messages with the named
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>syslog</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>3</manvolnum></citerefentry> priority.
+ </para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Log operations on all shares using the LOCAL1 facility
+ and NOTICE priority:</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[global]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">audit</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="audit:facility">LOCAL1</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="audit:priority">NOTICE</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_cacheprime.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_cacheprime.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..533919a59f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_cacheprime.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,110 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_cacheprime.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_cacheprime</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_cacheprime</refname>
+ <refpurpose>prime the kernel file data cache</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = cacheprime</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_cacheprime</command> VFS module reads chunks
+ of file data near the range requested by clients in order to
+ make sure the data is present in the kernel file data cache at
+ the time when it is actually requested by clients. </para>
+
+ <para>The size of the disk read operations performed
+ by <command>vfs_cacheprime</command> is determined by the
+ cacheprime:rsize option. All disk read operations are aligned
+ on boundaries that are a multiple of this size. Each range of
+ the file data is primed at most once during the time the client
+ has the file open. </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>cacheprime:rsize = BYTES</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The number of bytes with which to prime
+ the kernel data cache.</para>
+ <para>The following suffixes may be applied to BYTES:</para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><command>K</command> - BYTES is a number of kilobytes</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>M</command> - BYTES is a number of megabytes</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>G</command> - BYTES is a number of gigabytes</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>For a hypothetical disk array, it is necessary to ensure
+ that all read operations are of size 1 megabyte (1048576 bytes),
+ and aligned on 1 megabyte boundaries:
+ </para>
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[hypothetical]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">cacheprime</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="cacheprime:rsize">1M</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CAVEATS</title>
+ <para><command>cacheprime</command> is not a a substitute for
+ a general-purpose readahead mechanism. It is intended for use
+ only in very specific environments where disk operations must
+ be aligned and sized to known values (as much as that is possible).
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_cap.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_cap.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..6b625e0f03
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_cap.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,78 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_cap.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_cap</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_cap</refname>
+ <refpurpose>CAP encode filenames</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = cap</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>CAP (Columbia Appletalk Protocol) encoding is a
+ technique for representing non-ASCII filenames in ASCII. The
+ <command>vfs_cap</command> VFS module translates filenames to and
+ from CAP format, allowing users to name files in their native
+ encoding. </para>
+
+ <para>CAP encoding is most commonly
+ used in Japanese language environments. </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>On a system using GNU libiconv, use CAP encoding to support
+ users in the Shift_JIS locale:</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[global]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="dos charset">CP932</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="dos charset">CP932</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">cap</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_catia.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_catia.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..f1368a02c6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_catia.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,73 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_catia.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_catia</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_catia</refname>
+ <refpurpose>translate illegal characters in Catia filenames</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = catia</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The Catia CAD package commonly creates filenames that
+ use characters that are illegal in CIFS filenames. The
+ <command>vfs_catia</command> VFS module implements a fixed character
+ mapping so that these files can be shared with CIFS clients.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Map Catia filenames on the [CAD] share:</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[CAD]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/data/cad</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">catia</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_commit.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_commit.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..395c3de09b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_commit.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,110 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_commit.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_commit</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_commit</refname>
+ <refpurpose>flush dirty data at specified intervals</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = commit</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_commit</command> VFS module keeps track of
+ the amount of data written to a file and synchronizes it to
+ disk when a specified amount accumulates.
+ </para>
+
+ <para><command>vfs_commit</command> is useful in two
+ circumstances. First, if you have very precious data, the
+ impact of unexpected power loss can be minimized by a small
+ commit:dthresh value. Secondly, write performance can be
+ improved on some systems by flushing file data early and at
+ regular intervals.</para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>commit:dthresh = BYTES</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Synchronize file data each time the specified
+ number of bytes has been written.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>The following suffixes may be applied to BYTES:</para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><command>K</command> - BYTES is a number of kilobytes</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>M</command> - BYTES is a number of megabytes</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>G</command> - BYTES is a number of gigabytes</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Synchronize the file data on the [precious] share after
+ every 512 kilobytes (524288 bytes) of data is written:</para>
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[precious]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/data/precious</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">commit</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="commit:dthresh">512K</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CAVEATS</title>
+ <para>On some systems, the data synchronization performed by
+ <command>commit</command> may reduce performance.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_crossrename.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_crossrename.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..ba7c7c8419
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_crossrename.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,116 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_crossrename.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_crossrename</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_crossrename</refname>
+ <refpurpose>server side rename files across filesystem boundaries</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = crossrename</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_crossrename</command> VFS module allows
+ server side rename operations even if source and target are on
+ different physical devices. A "move" in Explorer is usually a
+ rename operation if it is inside of a single share or device.
+ Usually such a rename operation returns
+ NT_STATUS_NOT_SAME_DEVICE and the client has to move the file by
+ manual copy and delete operations. If the rename by copy is done by the
+ server this can be much more efficient. vfs_crossrename tries to do
+ this server-side cross-device rename operation. There are however
+ limitations that this module currently does not solve:
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ the ACLs of files are not preserved
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ meta data in EAs are not preserved
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ renames of whole subdirectories cannot be done recursively,
+ in that case we still return STATUS_NOT_SAME_DEVICE and
+ let the client decide what to do
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ rename operations of huge files can cause hangs on the
+ client because clients expect a rename operation to
+ return fast
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>crossrename:sizelimit = BYTES</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>server-side cross-device-renames are only done
+ for files if the filesize is not larger than the defined
+ size in MiB to prevent timeouts. The default sizelimit is
+ 20 (MiB)
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>To add server-side cross-device renames inside of a share
+ for all files sized up to 50MB:</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[testshare]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/data/mounts</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">crossrename</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="crossrename:sizelimit">50</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.6.0 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_default_quota.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_default_quota.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..c173c36320
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_default_quota.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,136 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_default_quota.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_default_quota</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_default_quota</refname>
+ <refpurpose>store default quota records for Windows clients</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = default_quota</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ suite.</para>
+
+ <para>Many common quota implementations only store
+ quotas for users and groups, but do not store a default quota. The
+ <command>vfs_default_quota</command> module allows Samba to store
+ default quota values which can be examined using the Windows
+ Explorer interface.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>By default, Samba returns NO_LIMIT the default quota and
+ refuses to update them. <command>vfs_default_quota</command> maps
+ the default quota to the quota record of a user. By default the
+ root user is taken because quota limits for root are typically
+ not enforced.</para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>default_quota:uid = UID</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>UID specifies the user ID of the quota record where the
+ default user quota values are stored.
+ </para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>default_quota:gid = GID</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>GID specifies the group ID of the quota record where the
+ default group quota values are stored.
+ </para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>default_quota:uid nolimit = BOOL</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If this parameter is True, then the user whose
+ quota record is storing the default user quota will
+ be reported as having a quota of NO_LIMIT. Otherwise,
+ the stored values will be reported.
+ </para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>default_quota:gid nolimit = BOOL</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If this parameter is True, then the group whose
+ quota record is storing the default group quota will
+ be reported as having a quota of NO_LIMIT. Otherwise,
+ the stored values will be reported.
+ </para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Store the default quota record in the quota record for
+ the user with ID 65535 and report that user as having no quota
+ limits:</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[global]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">default_quota</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="default_quota:uid">65535</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="default_quota:uid nolimit">yes</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_dirsort.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_dirsort.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..d833c4aafe
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_dirsort.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,69 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_dirsort.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_dirsort</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_dirsort</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Sort directory contents</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = dirsort</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_dirsort</command> module sorts directory
+ entries alphabetically before sending them to the client.</para>
+
+ <para>Please be aware that adding this module might have negative
+ performance implications for large directories.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Sort directories for all shares:</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[global]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">dirsort</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.3 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_extd_audit.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_extd_audit.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..bb1ad95c3f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_extd_audit.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,68 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_extd_audit.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_extd_audit</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_extd_audit</refname>
+ <refpurpose>record selected Samba VFS operations</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = extd_audit</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>extd_audit</command> VFS module records selected
+ client operations to both the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> log and
+ system log (using
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>syslog</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>3</manvolnum></citerefentry>).</para>
+
+ <para>Other than logging to the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> log,
+ <command>vfs_extd_audit</command> is identical to
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>vfs_audit</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_fake_perms.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_fake_perms.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..8b58f8dea2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_fake_perms.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,73 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_fake_perms.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_fake_perms</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_fake_perms</refname>
+ <refpurpose>enable read only Roaming Profiles</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = fake_perms</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_fake_perms</command> VFS module was created
+ to allow Roaming Profile files and directories to be set (on
+ the Samba server under UNIX) as read only. This module will,
+ if installed on the Profiles share, report to the client that
+ the Profile files and directories are writeable. This satisfies
+ the client even though the files will never be overwritten as
+ the client logs out or shuts down.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[Profiles]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/profiles</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">fake_perms</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_fileid.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_fileid.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..e4f40ee917
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_fileid.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,112 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_fileid.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_fileid</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_fileid</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Generates file_id structs with unique device id values for
+ cluster setups</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = fileid</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ suite.</para>
+
+ <para>Samba uses file_id structs to uniquely identify files
+ for locking purpose. By default the file_id contains the device
+ and inode number returned by the <command>stat()</command> system call.
+ As the file_id is a unique identifier of a file, it must be the same
+ on all nodes in a cluster setup. This module overloads the
+ <command>SMB_VFS_FILE_ID_CREATE()</command> operation and
+ generates the device number based on the configured algorithm
+ (see the "fileid:algorithm" option).
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>fileid:algorithm = ALGORITHM</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Available algorithms are <command>fsname</command>
+ and <command>fsid</command>. The default value is
+ <command>fsname</command>.
+ </para>
+ <para>The <command>fsname</command> algorithm generates
+ device id by hashing the kernel device name.
+ </para>
+ <para>The <command>fsid</command> algorithm generates
+ the device id from the <command>f_fsid</command> returned
+ from the <command>statfs()</command> syscall.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>fileid:mapping = ALGORITHM</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>This option is the legacy version of the
+ <command>fileid:algorithm</command> option, which was used in earlier
+ versions of fileid mapping feature in custom Samba 3.0 versions.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Usage of the <command>fileid</command> module with the
+ <command>fsid</command> algorithm:</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[global]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">fileid</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="fileid:algorithm">fsid</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.2 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_full_audit.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_full_audit.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..f773a086a8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_full_audit.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,241 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_full_audit.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_full_audit</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_full_audit</refname>
+ <refpurpose>record Samba VFS operations in the system log</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = full_audit</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_full_audit</command> VFS module records selected
+ client operations to the system log using
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>syslog</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>3</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para>
+
+ <para><command>vfs_full_audit</command> is able to record the
+ complete set of Samba VFS operations:</para>
+
+ <simplelist>
+ <member>chdir</member>
+ <member>chflags</member>
+ <member>chmod</member>
+ <member>chmod_acl</member>
+ <member>chown</member>
+ <member>close</member>
+ <member>closedir</member>
+ <member>connect</member>
+ <member>disconnect</member>
+ <member>disk_free</member>
+ <member>fchmod</member>
+ <member>fchmod_acl</member>
+ <member>fchown</member>
+ <member>fget_nt_acl</member>
+ <member>fgetxattr</member>
+ <member>flistxattr</member>
+ <member>fremovexattr</member>
+ <member>fset_nt_acl</member>
+ <member>fsetxattr</member>
+ <member>fstat</member>
+ <member>fsync</member>
+ <member>ftruncate</member>
+ <member>get_nt_acl</member>
+ <member>get_quota</member>
+ <member>get_shadow_copy_data</member>
+ <member>getlock</member>
+ <member>getwd</member>
+ <member>getxattr</member>
+ <member>kernel_flock</member>
+ <member>link</member>
+ <member>linux_setlease</member>
+ <member>listxattr</member>
+ <member>lock</member>
+ <member>lseek</member>
+ <member>lstat</member>
+ <member>mkdir</member>
+ <member>mknod</member>
+ <member>open</member>
+ <member>opendir</member>
+ <member>pread</member>
+ <member>pwrite</member>
+ <member>read</member>
+ <member>readdir</member>
+ <member>readlink</member>
+ <member>realpath</member>
+ <member>removexattr</member>
+ <member>rename</member>
+ <member>rewinddir</member>
+ <member>rmdir</member>
+ <member>seekdir</member>
+ <member>sendfile</member>
+ <member>set_nt_acl</member>
+ <member>set_quota</member>
+ <member>setxattr</member>
+ <member>stat</member>
+ <member>statvfs</member>
+ <member>symlink</member>
+ <member>sys_acl_delete_def_file</member>
+ <member>sys_acl_get_fd</member>
+ <member>sys_acl_get_file</member>
+ <member>sys_acl_set_fd</member>
+ <member>sys_acl_set_file</member>
+ <member>telldir</member>
+ <member>unlink</member>
+ <member>utime</member>
+ <member>write</member>
+ </simplelist>
+
+ <para>In addition to these operations,
+ <command>vfs_full_audit</command> recognizes the special operation
+ names &quot;all&quot; and &quot;none &quot;, which refer to all
+ the VFS operations and none of the VFS operations respectively.
+ </para>
+
+ <para><command>vfs_full_audit</command> records operations in fixed
+ format consisting of fields separated by '|' characters. The
+ format is: </para>
+ <programlisting>
+ smbd_audit: PREFIX|OPERATION|RESULT|FILE
+ </programlisting>
+
+ <para>The record fields are:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><command>PREFIX</command> - the result of the full_audit:prefix string after variable substitutions</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>OPERATION</command> - the name of the VFS operation</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>RESULT</command> - whether the operation succeeded or failed</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>FILE</command> - the name of the file or directory the operation was performed on</para></listitem>
+
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>vfs_full_audit:prefix = STRING</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Prepend audit messages with STRING. STRING is
+ processed for standard substitution variables listed in
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>. The default
+ prefix is &quot;%u|%I&quot;. </para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>vfs_full_audit:success = LIST</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>LIST is a list of VFS operations that should be
+ recorded if they succeed. Operations are specified using
+ the names listed above. Operations can be unset by prefixing
+ the names with "!".
+ </para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>vfs_full_audit:failure = LIST</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>LIST is a list of VFS operations that should be
+ recorded if they failed. Operations are specified using
+ the names listed above. Operations can be unset by prefixing
+ the names with "!".
+ </para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>full_audit:facility = FACILITY</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Log messages to the named
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>syslog</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>3</manvolnum></citerefentry> facility.
+
+ </para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>full_audit:priority = PRIORITY</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Log messages with the named
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>syslog</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>3</manvolnum></citerefentry> priority.
+ </para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Log file and directory open operations on the [records]
+ share using the LOCAL7 facility and ALERT priority, including
+ the username and IP address. Logging excludes the open VFS function
+ on failures:</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[records]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/data/records</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">full_audit</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="full_audit:prefix">%u|%I</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="full_audit:success">open opendir</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="full_audit:failure">all !open</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="full_audit:facility">LOCAL7</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="full_audit:priority">ALERT</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_gpfs.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_gpfs.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..526d86d0d0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_gpfs.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,443 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_gpfs.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_gpfs</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_gpfs</refname>
+ <refpurpose>gpfs specific samba extensions like acls and prealloc</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = gpfs</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>gpfs</command> VFS module is the home
+ for all gpfs extensions that Samba requires for proper integration
+ with GPFS. It uses the GPL library interfaces provided by GPFS.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>Currently the gpfs vfs module provides extensions in following areas :
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>NFSv4 ACL Interfaces with configurable options for GPFS</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>Kernel oplock support on GPFS</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>Lease support on GPFS</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </para>
+
+ <para><command>NOTE:</command>This module follows the posix-acl behaviour
+ and hence allows permission stealing via chown. Samba might allow at a later
+ point in time, to restrict the chown via this module as such restrictions
+ are the responsibility of the underlying filesystem than of Samba.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+ <para>Since Samba 4.0 all options are per share options.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>gpfs:sharemodes = [ yes | no ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Enable/Disable cross node sharemode handling for GPFS.
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>yes(default)</command> - propagate sharemodes across all GPFS nodes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>no</command> - do not propagate sharemodes across all GPFS nodes.
+ This should only be used if the GPFS file system is
+ exclusively exported by Samba. Access by local unix application or
+ NFS exports could lead to corrupted files.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>gpfs:leases = [ yes | no ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Enable/Disable cross node leases (oplocks) for GPFS.
+ You should also set the <command>oplocks</command> and <command>kernel oplocks</command>
+ options to the same value.
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>yes(default)</command> - propagate leases across all GPFS nodes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>no</command> - do not propagate leases across all GPFS nodes.
+ This should only be used if the GPFS file system is
+ exclusively exported by Samba. Access by local unix application or
+ NFS exports could lead to corrupted files.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>gpfs:hsm = [ yes | no ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Enable/Disable announcing if this FS has HSM enabled.
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>no(default)</command> - Do not announce HSM.
+ </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>yes</command> - Announce HSM.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>gpfs:getrealfilename = [ yes | no ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Enable/Disable usage of the <command>gpfs_get_realfilename_path()</command> function.
+ This improves the casesensitive wildcard file name access.
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>yes(default)</command> - use <command>gpfs_get_realfilename_path()</command>.
+ </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>no</command> - do not use <command>gpfs_get_realfilename_path()</command>.
+ It seems that <command>gpfs_get_realfilename_path()</command> doesn't work on AIX.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>gpfs:winattr = [ yes | no ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Enable/Disable usage of the windows attributes in GPFS.
+ GPFS is able to store windows file attributes e.g. HIDDEN,
+ READONLY, SYSTEM and others natively. That means Samba doesn't
+ need to map them to permission bits or extended attributes.
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>no(default)</command> - do not use GPFS windows attributes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>yes</command> - use GPFS windows attributes.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>gpfs:merge_writeappend = [ yes | no ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ GPFS ACLs doesn't know about the 'APPEND' right.
+ This option lets Samba map the 'APPEND' right to 'WRITE'.
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>yes(default)</command> - map 'APPEND' to 'WRITE'.
+ </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>no</command> - do not map 'APPEND' to 'WRITE'.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>gpfs:acl = [ yes | no ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ This option lets Samba use or ignore GPFS ACLs.
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>yes(default)</command> - use GPFS ACLs.
+ </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>no</command> - do not use GPFS ACLs and pass everything
+ to the next SMB_VFS module.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>gpfs:refuse_dacl_protected = [ yes | no ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ As GPFS does not support the ACE4_FLAG_NO_PROPAGATE NFSv4 flag (which would be
+ the mapping for the DESC_DACL_PROTECTED flag), the status of this flag is
+ currently silently ignored by Samba. That means that if you deselect the "Allow
+ inheritable permissions..." checkbox in Windows' ACL dialog and then apply the
+ ACL, the flag will be back immediately.
+ </para>
+ <para>
+ To make sure that automatic migration with e.g. robocopy does not lead to
+ ACLs silently (and unintentionally) changed, you can set
+ <command>gpfs:refuse_dacl_protected = yes</command> to enable an explicit
+ check for this flag and if set, it will return NT_STATUS_NOT_SUPPORTED so
+ errors are shown up on the Windows side and the Administrator is aware of
+ the ACLs not being settable like intended
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>no(default)</command> - ignore the DESC_DACL_PROTECTED flags.
+ </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>yes</command> - reject ACLs with DESC_DACL_PROTECTED.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>gpfs:dfreequota = [ yes | no ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Adjust reporting of the size and free space of a share
+ according to quotas. If this setting is "yes", a
+ request for size and free space will also evaluate the
+ user quota of the user requesting the data, the group
+ quota of the primary group of the user and the fileset
+ quota for the fileset containing the top level
+ directory of the share.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ If any of the soft or hard quota limits has been
+ reached, the free space will be reported as 0. If a
+ quota is in place, but the limits have not been
+ reached, the free space will be reported according to
+ the space left in the quota. If more than one quota
+ applies the free space will be reported as the smallest
+ space left in those quotas. The size of the share
+ will be reported according to the quota usage. If more
+ than one quota applies, the smallest size will be
+ reported for the share size according to these quotas.
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>yes</command> - include the quotas
+ when reporting the share size and free space
+ </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>no(default)</command> - do not include quotas,
+ simply report the size and free space of the file system
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>gpfs:prealloc = [ yes | no ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ If set to yes the gpfs_prealloc function will be used in the
+ fallocate callback when appropriate. If set to no gpfs_prealloc
+ will not be used. In both cases the system and libc calls are
+ avoided.
+ </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>yes (default)</command> - Use gpfs_prealloc for the
+ fallocate callback.
+ </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <command>no</command> - Do not use gpfs_prealloc for the
+ fallocate callback.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>nfs4:mode = [ simple | special ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Enable/Disable substitution of special IDs on GPFS. This parameter
+ should not affect the windows users in anyway. It only ensures that Samba
+ sets the special IDs - OWNER@ and GROUP@ ( mappings to simple uids )
+ that are relevant to GPFS.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>The following MODEs are understood by the module:</para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><command>simple(default)</command> - do not use special IDs in GPFS ACEs</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>special</command> - use special IDs in GPFS ACEs. </para> </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>nfs4:acedup = [dontcare|reject|ignore|merge]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ This parameter configures how Samba handles duplicate ACEs encountered in GPFS ACLs.
+ GPFS allows/creates duplicate ACE for different bits for same ID.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>Following is the behaviour of Samba for different values :</para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><command>dontcare (default)</command> - copy the ACEs as they come</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>reject</command> - stop operation and exit with error on ACL set op</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>ignore</command> - don't include the second matching ACE</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>merge</command> - bitwise OR the 2 ace.flag fields and 2 ace.mask fields of the 2 duplicate ACEs into 1 ACE</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>nfs4:chown = [yes|no]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>This parameter allows enabling or disabling the chown supported
+ by the underlying filesystem. This parameter should be enabled with
+ care as it might leave your system insecure.</para>
+ <para>Some filesystems allow chown as a) giving b) stealing. It is the latter
+ that is considered a risk.</para>
+
+ <para>Following is the behaviour of Samba for different values : </para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><command>yes</command> - Enable chown if as supported by the under filesystem</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>no (default)</command> - Disable chown</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>gpfs:syncio = [yes|no]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>This parameter makes Samba open all files with O_SYNC.
+ This triggers optimizations in GPFS for workloads that
+ heavily share files.</para>
+
+ <para>Following is the behaviour of Samba for different
+ values:
+ </para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><command>yes</command> - Open files with O_SYNC
+ </para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>no (default)</command> - Open files as
+ normal Samba would do
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>A GPFS mount can be exported via Samba as follows :</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[samba_gpfs_share]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">gpfs</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/test/gpfs_mount</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="nfs4: mode">special</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="nfs4: acedup">merge</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CAVEATS</title>
+ <para>
+ Depending on the version of gpfs, the <command>libgpfs_gpl</command>
+ library or the <command>libgpfs</command> library is needed at
+ runtime by the <command>gpfs</command> VFS module:
+ Starting with gpfs 3.2.1 PTF8, the complete <command>libgpfs</command>
+ is available as open source and <command>libgpfs_gpl</command> does no
+ longer exist. With earlier versions of gpfs, only the
+ <command>libgpfs_gpl</command> library was open source and could be
+ used at run time.
+ </para>
+ <para>
+ At build time, only the header file <command>gpfs_gpl.h</command>
+ is required , which is a symlink to <command>gpfs.h</command> in
+ gpfs versions newer than 3.2.1 PTF8.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The GPFS VFS module was created with contributions from
+ Volker Lendecke and the developers at IBM.
+ </para>
+
+ <para> This manpage was created by the IBM FSCC team </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_media_harmony.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_media_harmony.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..f24e700dc4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_media_harmony.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,142 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_media_harmony.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_media_harmony</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_media_harmony</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Allow multiple Avid clients to share a network drive.</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = media_harmony</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_media_harmony</command> VFS module allows
+ Avid editorial workstations to share a network drive. It does
+ this by:</para>
+ <orderedlist continuation="restarts" inheritnum="ignore" numeration="arabic">
+ <listitem><para>Giving each client their own copy of the Avid
+ msmMMOB.mdb and msmFMID.pmr files and Creating directories.</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>Allowing each client to explicitly control the
+ write time the Avid application sees on Avid media directories.</para></listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CONFIGURATION</title>
+
+ <para><command>vfs_media_harmony</command> automatically redirects
+ requests from clients for Avid database files or an Avid Creating
+ directory to a client-specific version of the file. No
+ configuration beyond enabling the module is needed to get this
+ portion of its functionality working.</para>
+
+ <para>If Mac and Windows Avid clients will be accessing the same
+ folder, they should be given separate share definitions, with
+ hidden Mac files vetoed on the Windows share. See EXAMPLES.</para>
+
+ <para>To allow each client to control when the Avid application
+ refreshes their Avid databases, create files for each client
+ and each Avid media directory with the name
+ [avid_dir_name]_[client_ip_address]_[client_username].
+ To trigger Avid database refreshes, update the write time on
+ those files. See EXAMPLES.</para>
+
+ <para>It is also necessary for the <command>cache locked write times = no</command>
+ option to be set for clients to be able to control their Avid
+ media folder write times.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Enable media_harmony for Mac and Windows clients:</para>
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[avid_mac]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/avid</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">media_harmony</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="cache locked write times">no</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfsection name="[avid_win]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/avid</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">media_harmony</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="cache locked write times">no</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="veto files">/.DS_Store/._@/.Trash@/.Spotlight@/.hidden/.hotfiles@/.vol/</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="delete veto files">yes</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+ <para>Create the files that will allow users david and susan
+ to control their own Avid database refreshes:</para>
+<programlisting>
+ touch '/avid/OMFI MediaFiles_192.168.1.10_david' \
+ '/avid/OMFI MediaFiles_192.168.1.11_susan' \
+ '/avid/Avid MediaFiles/MXF/1_192.168.1.10_david' \
+ '/avid/Avid MediaFiles/MXF/1_192.168.1.11_susan'
+</programlisting>
+ <para>Trigger an Avid database refresh for user david:</para>
+<programlisting>
+ touch '/avid/OMFI MediaFiles_192.168.1.10_david' \
+ '/avid/Avid MediaFiles/MXF/1_192.168.1.10_david'
+</programlisting>
+
+ <para>If you have a large number of Avid media folders to manage,
+ you can give each editor a suitably modified version of
+ examples/scripts/vfs/media_harmony/trigger_avid_update.py to
+ create and update these files.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CAVEATS</title>
+
+ <para><command>vfs_media_harmony</command> is designed to work with
+ Avid editing applications that look in the Avid MediaFiles or
+ OMFI MediaFiles directories for media. It is not designed to work
+ as expected in all circumstances for general use. For example: It
+ is possible to open a client-specific file such as
+ msmMMOB.mdb_192.168.1.10_userx even though it doesn't show up
+ in a directory listing.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.2.7 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_netatalk.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_netatalk.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..c543edadba
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_netatalk.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,77 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_netatalk.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_netatalk</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_netatalk</refname>
+ <refpurpose>hide .AppleDouble files from CIFS clients</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = netatalk</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_netatalk</command> VFS module dynamically
+ hides .AppleDouble files, preventing spurious errors on some
+ CIFS clients. .AppleDouble files may be created by historic
+ implementations of AFP (Apple Filing Protocol) on servers. </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Hide .AppleDouble files on the [data] share:</para>
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[data]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">netatalk</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CAVEATS</title>
+ <para>This module is largely historic and unlikely to be of use
+ in modern networks since current Apple systems are able to mount CIFS
+ shares natively.
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_notify_fam.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_notify_fam.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..76e7654ee6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_notify_fam.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,70 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_notify_fam.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_notify_fam</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_notify_fam</refname>
+ <refpurpose>FAM support for file change notifications</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = notify_fam</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_notify_fam</command> module makes use of
+ the system FAM (File Alteration Monitor) daemon to implement
+ file change notifications for Windows clients. FAM is generally
+ present only on IRIX and some BSD systems.</para>
+
+ <para>This module is not stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Support FAM notifications globally:</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[global]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">notify_fam</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_prealloc.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_prealloc.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..5aa25b688d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_prealloc.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,107 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_prealloc.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_prealloc</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_prealloc</refname>
+ <refpurpose>preallocate matching files to a predetermined size</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = prealloc</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_prealloc</command> VFS module preallocates
+ files to a specified size each time a new file is created. This
+ is useful in environments where files are of a predetermined
+ size will be written to a disk subsystem where extending file
+ allocations is expensive. </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>prealloc:EXT = BYTES</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Preallocate all files with the extension EXT to
+ the size specified by BYTES.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>The following suffixes may be applied to BYTES:</para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><command>K</command> - BYTES is a number of kilobytes</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>M</command> - BYTES is a number of megabytes</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>G</command> - BYTES is a number of gigabytes</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>A process writes TIFF files to a Samba share, and the
+ is known these files will almost always be around 4 megabytes
+ (4194304 bytes): </para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[frames]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/data/frames</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">prealloc</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="prealloc:tiff">4M</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CAVEATS</title>
+ <para><command>vfs_prealloc</command> is not supported on all
+ platforms and filesystems. Currently only XFS filesystems on
+ Linux and IRIX are supported.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_preopen.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_preopen.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..27b9567d61
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_preopen.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,115 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_preopen.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_preopen</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_preopen</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Hide read latencies for applications reading numbered files</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = preopen</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>This module assists applications that want to read numbered
+ files in sequence with very strict latency requirements. One area
+ where this happens in video streaming applications that want to read
+ one file per frame.</para>
+
+ <para>When you use this module, a number of helper processes is
+ started that speculatively open files and read a number of bytes to
+ prime the file system cache, so that later on when the real
+ application's request comes along, no disk access is necessary.</para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>preopen:names = /pattern/</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ preopen:names specifies the file name pattern which should
+ trigger the preopen helpers to do their work. We assume that
+ the files are numbered incrementally. So if your file names
+ are numbered FRAME00000.frm FRAME00001.frm and so on you would
+ list them as <command>preopen:names=/FRAME*.frm/</command>
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>preopen:num_bytes = BYTES</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Specifies the number of bytes the helpers should speculatively
+ read, defaults to 1.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>preopen:helpers = NUM-PROCS</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Number of forked helper processes, defaults to 1.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>preopen:queuelen = NUM-FILES</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Number of files that should be speculatively opened. Defaults
+ to the 10 subsequent files.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.3 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The PREOPEN VFS module was created with contributions from
+ Volker Lendecke and the developers at IBM.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_readahead.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_readahead.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..8857cf8557
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_readahead.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,115 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_readahead.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_readahead</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_readahead</refname>
+ <refpurpose>pre-load the kernel buffer cache</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = readahead</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>This <command>vfs_readahead</command> VFS module detects
+ read requests at multiples of a given offset (hex 0x80000 by
+ default) and then tells the kernel via either the readahead
+ system call (on Linux) or the posix_fadvise system call to
+ pre-fetch this data into the buffer cache.</para>
+
+ <para>This module is useful for Windows Vista clients reading
+ data using the Windows Explorer program, which asynchronously
+ does multiple file read requests at offset boundaries of 0x80000
+ bytes.</para>
+
+ <para>The offset multiple used is given by the readahead:offset
+ option, which defaults to 0x80000.</para>
+
+ <para>The size of the disk read operations performed
+ by <command>vfs_readahead</command> is determined by the
+ readahead:length option. By default this is set to the
+ same value as the readahead:offset option and if not
+ set explicitly will use the current value of
+ readahead:offset.</para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>readahead:offset = BYTES</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The offset multiple that causes readahead to be
+ requested of the kernel buffer cache.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>readahead:length = BYTES</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The number of bytes requested to be
+ read into the kernel buffer cache on each
+ readahead call.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <para>The following suffixes may be applied to BYTES:</para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><command>K</command> - BYTES is a number of kilobytes</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>M</command> - BYTES is a number of megabytes</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>G</command> - BYTES is a number of gigabytes</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[hypothetical]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">readahead</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_readonly.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_readonly.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..fee947b53e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_readonly.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,101 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_readonly.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_readonly</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_readonly</refname>
+ <refpurpose>make a Samba share read only for a specified time period</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = readonly</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_readonly</command> VFS module marks a share
+ as read only for all clients connecting within the configured
+ time period. Clients connecting during this time will be denied
+ write access to all files in the share, irrespective of their
+ actual access privileges.</para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>readonly:period = BEGIN, END</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Only mark the share as read only if the client
+ connection was made between the times marked by the
+ BEGIN and END date specifiers.
+ The syntax of these date specifiers is the
+ same as that accepted by the -d option of GNU
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>date</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>.
+ </para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Mark all shares read only:</para>
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[global]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">readonly</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+ <para>Mark the [backup] share as read only during business hours:</para>
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[backup]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/readonly</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">readonly</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="readonly:period">readonly:period = "today 9:00","today 17:00"</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_recycle.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_recycle.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..f0fb80042b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_recycle.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,220 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_recycle.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_recycle</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_recycle</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Samba VFS recycle bin</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = recycle</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_recycle</command> intercepts file deletion
+ requests and moves the affected files to a temporary repository
+ rather than deleting them immediately. This gives the same effect
+ as the Recycle Bin on Windows computers. </para>
+
+ <para>The Recycle Bin will not appear in Windows Explorer
+ views of the network file system (share) nor on any mapped
+ drive. Instead, a directory called .recycle will be automatically
+ created when the first file is deleted and recycle:repository is
+ not configured. If recycle:repository is configured, the name
+ of the created directory depends on recycle:repository. Users
+ can recover files from the recycle bin. If the recycle:keeptree
+ option has been specified, deleted files will be found in a path
+ identical with that from which the file was deleted. </para>
+
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>recycle:repository = PATH</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Path of the directory where deleted files should be moved.
+ </para>
+ <para>If this option is not set, the default path .recycle
+ is used. </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>recycle:directory_mode = MODE</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Set MODE to the octal mode the recycle repository
+ should be created with. The recycle repository will be
+ created when first file is deleted. If recycle:subdir_mode
+ is not set, MODE also applies to subdirectories.
+ </para>
+ <para>If this option is not set, the default mode
+ 0700 is used. </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>recycle:subdir_mode = MODE</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Set MODE to the octal mode with which
+ sub directories of the recycle repository should be created.
+ </para>
+ <para>If this option is not set, subdirectories
+ will be created with the mode from recycle:directory_mode.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>recycle:keeptree = BOOL</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Specifies whether the directory structure should
+ be preserved or whether the files in a directory that is being
+ deleted should be kept separately in the repository.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>recycle:versions = BOOL</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If this option is True, two files with the same
+ name that are deleted will both be kept in the repository.
+ Newer deleted versions of a file will be called
+ &quot;Copy #x of filename&quot;.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>recycle:touch = BOOL</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Specifies whether a file's access date should be
+ updated when the file is moved to the repository.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>recycle:touch_mtime = BOOL</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Specifies whether a file's last modified date should be
+ updated when the file is moved to the repository.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>recycle:minsize = BYTES</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Files that are smaller than the number of bytes
+ specified by this parameter will not be put into the
+ repository.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>recycle:maxsize = BYTES</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Files that are larger than the number of bytes
+ specified by this parameter will not be put into the
+ repository.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>recycle:exclude = LIST</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>List of files that should not be put into the
+ repository when deleted, but deleted in the normal way.
+ Wildcards such as * and ? are supported.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>recycle:exclude_dir = LIST</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>List of directories whose files should not be put
+ into the repository when deleted, but deleted in the
+ normal way. Wildcards such as * and ? are supported.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>recycle:noversions = LIST</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Specifies a list of paths (wildcards such as *
+ and ? are supported) for which no versioning should
+ be used. Only useful when recycle:versions is enabled.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Move files "deleted" on <parameter>share</parameter> to
+ <parameter>/data/share/.recycle</parameter> instead of deleting them:
+ </para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[share]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/data/share</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">recycle</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="recycle:repository">.recycle</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="recycle:keeptree">yes</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="recycle:versions">yes</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_scannedonly.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_scannedonly.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..1f72e93ba4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_scannedonly.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,243 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_scannedonly.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_scannedonly</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_scannedonly</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Ensures that only files that have been scanned for viruses are
+ visible and accessible to the end user.</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = scannedonly</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_scannedonly</command> VFS module ensures that
+ only files that have been scanned for viruses are visible and accessible
+ to the end user. If non-scanned files are found an anti-virus scanning
+ daemon is notified. The anti-virus scanning daemon is not part of the
+ Samba suite.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>Scannedonly comes in two parts: a samba vfs module and (one or
+ more) daemons. The daemon scans files. If a certain file is clean,
+ a second file is created with prefix <filename>.scanned:</filename>.
+ The Samba module simply looks if such a <filename>.scanned:</filename>
+ file exists, and is newer than the pertinent file. If this is the case,
+ the file is shown to the user. If this is not the case, the file is not
+ returned in a directory listing (configurable), and cannot be opened
+ (configurable). The Samba vfs module will notify the daemon to scan
+ this file.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>So what happens for the user in the default configuration. The
+ first time a directory is listed, it shows files as 'file is being
+ scanned for viruses, but after the first time all files are shown.
+ There is a utility scannedonly_prescan that can help you to prescan
+ all directories. When new files are written the daemon is notified
+ immediately after the file is complete.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>If a virus is found by the daemon, a file with a warning message
+ is created in the directory of the user, a warning is sent to the logs,
+ and the file is renamed to have prefix <filename>.virus:</filename>.
+ Files with the <filename>.virus:</filename> prefix are never shown to
+ the user and all access is denied.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CONFIGURATION</title>
+
+ <para><command>vfs_scannedonly</command> relies on a anti-virus scanning
+ daemon that listens on the scannedonly socket (unix domain socket or UDP
+ socket).
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>scannedonly:domain_socket = True </term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Whether to use a unix domain socket or not (false reverts
+ to use udp)
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>scannedonly:socketname = /var/lib/scannedonly/scan</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The location of the unix domain socket to connect to</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>scannedonly:portnum = 2020</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The udp port number to connect to
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>scannedonly:scanhost = localhost</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ When using UDP the host that runs the scanning daemon (this host
+ needs access to the files!)
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>scannedonly:show_special_files = True</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Whether sockets, devices and fifo's (all not scanned for
+ viruses) should be visible to the user
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>scannedonly:rm_hidden_files_on_rmdir = True</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Whether files that are not visible (<filename>.scanned:</filename>
+ files, <filename>.failed:</filename> files and <filename>.virus:
+ </filename> files) should be deleted if the user tries to remove
+ the directory. If false, the user will get the "directory is not
+ empty" error.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>scannedonly:hide_nonscanned_files = True</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ If false, all non-scanned files are visible in directory listings.
+ If such files are found in a directory listing the scanning daemon
+ is notified that scanning is required. Access to non-scanned files
+ is still denied (see scannedonly:allow_nonscanned_files).
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>scannedonly:scanning_message = is being scanned for
+ viruses</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ If non-scanned files are hidden
+ (if scannedonly:hide_nonscanned_files = True), a fake 0 byte file
+ is shown. The filename is the original filename with the message
+ as suffix.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>scannedonly:recheck_time_open = 50</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ If a non-scanned file is opened, the vfs module will wait
+ recheck_tries_open times for recheck_time_open milliseconds for
+ the scanning daemon to create a <filename>.scanned:</filename>
+ file. For small files that are scanned by the daemon within the
+ time (tries * time) the behavior will be just like on-access
+ scanning.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>scannedonly:recheck_tries_open = 100</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ See recheck_time_open.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>scannedonly:recheck_time_readdir = 50</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ If a non-scanned file is in a directory listing the vfs module
+ notifies the daemon (once for all files that need scanning in
+ that directory), and waits recheck_tries_readdir times for
+ recheck_time_readdir milliseconds. Only used when
+ hide_nonscanned_files is false.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>scannedonly:recheck_tries_readdir = 20</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ See recheck_time_readdir.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry><term>scannedonly:allow_nonscanned_files = False</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Allow access to non-scanned files. The daemon is notified,
+ however, and special files such as <filename>.scanned:</filename>
+ files. <filename>.virus:</filename> files and
+ <filename>.failed:</filename> files are not listed.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Enable anti-virus scanning:</para>
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[homes]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">scannedonly</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="scannedonly:hide_nonscanned_files">False</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CAVEATS</title>
+
+ <para>This is not true on-access scanning. However, it is very fast
+ for files that have been scanned already.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.6.0 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Scannedonly was
+ developed for Samba by Olivier Sessink. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_shadow_copy.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_shadow_copy.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..4152b6199e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_shadow_copy.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,121 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_shadow_copy.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_shadow_copy</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_shadow_copy</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Make a Samba share read only for a specified time period</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = shadow_copy</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_shadow_copy</command> VFS module functionality
+ that is similar to Microsoft Shadow Copy services. When setup properly,
+ this module allows Microsoft Shadow Copy clients to browse
+ "shadow copies" on Samba shares.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CONFIGURATION</title>
+
+ <para><command>vfs_shadow_copy</command> relies on a filesystem
+ snapshot implementation. Many common filesystems have native
+ support for this.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>Filesystem snapshots must be mounted on
+ specially named directories in order to be recognized by
+ <command>vfs_shadow_copy</command>. The snapshot mount points must
+ be immediate children of a the directory being shared.</para>
+
+ <para>The snapshot naming convention is @GMT-YYYY.MM.DD-hh.mm.ss,
+ where:
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><command>YYYY</command> is the 4 digit year</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>MM</command> is the 2 digit month</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>DD</command> is the 2 digit day</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>hh</command> is the 2 digit hour</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>mm</command> is the 2 digit minute</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>ss</command> is the 2 digit second.</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_shadow_copy</command> snapshot naming convention can be produced with the following
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>date</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> command:
+ <programlisting>
+ TZ=GMT date +@GMT-%Y.%m.%d-%H.%M.%S
+ </programlisting></para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Add shadow copy support to user home directories:</para>
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[homes]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">shadow_copy</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CAVEATS</title>
+
+ <para>This is not a backup, archival, or version control solution.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>With Samba or Windows servers,
+ <command>vfs_shadow_copy</command> is designed to be an end-user
+ tool only. It does not replace or enhance your backup and
+ archival solutions and should in no way be considered as
+ such. Additionally, if you need version control, implement a
+ version control system.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.0.25 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_shadow_copy2.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_shadow_copy2.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..e5171bbaa4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_shadow_copy2.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,211 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_shadow_copy2.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_shadow_copy2</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_shadow_copy2</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Expose snapshots to Windows clients as shadow copies.</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = shadow_copy2</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_shadow_copy2</command> VFS module functionality
+ that is similar to Microsoft Shadow Copy services. When setup properly,
+ this module allows Microsoft Shadow Copy clients to browse
+ "shadow copies" on Samba shares.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This is a 2nd implementation of a shadow copy module. This
+ version has the following features:</para>
+ <orderedlist continuation="restarts" inheritnum="ignore" numeration="arabic">
+ <listitem><para>You don't need to populate your shares with symlinks to the
+ snapshots. This can be very important when you have thousands of
+ shares, or use [homes].</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>The inode number of the files is altered so it is different
+ from the original. This allows the 'restore' button to work
+ without a sharing violation.</para></listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CONFIGURATION</title>
+
+ <para><command>vfs_shadow_copy2</command> relies on a filesystem
+ snapshot implementation. Many common filesystems have native
+ support for this.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>Filesystem snapshots must be mounted on
+ specially named directories in order to be recognized by
+ <command>vfs_shadow_copy2</command>. The snapshot mount points must
+ be immediate children of a the directory being shared.</para>
+
+ <para>The snapshot naming convention is @GMT-YYYY.MM.DD-hh.mm.ss,
+ where:
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><command>YYYY</command> is the 4 digit year</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>MM</command> is the 2 digit month</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>DD</command> is the 2 digit day</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>hh</command> is the 2 digit hour</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>mm</command> is the 2 digit minute</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>ss</command> is the 2 digit second.</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_shadow_copy2</command> snapshot naming convention can be
+ produced with the following <citerefentry><refentrytitle>date</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry> command:
+ <programlisting>
+ TZ=GMT date +@GMT-%Y.%m.%d-%H.%M.%S
+ </programlisting></para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>shadow:snapdir = SNAPDIR
+ </term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Path to the directory where snapshots are kept.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>shadow:basedir = BASEDIR
+ </term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Path to the base directory that snapshots are from.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>shadow:sort = asc/desc, or not specified for unsorted (default)
+ </term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>By this parameter one can specify that the shadow
+ copy directories should be sorted before they are sent to the
+ client. This can be beneficial as unix filesystems are usually
+ not listed alphabetically sorted. If enabled, you typically
+ want to specify descending order.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>shadow:localtime = yes/no
+ </term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>This is an optional parameter that indicates whether the
+ snapshot names are in UTC/GMT or in local time. By default
+ UTC is expected.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>shadow:format = format specification for snapshot names
+ </term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>This is an optional parameter that specifies the format
+ specification for the naming of snapshots. The format must
+ be compatible with the conversion specifications recognized
+ by str[fp]time. The default value is "@GMT-%Y.%m.%d-%H.%M.%S".
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>shadow:fixinodes = yes/no
+ </term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If you enable <command moreinfo="none">shadow:fixinodes
+ </command> then this module will modify the apparent inode
+ number of files in the snapshot directories using a hash of the
+ files path. This is needed for snapshot systems where the
+ snapshots have the same device:inode number as the original
+ files (such as happens with GPFS snapshots). If you don't set
+ this option then the 'restore' button in the shadow copy UI
+ will fail with a sharing violation.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>Add shadow copy support to user home directories:</para>
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[homes]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">shadow_copy2</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="shadow:snapdir">/data/snapshots</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="shadow:basedir">/data/home</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="shadow:sort">desc</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CAVEATS</title>
+
+ <para>This is not a backup, archival, or version control solution.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>With Samba or Windows servers,
+ <command>vfs_shadow_copy2</command> is designed to be an end-user
+ tool only. It does not replace or enhance your backup and
+ archival solutions and should in no way be considered as
+ such. Additionally, if you need version control, implement a
+ version control system.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.2.7 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_smb_traffic_analyzer.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_smb_traffic_analyzer.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..86ae3f3b7c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_smb_traffic_analyzer.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,299 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_smb_traffic_analyzer.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>smb_traffic_analyzer</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_smb_traffic_analyzer</refname>
+ <refpurpose>log Samba VFS read and write operations through a socket
+ to a helper application</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = smb_traffic_analyzer</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_smb_traffic_analyzer</command> VFS module logs
+ client file operations on a Samba server and sends this data
+ over a socket to a helper program (in the following the "Receiver"),
+ which feeds a SQL database. More
+ information on the helper programs can be obtained from the
+ homepage of the project at:
+ http://holger123.wordpress.com/smb-traffic-analyzer/
+ Since the VFS module depends on a receiver that is doing something with
+ the data, it is evolving in it's development. Therefore, the module
+ works with different protocol versions, and the receiver has to be able
+ to decode the protocol that is used. The protocol version 1 was
+ introduced to Samba at September 25, 2008. It was a very simple
+ protocol, supporting only a small list of VFS operations, and had
+ several drawbacks. The protocol version 2 is a try to solve the
+ problems version 1 had while at the same time adding new features.
+ With the release of Samba 3.6.0, the module will run protocol version 2
+ by default.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>Protocol version 1 documentation</title>
+ <para><command>vfs_smb_traffic_analyzer</command> protocol version 1 is aware
+ of the following VFS operations:</para>
+
+ <simplelist>
+ <member>write</member>
+ <member>pwrite</member>
+ <member>read</member>
+ <member>pread</member>
+ </simplelist>
+
+ <para><command>vfs_smb_traffic_analyzer</command> sends the following data
+ in a fixed format separated by a comma through either an internet or a
+ unix domain socket:</para>
+ <programlisting>
+ BYTES|USER|DOMAIN|READ/WRITE|SHARE|FILENAME|TIMESTAMP
+ </programlisting>
+
+ <para>Description of the records:
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><command>BYTES</command> - the length in bytes of the VFS operation</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>USER</command> - the user who initiated the operation</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>DOMAIN</command> - the domain of the user</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>READ/WRITE</command> - either "W" for a write operation or "R" for read</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>SHARE</command> - the name of the share on which the VFS operation occurred</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>FILENAME</command> - the name of the file that was used by the VFS operation</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>TIMESTAMP</command> - a timestamp, formatted as "yyyy-mm-dd hh-mm-ss.ms" indicating when the VFS operation occurred</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>IP</command> - The IP Address (v4 or v6) of the client machine that initiated the VFS operation.</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>Drawbacks of protocol version 1</title>
+ <para>Several drawbacks have been seen with protocol version 1 over time.</para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ <command>Problematic parsing - </command>
+ Protocol version 1 uses hyphen and comma to seperate blocks of data. Once there is a
+ filename with a hyphen, you will run into problems because the receiver decodes the
+ data in a wrong way.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ <command>Insecure network transfer - </command>
+ Protocol version 1 sends all it's data as plaintext over the network.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ <command>Limited set of supported VFS operations - </command>
+ Protocol version 1 supports only four VFS operations.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ <command>No subreleases of the protocol - </command>
+ Protocol version 1 is fixed on it's version, making it unable to introduce new
+ features or bugfixes through compatible sub-releases.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+</refsect1>
+<refsect1>
+ <title>Version 2 of the protocol</title>
+ <para>Protocol version 2 is an approach to solve the problems introduced with protcol v1.
+ From the users perspective, the following changes are most prominent among other enhancements:
+ </para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ The data from the module may be send encrypted, with a key stored in secrets.tdb. The
+ Receiver then has to use the same key. The module does AES block encryption over the
+ data to send.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ The module now can identify itself against the receiver with a sub-release number, where
+ the receiver may run with a different sub-release number than the module. However, as
+ long as both run on the V2.x protocol, the receiver will not crash, even if the module
+ uses features only implemented in the newer subrelease. Ultimatively, if the module uses
+ a new feature from a newer subrelease, and the receiver runs an older protocol, it is just
+ ignoring the functionality. Of course it is best to have both the receiver and the module
+ running the same subrelease of the protocol.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ The parsing problems of protocol V1 can no longer happen, because V2 is marshalling the
+ data packages in a proper way.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ The module now potentially has the ability to create data on every VFS function. As of
+ protocol V2.0, there is support for 8 VFS functions, namely write,read,pread,pwrite,
+ rename,chdir,mkdir and rmdir. Supporting more VFS functions is one of the targets for the
+ upcoming sub-releases.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ <para>
+ To enable protocol V2, the protocol_version vfs option has to be used (see OPTIONS).
+ </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS with protocol V1 and V2.x</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>smb_traffic_analyzer:mode = STRING</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If STRING matches to "unix_domain_socket", the module will
+ use a unix domain socket located at /var/tmp/stadsocket, if
+ STRING contains an different string or is not defined, the module will
+ use an internet domain socket for data transfer.</para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>smb_traffic_analyzer:host = STRING</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The module will send the data to the system named with
+ the hostname STRING.</para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>smb_traffic_analyzer:port = STRING</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The module will send the data using the TCP port given
+ in STRING.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>smb_traffic_analyzer:anonymize_prefix = STRING</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The module will replace the user names with a prefix
+ given by STRING and a simple hash number. In version 2.x
+ of the protocol, the users SID will also be anonymized.
+ </para>
+
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>smb_traffic_analyzer:total_anonymization = STRING</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If STRING matches to 'yes', the module will replace
+ any user name with the string given by the option
+ smb_traffic_analyzer:anonymize_prefix, without generating
+ an additional hash number. This means that any transfer data
+ will be mapped to a single user, leading to a total
+ anonymization of user related data. In version 2.x of the
+ protocol, the users SID will also be anonymized.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>smb_traffic_analyzer:protocol_version = STRING</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If STRING matches to V1, the module will use version 1 of the
+ protocol. If STRING is not given, the module will use version 2 of the
+ protocol, which is the default.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+ <para>Running protocol V2 on share "example_share", using an internet socket.</para>
+ <programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[example_share]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/data/example</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs_objects">smb_traffic_analyzer</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="smb_traffic_analyzer:host">examplehost</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="smb_traffic_analyzer:port">3491</smbconfoption>
+ </programlisting>
+
+ <para>The module running on share "example_share", using a unix domain socket</para>
+ <programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[example_share]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/data/example</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">smb_traffic_analyzer</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="smb_traffic_analyzer:mode">unix_domain_socket</smbconfoption>
+ </programlisting>
+
+ <para>The module running on share "example_share", using an internet socket,
+ connecting to host "examplehost" on port 3491.</para>
+ <programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[example_share]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/data/example</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">smb_traffic_analyzer</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="smb_traffic_analyzer:host">examplehost</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="smb_traffic_analyzer:port">3491</smbconfoption>
+ </programlisting>
+
+ <para>The module running on share "example_share", using an internet socket,
+ connecting to host "examplehost" on port 3491, anonymizing user names with
+ the prefix "User".</para>
+ <programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[example_share]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/data/example</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">smb_traffic_analyzer</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="smb_traffic_analyzer:host">examplehost</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="smb_traffic_analyzer:port">3491</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="smb_traffic_analyzer:anonymize_prefix">User</smbconfoption>
+ </programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.3 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The original version of the VFS module and the
+ helper tools were created by Holger Hetterich.</para>
+</refsect1>
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_streams_depot.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_streams_depot.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..3a6f99490f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_streams_depot.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,78 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_streams_depot.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_streams_depot</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_streams_depot</refname>
+ <refpurpose>EXPERIMENTAL module to store alternate data streams in a
+ central directory.
+ </refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = streams_depot</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This <emphasis>EXPERIMENTAL</emphasis> VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_streams_depot</command> enables storing of NTFS
+ alternate data streams in the file system. As a normal posix file
+ system does not support the concept of multiple data streams per file,
+ the streams_depot module stores the data in files in a separate
+ directory.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>streams_depot:directory = PATH</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Path of the directory where the alternate data streams
+ should be stored. Defaults to the sharepath/.streams.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[share]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">streams_depot</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_streams_xattr.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_streams_xattr.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..0d67273c3c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_streams_xattr.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,68 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_streams_xattr.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_streams_xattr</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_streams_xattr</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Store alternate data streams in posix xattrs</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = streams_xattr</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_streams_xattr</command> enables storing of NTFS
+ alternate data streams in the file system. As a normal posix file
+ system does not support the concept of multiple data streams per file,
+ the streams_xattr module stores the data in posix extended attributes
+ (xattrs). The name of these attributes is
+ user.DosStream."ADS-NAME".</para>
+
+ <para>The file system that is shared with this module enabled must
+ support xattrs.</para>
+
+ <para>Please note that most file systems have severe limitations on
+ the size of xattrs. So this module might work for applications like IE
+ that stores small zone information in streams but will fail for
+ applications that store serious amounts of data in ADSs.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[share]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">streams_xattr</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_time_audit.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_time_audit.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..d79acc8600
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_time_audit.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,101 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_time_audit.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_time_audit</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_time_audit</refname>
+ <refpurpose>samba vfs module to log slow VFS operations</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = time_audit</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>time_audit</command> VFS module logs system calls
+ that take longer than the number of milliseconds defined by the variable
+ <command>time_audit:timeout</command>. It will log the calls and
+ the time spent in it.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>It's kind of comparable with <command>strace -T</command> and
+ is helpful to reveal performance problems with the underlying file
+ and storage subsystems.</para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>time_audit:timeout = number of milliseconds</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>VFS calls that take longer than the defined number of milliseconds
+ that should be logged. The default is 10000 (10s).
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>This would log VFS calls that take longer than 3 seconds:</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[sample_share]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/test/sample_share</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">time_audit</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="time_audit:timeout">3000</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.6.0 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The time_audit VFS module was created with contributions from
+ Abhidnya Chirmule.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_tsmsm.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_tsmsm.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..eac17d31eb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_tsmsm.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,135 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_tsmsm.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_tsmsm</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_tsmsm</refname>
+ <refpurpose>VFS module for handling offline files with Tivoli Storage Manager Space Management</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = tsmsm</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>tsmsm</command> VFS module is an
+ extension for handling offline files with Tivoli
+ Storage Manager Space Management.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ It tries to avoid calling expensive DMAPI calls with some
+ heuristics based on the fact that number of blocks reported of a
+ file multiplied by 512 will be bigger than 'online ratio' of
+ actual size for online (non-migrated) files.
+ If heuristic check fails, the module calls DMAPI and asks for
+ a specific attribute which is present for offline (migrated) files.
+ If this attribute presents, the file is considered offline.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module is not stackable.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>tsmsm:hsm script = [ path to hsm script ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ hsm script should point to a shell script which
+ accepts two arguments: operation and filepath.
+ the tsmsm module only uses "offline" for operation
+ to set set the file under filepath offline.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>tsmsm:online ratio = [ number ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Ratio to check reported size against actual file size.
+ The default value is 0.5.
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>tsmsm:dmapi attribute = [ attribute-name ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Name of a DMAPI attribute that is present when a file is offline.
+ The default is "IBMobj" (which is what GPFS uses).
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+ <varlistentry>
+
+ <term>tsmsm:dmapi value = [ value for the DMAPI attribute ]</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>
+ Value that the DMAPI attribute should have for the file to
+ be considered offline. The default is empty (no value required).
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLES</title>
+
+ <para>A GPFS mount with TSM support can be exported via Samba as follows:</para>
+
+<programlisting>
+ <smbconfsection name="[gpfs_tsm_share]"/>
+ <smbconfoption name="vfs objects">tsmsm gpfs</smbconfoption>
+ <smbconfoption name="path">/test/gpfs_mount</smbconfoption>
+</programlisting>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3.6 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_xattr_tdb.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_xattr_tdb.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..47c75038a8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfs_xattr_tdb.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,69 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfs_xattr_tdb.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfs_xattr_tdb</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfs_xattr_tdb</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Save Extended Attributes (EAs) in a tdb file</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfs objects = xattr_tdb</command>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This VFS module is part of the
+ <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>vfs_xattr_tdb</command> VFS module stores
+ Extended Attributes (EAs) in a tdb file.
+ This enables the usage of Extended Attributes on OS and
+ filesystems which do not support Extended Attributes
+ by themselves.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>This module is stackable.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>xattr_tdb:file = PATH</term>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Name of the tdb file the EAs are stored in.
+ If this option is not set, the default filename
+ <filename>xattr.tdb</filename> is used.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/vfstest.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/vfstest.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..675d766550
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/vfstest.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,153 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="vfstest.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>vfstest</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>vfstest</refname>
+ <refpurpose>tool for testing samba VFS modules </refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>vfstest</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d debuglevel</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-c command</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-l logdir</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-h</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>vfstest</command> is a small command line
+ utility that has the ability to test dso samba VFS modules. It gives the
+ user the ability to call the various VFS functions manually and
+ supports cascaded VFS modules.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-c|--command=command</term>
+ <listitem><para>Execute the specified (colon-separated) commands.
+ See below for the commands that are available.
+ </para> </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.help;
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-l|--logfile=logbasename</term>
+ <listitem><para>File name for log/debug files. The extension
+ <constant>'.client'</constant> will be appended. The log file is never removed
+ by the client.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>COMMANDS</title>
+
+ <para><emphasis>VFS COMMANDS</emphasis></para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><command>load &lt;module.so&gt;</command> - Load specified VFS module </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><command>populate &lt;char&gt; &lt;size&gt;</command> - Populate a data buffer with the specified data
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><command>showdata [&lt;offset&gt; &lt;len&gt;]</command> - Show data currently in data buffer
+ </para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><command>connect</command> - VFS connect()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>disconnect</command> - VFS disconnect()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>disk_free</command> - VFS disk_free()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>opendir</command> - VFS opendir()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>readdir</command> - VFS readdir()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>mkdir</command> - VFS mkdir()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>rmdir</command> - VFS rmdir()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>closedir</command> - VFS closedir()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>open</command> - VFS open()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>close</command> - VFS close()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>read</command> - VFS read()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>write</command> - VFS write()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>lseek</command> - VFS lseek()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>rename</command> - VFS rename()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>fsync</command> - VFS fsync()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>stat</command> - VFS stat()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>fstat</command> - VFS fstat()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>lstat</command> - VFS lstat()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>unlink</command> - VFS unlink()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>chmod</command> - VFS chmod()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>fchmod</command> - VFS fchmod()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>chown</command> - VFS chown()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>fchown</command> - VFS fchown()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>chdir</command> - VFS chdir()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>getwd</command> - VFS getwd()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>utime</command> - VFS utime()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>ftruncate</command> - VFS ftruncate()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>lock</command> - VFS lock()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>symlink</command> - VFS symlink()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>readlink</command> - VFS readlink()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>link</command> - VFS link()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>mknod</command> - VFS mknod()</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><command>realpath</command> - VFS realpath()</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para><emphasis>GENERAL COMMANDS</emphasis></para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para><command>conf &lt;smb.conf&gt;</command> - Load a different configuration file</para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><command>help [&lt;command&gt;]</command> - Get list of commands or info about specified command</para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><command>debuglevel &lt;level&gt;</command> - Set debug level</para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><command>freemem</command> - Free memory currently in use</para></listitem>
+
+ <listitem><para><command>exit</command> - Exit vfstest</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba
+ suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para>The vfstest man page was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/wbinfo.1.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/wbinfo.1.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..93fc0abbed
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/wbinfo.1.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,500 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="wbinfo.1">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>wbinfo</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">User Commands</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>wbinfo</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Query information from winbind daemon</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>wbinfo</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-a user%password</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--all-domains</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--allocate-gid</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--allocate-uid</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-c</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--ccache-save</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--change-user-password</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-D domain</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--domain domain</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--dsgetdcname domain</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-g</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--getdcname domain</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--get-auth-user</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-G gid</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--gid-info gid</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--group-info group</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--help|-?</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-i user</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-I ip</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-K user%password</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--lanman</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-m</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-n name</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-N netbios-name</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--ntlmv2</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--online-status</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--own-domain</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-p</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-P|--ping-dc</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-r user</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-R|--lookup-rids</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s sid</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--separator</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--set-auth-user user%password</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-S sid</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--sid-aliases sid</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--sid-to-fullname sid</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-t</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-u</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--uid-info uid</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--usage</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--user-domgroups sid</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--user-sidinfo sid</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--user-sids sid</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-U uid</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-V</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">--verbose</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-Y sid</arg>
+
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This tool is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para>The <command>wbinfo</command> program queries and returns information
+ created and used by the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon. </para>
+
+ <para>The <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon must be configured
+ and running for the <command>wbinfo</command> program to be able
+ to return information.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-a|--authenticate <replaceable>username%password</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Attempt to authenticate a user via <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>.
+ This checks both authentication methods and reports its results.
+ </para><note><para>Do not be tempted to use this
+ functionality for authentication in third-party
+ applications. Instead use <citerefentry><refentrytitle>ntlm_auth</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>.</para></note></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--allocate-gid</term>
+ <listitem><para>Get a new GID out of idmap
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--allocate-uid</term>
+ <listitem><para>Get a new UID out of idmap
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--all-domains</term>
+ <listitem><para>List all domains (trusted and
+ own domain).
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-c|--change-secret</term>
+ <listitem><para>Change the trust account password. May be used
+ in conjunction with <option>domain</option> in order to change
+ interdomain trust account passwords.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--ccache-save <replaceable>username%password</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Store user and password for ccache.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--change-user-password <replaceable>username</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Change the password of a user. The old and new password will be prompted.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--domain <replaceable>name</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>This parameter sets the domain on which any specified
+ operations will performed. If special domain name '.' is used to represent
+ the current domain to which <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> belongs. Currently only the
+ <option>-u</option>, and <option>-g</option> options honor this parameter.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-D|--domain-info <replaceable>domain</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Show most of the info we have about the
+ specified domain.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--dsgetdcname <replaceable>domain</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Find a DC for a domain.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--gid-info <replaceable>gid</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Get group info from gid.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--group-info <replaceable>group</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Get group info from group name.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-g|--domain-groups</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option will list all groups available
+ in the Windows NT domain for which the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon is operating in. Groups in all trusted domains
+ will also be listed. Note that this operation does not assign
+ group ids to any groups that have not already been
+ seen by <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--get-auth-user</term>
+ <listitem><para>Print username and password used by <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ during session setup to a domain controller. Username
+ and password can be set using <option>--set-auth-user</option>.
+ Only available for root.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--getdcname <replaceable>domain</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Get the DC name for the specified domain.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-G|--gid-to-sid <replaceable>gid</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Try to convert a UNIX group id to a Windows
+ NT SID. If the gid specified does not refer to one within
+ the idmap gid range then the operation will fail. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-?</term>
+ <listitem><para>Print brief help overview.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-i|--user-info <replaceable>user</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Get user info.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-I|--WINS-by-ip <replaceable>ip</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <parameter>-I</parameter> option
+ queries <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> to send a node status
+ request to get the NetBIOS name associated with the IP address
+ specified by the <parameter>ip</parameter> parameter.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-K|--krb5auth <replaceable>username%password</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Attempt to authenticate a user via Kerberos.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--lanman</term>
+ <listitem><para>Use lanman cryptography for user authentication.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-m|--trusted-domains</term>
+ <listitem><para>Produce a list of domains trusted by the
+ Windows NT server <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> contacts
+ when resolving names. This list does not include the Windows
+ NT domain the server is a Primary Domain Controller for.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-n|--name-to-sid <replaceable>name</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <parameter>-n</parameter> option
+ queries <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> for the SID
+ associated with the name specified. Domain names can be specified
+ before the user name by using the winbind separator character.
+ For example CWDOM1/Administrator refers to the Administrator
+ user in the domain CWDOM1. If no domain is specified then the
+ domain used is the one specified in the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> <parameter>workgroup
+ </parameter> parameter. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-N|--WINS-by-name <replaceable>name</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>The <parameter>-N</parameter> option
+ queries <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> to query the WINS
+ server for the IP address associated with the NetBIOS name
+ specified by the <parameter>name</parameter> parameter.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--ntlmv2</term>
+ <listitem><para>Use NTLMv2 cryptography for user authentication.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--online-status <replaceable>domain</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Show whether domains are marked as online or
+ offline. An optional domain argument limits the
+ output to the online status of a given domain.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--own-domain</term>
+ <listitem><para>List own domain.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-p|--ping</term>
+ <listitem><para>Check whether <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> is still alive.
+ Prints out either 'succeeded' or 'failed'.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-P|--ping-dc</term>
+ <listitem><para>Issue a no-effect command to our DC. This
+ checks if our secure channel connection to our domain
+ controller is still alive. It has much less impact than
+ wbinfo -t.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-r|--user-groups <replaceable>username</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Try to obtain the list of UNIX group ids
+ to which the user belongs. This only works for users
+ defined on a Domain Controller.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-R|--lookup-rids <replaceable>rid1, rid2, rid3...</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Converts RIDs to names. Uses a comma separated
+ list of rids.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-s|--sid-to-name <replaceable>sid</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Use <parameter>-s</parameter> to resolve
+ a SID to a name. This is the inverse of the <parameter>-n
+ </parameter> option above. SIDs must be specified as ASCII strings
+ in the traditional Microsoft format. For example,
+ S-1-5-21-1455342024-3071081365-2475485837-500. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--separator</term>
+ <listitem><para>Get the active winbind separator.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--set-auth-user <replaceable>username%password</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Store username and password used by <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry> during session setup to a domain controller. This enables
+ winbindd to operate in a Windows 2000 domain with Restrict
+ Anonymous turned on (a.k.a. Permissions compatible with
+ Windows 2000 servers only).
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-S|--sid-to-uid <replaceable>sid</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Convert a SID to a UNIX user id. If the SID
+ does not correspond to a UNIX user mapped by <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry> then the operation will fail. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--sid-aliases <replaceable>sid</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Get SID aliases for a given SID.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--sid-to-fullname <replaceable>sid</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Converts a SID to a full username
+ (DOMAIN\username).
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-t|--check-secret</term>
+ <listitem><para>Verify that the workstation trust account
+ created when the Samba server is added to the Windows NT
+ domain is working. May be used in conjunction with
+ <option>domain</option> in order to verify interdomain
+ trust accounts.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-u|--domain-users</term>
+ <listitem><para>This option will list all users available
+ in the Windows NT domain for which the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon is operating in. Users in all trusted domains
+ will also be listed. Note that this operation does not assign
+ user ids to any users that have not already been seen by <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>
+ .</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--uid-info <replaceable>uid</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Get user info for the user connected to
+ user id UID.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--usage</term>
+ <listitem><para>Print brief help overview.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--user-domgroups <replaceable>sid</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Get user domain groups.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--user-sidinfo <replaceable>sid</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Get user info by sid.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--user-sids <replaceable>sid</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Get user group SIDs for user.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-U|--uid-to-sid <replaceable>uid</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Try to convert a UNIX user id to a Windows NT
+ SID. If the uid specified does not refer to one within
+ the idmap range then the operation will fail. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>--verbose</term>
+ <listitem><para>
+ Print additional information about the query results.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-Y|--sid-to-gid <replaceable>sid</replaceable></term>
+ <listitem><para>Convert a SID to a UNIX group id. If the SID
+ does not correspond to a UNIX group mapped by <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> then
+ the operation will fail. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.version;
+ &stdarg.help;
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXIT STATUS</title>
+
+ <para>The wbinfo program returns 0 if the operation
+ succeeded, or 1 if the operation failed. If the <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle><manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry> daemon is not working <command>wbinfo</command> will always return
+ failure. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+ <para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> and <citerefentry><refentrytitle>ntlm_auth</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para><command>wbinfo</command> and <command>winbindd</command>
+ were written by Tim Potter.</para>
+
+ <para>The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done
+ by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for Samba
+ 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/winbind_krb5_locator.7.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/winbind_krb5_locator.7.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..4f63e15aa4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/winbind_krb5_locator.7.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,95 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="winbind_krb5_locator.7">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>winbind_krb5_locator</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">7</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>winbind_krb5_locator</refname>
+ <refpurpose>A plugin for MIT and Heimdal Kerberos for detecting KDCs using Windows semantics.</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>
+ This plugin is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ <command>winbind_krb5_locator</command> is a plugin that permits MIT and
+ Heimdal Kerberos libraries to detect Kerberos Servers (for the KDC and
+ kpasswd service) using the same semantics that other tools of the Samba
+ suite use. This include site-aware DNS service record lookups and caching
+ of closest dc.
+ The plugin uses the public locator API provided by most modern Kerberos
+ implementations.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+<refsect1>
+ <title>PREREQUISITES</title>
+ <para>
+ MIT Kerberos (at least version 1.5) or Heimdal Kerberos (at least version
+ 1.0) is required.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The plugin queries the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> daemon which needs to be configured
+ and started separately.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The <command>winbind_krb5_locator.so</command> file needs to be manually
+ copied to the plugin directory of the system Kerberos library.
+
+ For MIT Kerberos this is often:
+ <filename>/usr/lib/krb5/plugins/libkrb5/</filename>.
+ For Heimdal Kerberos this is often:
+ <filename>/usr/lib/plugin/krb5/</filename>.
+
+ Please check your local Kerberos installation for the correct
+ paths. No modification in <filename>/etc/krb5.conf</filename>
+ is required to enable the use of this plugin.
+ </para>
+ <para>
+ After copying the locator plugin to the appropriate plugin
+ directory it should immediately be available for use.
+ Users should be able to kinit into their kerberized Windows
+ environment without any modification or servers
+ being put manually into <filename>/etc/krb5.conf</filename>.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>
+ This man page is correct for version 3 of the Samba suite.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>
+ The original Samba software and related utilities were created by Andrew
+ Tridgell. Samba is now developed by the Samba Team as an Open Source
+ project similar to the way the Linux kernel is developed.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The winbind_krb5_locator manpage was written by Guenther Deschner.
+ </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>
diff --git a/docs-xml/manpages/winbindd.8.xml b/docs-xml/manpages/winbindd.8.xml
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..71829fb124
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs-xml/manpages/winbindd.8.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,497 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="iso-8859-1"?>
+<!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//Samba-Team//DTD DocBook V4.2-Based Variant V1.0//EN" "http://www.samba.org/samba/DTD/samba-doc">
+<refentry id="winbindd.8">
+
+<refmeta>
+ <refentrytitle>winbindd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum>
+ <refmiscinfo class="source">Samba</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="manual">System Administration tools</refmiscinfo>
+ <refmiscinfo class="version">3.6</refmiscinfo>
+</refmeta>
+
+
+<refnamediv>
+ <refname>winbindd</refname>
+ <refpurpose>Name Service Switch daemon for resolving names
+ from NT servers</refpurpose>
+</refnamediv>
+
+<refsynopsisdiv>
+ <cmdsynopsis>
+ <command>winbindd</command>
+ <arg choice="opt">-D</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-F</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-S</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-i</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-d &lt;debug level&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-s &lt;smb config file&gt;</arg>
+ <arg choice="opt">-n</arg>
+ </cmdsynopsis>
+</refsynopsisdiv>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>DESCRIPTION</title>
+
+ <para>This program is part of the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry> suite.</para>
+
+ <para><command>winbindd</command> is a daemon that provides
+ a number of services to the Name Service Switch capability found
+ in most modern C libraries, to arbitrary applications via PAM
+ and <command>ntlm_auth</command> and to Samba itself.</para>
+
+ <para>Even if winbind is not used for nsswitch, it still provides a
+ service to <command>smbd</command>, <command>ntlm_auth</command>
+ and the <command>pam_winbind.so</command> PAM module, by managing connections to
+ domain controllers. In this configuration the
+ <smbconfoption name="idmap config * : range"/>
+ parameter is not required. (This is known as `netlogon proxy only mode'.)</para>
+
+ <para> The Name Service Switch allows user
+ and system information to be obtained from different databases
+ services such as NIS or DNS. The exact behaviour can be configured
+ through the <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename> file.
+ Users and groups are allocated as they are resolved to a range
+ of user and group ids specified by the administrator of the
+ Samba system.</para>
+
+ <para>The service provided by <command>winbindd</command> is called `winbind' and
+ can be used to resolve user and group information from a
+ Windows NT server. The service can also provide authentication
+ services via an associated PAM module. </para>
+
+ <para>
+ The <filename>pam_winbind</filename> module supports the
+ <parameter>auth</parameter>, <parameter>account</parameter>
+ and <parameter>password</parameter>
+ module-types. It should be noted that the
+ <parameter>account</parameter> module simply performs a getpwnam() to verify that
+ the system can obtain a uid for the user, as the domain
+ controller has already performed access control. If the
+ <filename>libnss_winbind</filename> library has been correctly
+ installed, or an alternate source of names configured, this should always succeed.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>The following nsswitch databases are implemented by
+ the winbindd service: </para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>hosts</term>
+ <listitem><para>This feature is only available on IRIX.
+ User information traditionally stored in
+ the <filename>hosts(5)</filename> file and used by
+ <command>gethostbyname(3)</command> functions. Names are
+ resolved through the WINS server or by broadcast.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>passwd</term>
+ <listitem><para>User information traditionally stored in
+ the <filename>passwd(5)</filename> file and used by
+ <command>getpwent(3)</command> functions. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>group</term>
+ <listitem><para>Group information traditionally stored in
+ the <filename>group(5)</filename> file and used by
+ <command>getgrent(3)</command> functions. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+
+ <para>For example, the following simple configuration in the
+ <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename> file can be used to initially
+ resolve user and group information from <filename>/etc/passwd
+ </filename> and <filename>/etc/group</filename> and then from the
+ Windows NT server.
+ </para>
+
+<programlisting>
+passwd: files winbind
+group: files winbind
+## only available on IRIX: use winbind to resolve hosts:
+# hosts: files dns winbind
+## All other NSS enabled systems should use libnss_wins.so like this:
+hosts: files dns wins
+
+</programlisting>
+
+ <para>The following simple configuration in the
+ <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename> file can be used to initially
+ resolve hostnames from <filename>/etc/hosts</filename> and then from the
+ WINS server.</para>
+<programlisting>
+hosts: files wins
+</programlisting>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>OPTIONS</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-D</term>
+ <listitem><para>If specified, this parameter causes
+ the server to operate as a daemon. That is, it detaches
+ itself and runs in the background on the appropriate port.
+ This switch is assumed if <command>winbindd</command> is
+ executed on the command line of a shell.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-F</term>
+ <listitem><para>If specified, this parameter causes
+ the main <command>winbindd</command> process to not daemonize,
+ i.e. double-fork and disassociate with the terminal.
+ Child processes are still created as normal to service
+ each connection request, but the main process does not
+ exit. This operation mode is suitable for running
+ <command>winbindd</command> under process supervisors such
+ as <command>supervise</command> and <command>svscan</command>
+ from Daniel J. Bernstein's <command>daemontools</command>
+ package, or the AIX process monitor.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-S</term>
+ <listitem><para>If specified, this parameter causes
+ <command>winbindd</command> to log to standard output rather
+ than a file.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ &stdarg.server.debug;
+ &popt.common.samba;
+ &stdarg.help;
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-i</term>
+ <listitem><para>Tells <command>winbindd</command> to not
+ become a daemon and detach from the current terminal. This
+ option is used by developers when interactive debugging
+ of <command>winbindd</command> is required.
+ <command>winbindd</command> also logs to standard output,
+ as if the <command>-S</command> parameter had been given.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>-n</term>
+ <listitem><para>Disable caching. This means winbindd will
+ always have to wait for a response from the domain controller
+ before it can respond to a client and this thus makes things
+ slower. The results will however be more accurate, since
+ results from the cache might not be up-to-date. This
+ might also temporarily hang winbindd if the DC doesn't respond.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>NAME AND ID RESOLUTION</title>
+
+ <para>Users and groups on a Windows NT server are assigned
+ a security id (SID) which is globally unique when the
+ user or group is created. To convert the Windows NT user or group
+ into a unix user or group, a mapping between SIDs and unix user
+ and group ids is required. This is one of the jobs that <command>
+ winbindd</command> performs. </para>
+
+ <para>As winbindd users and groups are resolved from a server, user
+ and group ids are allocated from a specified range. This
+ is done on a first come, first served basis, although all existing
+ users and groups will be mapped as soon as a client performs a user
+ or group enumeration command. The allocated unix ids are stored
+ in a database and will be remembered. </para>
+
+ <para>WARNING: The SID to unix id database is the only location
+ where the user and group mappings are stored by winbindd. If this
+ store is deleted or corrupted, there is no way for winbindd to
+ determine which user and group ids correspond to Windows NT user
+ and group rids. </para>
+
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>CONFIGURATION</title>
+
+ <para>Configuration of the <command>winbindd</command> daemon
+ is done through configuration parameters in the <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle><manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
+ </citerefentry> file. All parameters should be specified in the
+ [global] section of smb.conf. </para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <smbconfoption name="winbind separator"/></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <smbconfoption name="idmap config * : range"/></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <smbconfoption name="idmap config * : backend"/></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <smbconfoption name="winbind cache time"/></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <smbconfoption name="winbind enum users"/></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <smbconfoption name="winbind enum groups"/></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <smbconfoption name="template homedir"/></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <smbconfoption name="template shell"/></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <smbconfoption name="winbind use default domain"/></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para>
+ <smbconfoption name="winbind: rpc only"/>
+ Setting this parameter forces winbindd to use RPC
+ instead of LDAP to retrieve information from Domain
+ Controllers.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>EXAMPLE SETUP</title>
+
+ <para>
+ To setup winbindd for user and group lookups plus
+ authentication from a domain controller use something like the
+ following setup. This was tested on an early Red Hat Linux box.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>In <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename> put the
+ following:
+<programlisting>
+passwd: files winbind
+group: files winbind
+</programlisting>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>In <filename>/etc/pam.d/*</filename> replace the <parameter>
+ auth</parameter> lines with something like this:
+<programlisting>
+auth required /lib/security/pam_securetty.so
+auth required /lib/security/pam_nologin.so
+auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+auth required /lib/security/pam_unix.so \
+ use_first_pass shadow nullok
+</programlisting>
+ </para>
+
+ <note><para>
+ The PAM module pam_unix has recently replaced the module pam_pwdb.
+ Some Linux systems use the module pam_unix2 in place of pam_unix.
+ </para></note>
+
+ <para>Note in particular the use of the <parameter>sufficient
+ </parameter> keyword and the <parameter>use_first_pass</parameter> keyword. </para>
+
+ <para>Now replace the account lines with this: </para>
+
+ <para><command>account required /lib/security/pam_winbind.so
+ </command></para>
+
+ <para>The next step is to join the domain. To do that use the
+ <command>net</command> program like this: </para>
+
+ <para><command>net join -S PDC -U Administrator</command></para>
+
+ <para>The username after the <parameter>-U</parameter> can be any
+ Domain user that has administrator privileges on the machine.
+ Substitute the name or IP of your PDC for "PDC".</para>
+
+ <para>Next copy <filename>libnss_winbind.so</filename> to
+ <filename>/lib</filename> and <filename>pam_winbind.so
+ </filename> to <filename>/lib/security</filename>. A symbolic link needs to be
+ made from <filename>/lib/libnss_winbind.so</filename> to
+ <filename>/lib/libnss_winbind.so.2</filename>. If you are using an
+ older version of glibc then the target of the link should be
+ <filename>/lib/libnss_winbind.so.1</filename>.</para>
+
+ <para>Finally, setup a <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> containing directives like the
+ following:
+<programlisting>
+[global]
+ winbind separator = +
+ winbind cache time = 10
+ template shell = /bin/bash
+ template homedir = /home/%D/%U
+ idmap config * : range = 10000-20000
+ workgroup = DOMAIN
+ security = domain
+ password server = *
+</programlisting></para>
+
+
+ <para>Now start winbindd and you should find that your user and
+ group database is expanded to include your NT users and groups,
+ and that you can login to your unix box as a domain user, using
+ the DOMAIN+user syntax for the username. You may wish to use the
+ commands <command>getent passwd</command> and <command>getent group
+ </command> to confirm the correct operation of winbindd.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>NOTES</title>
+
+ <para>The following notes are useful when configuring and
+ running <command>winbindd</command>: </para>
+
+ <para><citerefentry><refentrytitle>nmbd</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry> must be running on the local machine
+ for <command>winbindd</command> to work. </para>
+
+ <para>PAM is really easy to misconfigure. Make sure you know what
+ you are doing when modifying PAM configuration files. It is possible
+ to set up PAM such that you can no longer log into your system. </para>
+
+ <para>If more than one UNIX machine is running <command>winbindd</command>,
+ then in general the user and groups ids allocated by winbindd will not
+ be the same. The user and group ids will only be valid for the local
+ machine, unless a shared <smbconfoption name="idmap config * : backend"/> is configured.</para>
+
+ <para>If the the Windows NT SID to UNIX user and group id mapping
+ file is damaged or destroyed then the mappings will be lost. </para>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SIGNALS</title>
+
+ <para>The following signals can be used to manipulate the
+ <command>winbindd</command> daemon. </para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>SIGHUP</term>
+ <listitem><para>Reload the <citerefentry><refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry> file and
+ apply any parameter changes to the running
+ version of winbindd. This signal also clears any cached
+ user and group information. The list of other domains trusted
+ by winbindd is also reloaded. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>SIGUSR2</term>
+ <listitem><para>The SIGUSR2 signal will cause <command>
+ winbindd</command> to write status information to the winbind
+ log file.</para>
+
+ <para>Log files are stored in the filename specified by the
+ log file parameter.</para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>FILES</title>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term><filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf(5)</filename></term>
+ <listitem><para>Name service switch configuration file.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>/tmp/.winbindd/pipe</term>
+ <listitem><para>The UNIX pipe over which clients communicate with
+ the <command>winbindd</command> program. For security reasons, the
+ winbind client will only attempt to connect to the winbindd daemon
+ if both the <filename>/tmp/.winbindd</filename> directory
+ and <filename>/tmp/.winbindd/pipe</filename> file are owned by
+ root. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>$LOCKDIR/winbindd_privileged/pipe</term>
+ <listitem><para>The UNIX pipe over which 'privileged' clients
+ communicate with the <command>winbindd</command> program. For security
+ reasons, access to some winbindd functions - like those needed by
+ the <command>ntlm_auth</command> utility - is restricted. By default,
+ only users in the 'root' group will get this access, however the administrator
+ may change the group permissions on $LOCKDIR/winbindd_privileged to allow
+ programs like 'squid' to use ntlm_auth.
+ Note that the winbind client will only attempt to connect to the winbindd daemon
+ if both the <filename>$LOCKDIR/winbindd_privileged</filename> directory
+ and <filename>$LOCKDIR/winbindd_privileged/pipe</filename> file are owned by
+ root. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>/lib/libnss_winbind.so.X</term>
+ <listitem><para>Implementation of name service switch library.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>$LOCKDIR/winbindd_idmap.tdb</term>
+ <listitem><para>Storage for the Windows NT rid to UNIX user/group
+ id mapping. The lock directory is specified when Samba is initially
+ compiled using the <parameter>--with-lockdir</parameter> option.
+ This directory is by default <filename>/usr/local/samba/var/locks
+ </filename>. </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>$LOCKDIR/winbindd_cache.tdb</term>
+ <listitem><para>Storage for cached user and group information.
+ </para></listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+</refsect1>
+
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>VERSION</title>
+
+ <para>This man page is correct for version 3 of
+ the Samba suite.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>SEE ALSO</title>
+
+ <para><filename>nsswitch.conf(5)</filename>, <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>samba</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>7</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>wbinfo</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>1</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>ntlm_auth</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>5</manvolnum></citerefentry>, <citerefentry>
+ <refentrytitle>pam_winbind</refentrytitle>
+ <manvolnum>8</manvolnum></citerefentry></para>
+</refsect1>
+
+<refsect1>
+ <title>AUTHOR</title>
+
+ <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
+ were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
+ by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
+ to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
+
+ <para><command>wbinfo</command> and <command>winbindd</command> were
+ written by Tim Potter.</para>
+
+ <para>The conversion to DocBook for Samba 2.2 was done
+ by Gerald Carter. The conversion to DocBook XML 4.2 for
+ Samba 3.0 was done by Alexander Bokovoy.</para>
+</refsect1>
+
+</refentry>